Yamaha Electronic Keyboard CGP 1000 User Manual

C G P - 1 0 0 0  
O W N E R ’ S M A N U A L  
EN  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PRECAUTIONS  
PLEASE READ CAREFULLY BEFORE PROCEEDING  
* Please keep this manual in a safe place for future reference.  
WARNING  
Always follow the basic precautions listed below to avoid the possibility of serious injury or even death from electrical  
shock, short-circuiting, damages, fire or other hazards. These precautions include, but are not limited to, the following:  
Power supply/Power cord  
Water warning  
• Only use the voltage specified as correct for the instrument. The required  
voltage is printed on the name plate of the instrument.  
• Do not expose the instrument to rain, use it near water or in damp or wet  
conditions, or place containers on it containing liquids which might spill into  
any openings.  
• Check the electric plug periodically and remove any dirt or dust which may have  
accumulated on it.  
• Never insert or remove an electric plug with wet hands.  
• Use only the supplied power cord/plug.  
Fire warning  
• Do not place the power cord near heat sources such as heaters or radiators, and  
do not excessively bend or otherwise damage the cord, place heavy objects on  
it, or place it in a position where anyone could walk on, trip over, or roll anything  
over it.  
• Do not put burning items, such as candles, on the unit.  
A burning item may fall over and cause a fire.  
If you notice any abnormality  
Do not open  
• If the power cord or plug becomes frayed or damaged, or if there is a sudden  
loss of sound during use of the instrument, or if any unusual smells or smoke  
should appear to be caused by it, immediately turn off the power switch,  
disconnect the electric plug from the outlet, and have the instrument inspected  
by qualified Yamaha service personnel.  
• Do not open the instrument or attempt to disassemble the internal parts or  
modify them in any way. The instrument contains no user-serviceable parts. If it  
should appear to be malfunctioning, discontinue use immediately and have it  
inspected by qualified Yamaha service personnel.  
CAUTION  
Always follow the basic precautions listed below to avoid the possibility of physical injury to you or others, or damage  
to the instrument or other property. These precautions include, but are not limited to, the following:  
Power supply/Power cord  
Location  
• When removing the electric plug from the instrument or an outlet, always hold  
the plug itself and not the cord. Pulling by the cord can damage it.  
• Do not expose the instrument to excessive dust or vibrations, or extreme cold or  
heat (such as in direct sunlight, near a heater, or in a car during the day) to  
prevent the possibility of panel disfiguration or damage to the internal  
components.  
• Remove the electric plug from the outlet when the instrument is not to be used  
for extended periods of time, or during electrical storms.  
• Do not use the instrument in the vicinity of a TV, radio, stereo equipment,  
mobile phone, or other electric devices. Otherwise, the instrument, TV, or radio  
may generate noise.  
• Do not connect the instrument to an electrical outlet using a multiple-connector.  
Doing so can result in lower sound quality, or possibly cause overheating in the  
outlet.  
• Do not place the instrument in an unstable position where it might accidentally  
fall over.  
Assembly  
• Before moving the instrument, remove all connected cables.  
• Read carefully the attached documentation explaining the assembly process.  
Failure to assemble the instrument in the proper sequence might result in  
damage to the instrument or even injury.  
• When setting up the product, make sure that the AC outlet you are using is  
easily accessible. If some trouble or malfunction occurs, immediately turn off  
the power switch and disconnect the plug from the outlet. Even when the power  
switch is turned off, electricity is still flowing to the product at the minimum  
level. When you are not using the product for a long time, make sure to unplug  
the power cord from the wall AC outlet.  
(1)B-11 1/2  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connections  
Using the bench (If included)  
• Before connecting the instrument to other electronic components, turn off the  
power for all components. Before turning the power on or off for all  
• Do not place the bench in an unstable position where it might accidentally fall  
over.  
components, set all volume levels to minimum. Also, be sure to set the volumes  
of all components at their minimum levels and gradually raise the volume  
controls while playing the instrument to set the desired listening level.  
• Do not play carelessly with or stand on the bench. Using it as a tool or step-  
ladder or for any other purpose might result in accident or injury.  
• Only one person should sit on the bench at a time, in order to prevent the  
possibility of accident or injury.  
Maintenance  
• Do not attempt to adjust the bench height while sitting on the bench, since this  
can cause excessive force to be imposed on the adjustment mechanism,  
possibly resulting in damage to the mechanism or even injury.  
• In the case of a model with a polished finish, gently remove dust and dirt with a  
soft cloth. Do not wipe too hard since small particles of dirt can scratch the  
instrument's finish.  
• If the bench screws become loose due to extensive long-term use, tighten them  
periodically using the included tool.  
• When cleaning the instrument, use a soft, dry or slightly damp cloth. Do not use  
paint thinners, solvents, cleaning fluids, or chemical-impregnated wiping  
cloths.  
Saving data  
Saving and backing up your data  
Handling caution  
• The data of the types listed below are lost when you turn off the power to the  
instrument. Save the data to the USER tab display (page 26), USB storage  
device (USB flash memory/floppy disk, etc).  
• Take care that the key cover does not pinch your fingers, and do not insert a  
finger or hand in any gaps on the key cover or instrument.  
• Never insert or drop paper, metallic, or other objects into the gaps on the key  
cover, panel or keyboard. If this happens, turn off the power immediately and  
unplug the power cord from the AC outlet. Then have the instrument inspected  
by qualified Yamaha service personnel.  
• Recorded/Edited Songs (page 42, 143, 158)  
• Created/Edited Styles (page 117)  
• Edited Voices (page 99)  
• Memorized One Touch Settings (page 51)  
• Edited MIDI settings (page 200)  
• Do not place vinyl, plastic or rubber objects on the instrument, since this might  
discolor the panel or keyboard.  
• In the case of a model with a polished finish, bumping the surface of the  
instrument with metal, porcelain, or other hard objects can cause the finish to  
crack or peel. Use caution.  
Moreover, the above-mentioned data can be saved all at once. Refer to page 76.  
Data in the USER tab display (page 26) may be lost due to malfunction or  
incorrect operation. Save important data to a USB storage device (USB flash  
memory/floppy disk, etc).  
• Do not rest your weight on, or place heavy objects on the instrument, and do not  
use excessive force on the buttons, switches or connectors.  
• Do not use the instrument/device or headphones for a long period of time at a  
high or uncomfortable volume level, since this can cause permanent hearing  
loss. If you experience any hearing loss or ringing in the ears, consult a  
physician.  
When you change settings in a display page and then exit from that page,  
System Setup data (listed in the Parameter Chart of the separate Data List  
booklet) is automatically stored. However, this edited data is lost if you turn  
off the power without properly exiting from the relevant display.  
• Since magnetic parts are built into this instrument, you should be careful to  
never leave any video tapes, cassette tapes, floppy disks or any kind of magnetic  
storage media on the panel—doing so may result in data loss or damage to the  
items. Also avoid using the instrument near a television or computer monitor,  
since interference may result.  
Yamaha cannot be held responsible for damage caused by improper use or modifications to the instrument, or data that is lost or destroyed.  
Always turn the power off when the instrument is not in use.  
(1)B-11 2/2  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Thank you for purchasing this Yamaha Clavinova!  
We recommend that you read this manual carefully so that you can fully take advantage of the advanced and  
convenient functions of the instrument.  
We also recommend that you keep this manual in a safe and handy place for future reference.  
About this Owner’s Manual and Data List  
This manual consists of the following sections.  
Owner’s Manual  
Introduction (page 10).......................... Please read this section first.  
Quick Guide (page 23)......................... This section explains how to use the basic functions.  
Basic Operation (page 63).................... This section explains how to use the basic operations including display-  
based controls.  
Reference (page 78) ............................. This section explains how to make detailed settings for the instrument’s  
various functions.  
Appendix (page 205)............................ This section contains additional information such asTroubleshooting and  
Specifications.  
Data List  
Voice List, MIDI Data Format, etc.  
• The CGP-1000 will be referred to as the CGP/Clavinova in this Owner’s Manual.  
• The illustrations and LCD screens as shown in this owner’s manual are for instructional purposes only, and may appear somewhat different  
from those on your instrument.  
• The example Operation Guide displays shown in this Manual are in English.  
• Copying of the commercially available musical data including but not limited to MIDI data and/or audio data is strictly prohibited except  
for your personal use.  
• This device is capable of using various types/formats of music data by optimizing them to the proper format music data for use with the  
device in advance. As a result, this device may not play them back precisely as their producers or composers originally intended.  
• Some of the preset songs have been edited for length or arrangement, and may not be exactly the same as the original.  
This product incorporates and bundles computer programs and contents in which Yamaha owns copyrights or  
with respect to which it has license to use others' copyrights. Such copyrighted materials include, without lim-  
itation, all computer software, style files, MIDI files, WAVE data, musical scores and sound recordings. Any  
unauthorized use of such programs and contents outside of personal use is not permitted under relevant laws.  
Any violation of copyright has legal consequences. DON'T MAKE, DISTRIBUTE OR USE ILLEGAL COPIES.  
• The photos of the harpsichord, bandoneon, hackbrett, music box, dulcimer and cimbalom, shown in the displays of the Clavinova, are  
courtesy of the Gakkigaku Shiryokan (Collection for Organolgy), Kunitachi College of Music.  
• The following instruments, shown in the displays of the Clavinova, are on display at the Hamamatsu Museum of Musical Instruments:  
balafon, gender, kalimba, kanoon, santur, gamelan gong, harp, hand bell, bagpipe, banjo, carillon, mandolin, oud, pan flute, pungi, rabab,  
shanai, sitar, steel drum, and tambra.  
• This product is manufactured under license of U.S. Patents No.5231671, No.5301259, No.5428708, and No.5567901 from IVL Audio  
Inc.  
• The bitmap fonts used in this instrument have been provided by and are the property of Ricoh Co., Ltd.  
• This product utilizes NF, an embedded Internet browser from ACCESS Co., Ltd. NF is used with the patented LZW, licensed  
from Unisys Co., Ltd. NF may not be separated from this product, nor may it be sold, lent or transferred in any way. Also, NF  
may not be reverse-engineered, reverse-compiled, reverse-assembled or copied.  
This software includes a module developed by the Independent JPEG Group.  
Trademarks:  
• All other trademarks are the property of their respective holders.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessories  
Guide to Yamaha Online Member Product User Registration  
“50 greats for the Piano” Music Book  
Owner’s Manual  
Data List  
The following items may be included or optional, depending on your locale:  
Bench  
Tuning  
Unlike an acoustic piano, the instrument does not need to be tuned. It always stays perfectly in tune.  
Transporting  
If you move to another location, you can transport the instrument along with other belongings. You can move the  
unit as it is (assembled) or you can disassemble the unit down to the condition it was in when you first took it out  
of the box. Transport the keyboard horizontally. Do not lean it up against a wall or stand it up on its side.  
Do not subject the instrument to excessive vibration or shock.  
When transporting the assembled instrument, make sure all screws are properly tightened and have not been  
loosened by moving the instrument.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
Convenient Functions for Singing Along with Your  
Introduction  
Enhanced Realism and Natural  
Recording Your Performance as Audio  
Basic Operation  
Handling the Floppy Disk Drive (FDD) and  
Instant Selection of the Displays  
Handling the USB Storage Device (USB Flash  
Basic Displays (Main Display and File Selection  
File Selection Display Configuration and Basic  
File/Folder Operations in the File Selection  
Restoring the Factory-programmed Settings  
Saving and Recalling Your Original Settings as a  
Reference  
Playing Backing Parts with the performance  
Playing Two Voices Simultaneously  
Playing Accompaniment with the Auto  
Playing “Mary Had a Little Lamb” with the Auto  
Playing Different Voices with the Left and Right  
Calling Up Ideal Setups for Each Song  
Calling up the panel settings to match the Style  
Enhancing the Acoustic Realism of the Sound  
Singing Along with Song Playback (Karaoke)  
Various display pages and menus appear on the LCD display of this instrument, indicating the functions and opera-  
tions. Throughout this manual, arrows are used in the instructions, indicating in shorthand the process of calling up  
these functions. The example shorthand below describes a four step operation:  
1) press the [FUNCTION] button, 2) press the [D] button to select the Controller page, 3) press the TAB [  
®] button to  
select the Keyboard/Panel page, and 4) press the [A] button to select the Initial Touch parameter.  
[FUNCTION] [D] CONTROLLER TAB [®] KEYBOARD/PANEL [A] 1 INITIAL TOUCH  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Adding Effects to Voices Played on the  
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance  
Adjusting the Microphone and Harmony  
Connecting the Clavinova Directly  
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto  
Refreshing a Web Page/Canceling Loading of a  
Playing Only the Rhythm Channels of a  
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance of the  
Using Your Instrument with Other  
Recording (3 [AUX OUT] Jacks, [AUX OUT  
Registering and Recalling Custom  
—Registration Memory ..................131  
Registering and Saving Custom Panel  
Deleting an Unneeded Panel Setup/Naming a  
Disabling Recall of Specific Items  
Calling Up Registration Memory Numbers in Order  
Using, Creating and Editing  
Adjusting the Volume Balance and Voice  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting the Bass Note for Style Playback via  
Introduction  
Setting the Chord Type for Style Playback via  
Quick Guide  
Basic Operation  
Appendix  
Removing the CGP-1000 from its Case and  
Reference  
Using, Creating and Editing Voices  
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto  
Accompaniment Styles  
Registering and Recalling Custom Panel Setups  
Using, Creating and Editing Songs  
Using a Microphone  
Connecting the Clavinova Directly to the  
Internet  
Using Your Instrument with Other  
Devices  
Appendix  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enhanced Realism and Natural Expressiveness  
Authentic Acoustic Piano-like Touch  
NW (Natural Wood) with Synthetic ivory keytops  
The CGP-1000 is one of a new breed of instruments that features a keyboard with the feel  
of real ivory. The special Natural Wood keyboard of the CGP-1000 uses real-wood white  
keys. The key surface is soft and slightly porous, giving the keys added grip and a natural  
friction that lets you play easily. The authentic touch and feel of the keys goes far beyond  
existing electronic keyboards, it makes you feel as if you’re playing a real grand piano.  
This specially crafted keyboard lets you use techniques only possible on grand pianos,  
such as playing the same note successively and having the sounds blend smoothly even  
without use of the damper pedal, or playing the same key quickly and having perfect  
articulation without the sound cutting off unnaturally.  
The Acoustic Ambience of a Grand Piano  
—with the iAFC Feature  
This Clavinova features the groundbreaking technologies of the Hybrid Active Sound-  
board System plus an iAFC (Instrumental Active Field Control) effect – utilizing an  
actual piano soundboard along with a finely crafted grand piano cabinet to perfectly  
recreate the deep sonic resonances and subtle harmonics of a concert grand piano –  
all in a full-featured digital keyboard instrument.  
The Hybrid Active Soundboard System uses a real soundboard and specialVibro-trans-  
ducers to effectively reproduce for the first time on a digital keyboard the full experi-  
ence of playing a true grand piano. This effect is NOT produced by speakers; the  
soundboard resonates naturally and transmits both sound and vibration in the exact  
same way an actual grand piano does!  
Advanced iAFC technology is also included on this instrument. Turn on the iAFC effect  
and hear the sound expand around you, as if you're playing on the stage in a concert  
hall. The overall sound is deeper and more resonant, especially when using the  
damper pedal, recreating and emphasizing the natural sounds of acoustic instruments.  
Audio Recording  
Recording Your Performance as Audio......................................page 60  
You can record your performance as audio data to a USB flash memory.  
Connect a microphone or guitar to the instrument and enjoy recording a gui-  
tar and keyboard performance together, or record your singing along with  
Song playback (in karaoke fashion).  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Playing the Instrument  
Playing Piano Voices ................................................................ page 28  
With just the press of a button, you can reconfigure the entire instrument for  
optimum piano performance, no matter what settings you’ve made from the  
panel. Now you can enjoy performing and practicing with authentic grand  
piano sounds and response—instantly.  
Playing Other Instrument Voices ..............................................page 32  
The instrument gives you not only various realistic piano Voices, but also features an  
exceptionally wide variety of authentic instruments, both acoustic and electronic.  
Perform Along with a Full Band  
—Song Playback.........................................................................page 35  
Play along with previously recorded Song data, and fill out your solo perfor-  
mance with the sounds and arrangement of an entire band or orchestra.  
Ease in Playing Backing Parts with Songs,  
—performance assistant technology.........................................page 43  
The new performance assistant technology features make it exceptionally  
easy to play professional-sounding backing parts along with Song playback.  
Playing Melodies along with Auto Accompaniment,  
—Style Playback .........................................................................page 44  
Use the Style playback features to automatically produce full backing parts and  
accompaniment, while you play melodies on top. It’s like having an expert ensemble  
playing behind you. Select an accompaniment Style—such as pop, jazz, Latin, etc.—  
and let the instrument be your backing band!  
Practicing  
Displaying and Playing along with the Music Score ................page 59  
While playing back a Song, you can have the music score (notation) automati-  
cally shown on the display—an exceptionally convenient tool for learning and  
practicing pieces.  
Guide Lamps...............................................................................page 39  
The key guide lamps are also helpful in learning and practicing, since they  
indicate the notes you should play, when you should play them, and how long  
you should hold them down.  
Recording Your Performance.................................................... page 42  
The instrument lets you easily record your own performance and save it to inter-  
nal memory or a USB storage device. This, too, is an excellent practice tool, let-  
ting you listen back to your playing and spot your strong and weak points.  
Expand Your Song Collection  
Internet Direct Connection......................................................page 176  
The instrument also connects directly to the Internet, letting you download Song data  
from special websites, and save them to internal memory or a USB storage device.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Panel Controls  
1 [POWER] switch .............................................................. P. 14  
2 [USB TO DEVICE] Terminal.............................................. P. 22  
3 [MASTER VOLUME] dial.................................................. P. 15  
4 [DEMO] button................................................................ P. 23  
Q [EXIT] button....................................................................P. 26  
R [DATA ENTRY] dial ..........................................................P. 67  
S [ENTER] button ................................................................P. 67  
T [USB] button....................................................................P. 67  
U [USER] button ..................................................................P. 67  
METRONOME  
5 [ON/OFF] button ............................................................. P. 30  
PART ON/OFF  
V [DUAL (RIGHT2)] button .................................................P. 79  
TRANSPOSE  
W [SPLIT (LEFT)] button........................................................P. 79  
6 [–] [+] buttons.................................................................. P. 56  
TEMPO  
X [FUNCTION] button ........................................................P. 27  
Y [INTERNET] button ........................................................P. 176  
7 [TAP TEMPO] button........................................................ P. 47  
8 [–] [+] buttons.................................................................. P. 31  
SONG CONTROL  
STYLE CONTROL  
Z [SONG SELECT] button....................................................P. 35  
9 STYLE category selection buttons..................................... P. 45  
[ [REC] button ....................................................................P. 42  
\ [STOP] button ..................................................................P. 35  
] [PLAY/PAUSE] button .......................................................P. 35  
^ [REW]/[FF] buttons.........................................................P. 138  
a [EXTRA TRACKS] button.................................................P. 144  
b [TRACK 2 (L)] button........................................................P. 41  
c [TRACK 1 (R)] button........................................................P. 39  
d [SCORE] button................................................................P. 38  
e [LYRICS/TEXT] button.......................................................P. 55  
f [GUIDE] button................................................................P. 39  
g [REPEAT] button...............................................................P. 41  
0 [ACMP ON/OFF] button .................................................. P. 46  
A [AUTO FILL IN] button .................................................... P. 48  
B INTRO [I]/[II]/[III] buttons ................................................ P. 47  
C MAIN VARIATION [A]/[B]/[C]/[D] buttons ....................... P. 48  
D [BREAK] button................................................................ P. 48  
E ENDING/rit. [I]/[II]/[III] buttons ........................................ P. 48  
F [SYNC STOP] button........................................................ P. 48  
G [SYNC START] button ...................................................... P. 47  
H [START/STOP] button....................................................... P. 47  
I [MUSIC FINDER] button.................................................. P. 52  
PIANO Setting  
h [PIANO RESET] button.....................................................P. 29  
J [LCD CONTRAST] knob .................................................. P. 18  
K [A]–[J] buttons.................................................................. P. 25  
L [DIRECT ACCESS] button................................................. P. 64  
M [MIXING CONSOLE] button............................................ P. 88  
N [CHANNEL ON/OFF] button ................................. P. 109, 143  
O [1π†]–[8π†] buttons ................................................ P. 25  
REGISTRATION MEMORY  
i REGIST BANK [+] [–] buttons.........................................P. 132  
j [MEMORY] button .........................................................P. 131  
k [1]–[8] buttons ...............................................................P. 131  
P TAB [][®] buttons......................................................... P. 26  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
CGP-1000  
VOICE CONTROL  
l VOICE category selection buttons.................................... P. 32  
m [VOICE EFFECT] button ................................................... P. 86  
ONE TOUCH SETTING  
n [1]–[4] buttons................................................................. P. 50  
o [OTS LINK] button........................................................... P. 51  
p Drum Kit icons................ Data List (Drum/key Assignment List)  
Pedals  
q Left pedal......................................................................... P. 30  
r Sostenuto pedal ............................................................... P. 30  
s Damper pedal.................................................................. P. 30  
t Keyboard guide lamps ..................................................... P. 39  
u Mic signal/over lamps...................................................... P. 54  
For quick reference, also see the alphabetically  
For information on the jacks and connectors located  
The [USB TO DEVICE] terminal is also located on the  
bottom left of the instrument.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playing the Keyboard  
1
Connecting the power cable  
First insert the plug of the power cable into the AC connector on the Clavinova,  
then plug the other end of the cable into the proper AC outlet on the wall.  
(The shape of the plug and outlet  
differ depending on locale.)  
2
Opening the key cover  
Using the hand grip on the front, lift open the key cover.  
If you want to play in this condition (with the panel unopened), go on to step 4.  
CAUTION  
Hold the cover with both  
hands when opening or clos-  
ing it. Do not release it until it  
is fully opened or closed. Be  
careful to avoid catching fin-  
gers (yours or others, espe-  
cially children’s) between the  
cover and the unit.  
CAUTION  
Be careful to avoid catching your  
fingers when opening the cover.  
3
Opening the panel  
CAUTION  
Do not place objects such as a  
piece of metal or paper on  
top of the key cover. Small  
objects placed on the key  
cover may fall inside the unit  
when the cover is opened and  
may be nearly impossible to  
remove. This could cause elec-  
tric shock, short circuit, fire or  
other serious damage to the  
instrument.  
Fold down the hand grip.  
Fold down the hand grip at the top (as shown), then grip the key cover at the  
bottom and lift it, gently pushing it inside the CGP-1000, revealing the con-  
trol panel.  
CAUTION  
Be careful to avoid catching your  
fingers when opening the cover.  
4
Turning the power on  
Press the [POWER] switch located on the right of the keyboard to turn the  
power on. The display located in the center of the front panel and the power  
indicator located below the left end of the keyboard lights up.  
The power indicator lights up.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
5
Playing the keyboard  
Play the keyboard to produce sound.  
Adjusting the volume  
While playing the keyboard, adjust the volume level by using the [MASTER  
VOLUME] located at the left of the panel.  
6
7
Turning the power off  
Press the [POWER] switch to turn the power off.  
The screen and the power indicator turn off.  
Closing the panel  
Grip the rim at the top of the panel, and pull the key cover down to close it.  
CAUTION  
Be careful to avoid  
catching your fingers  
when closing the cover.  
8
Closing the keycover  
Pull this portion up.  
Pull the hand grip up , and then close the key cover.  
CAUTION  
Be careful to avoid  
catching your fingers  
when closing the cover.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Setting Up  
Music Rest  
To Raise the Music Rest:  
1 Gently open the front portion of lid.  
2 Pull the music rest up and toward  
yourself until it goes at your favorite  
angle.  
3 Gently lower the music rest so that  
it rests at the angle.  
To Lower the Music Rest:  
1 Pull the music rest toward yourself  
as far as it will go.  
2 While pulling the support and gen-  
tly lowering the music rest back-  
ward until it is all the way down.  
CAUTION  
Be careful to avoid  
catching your fingers.  
Lid  
One long stay and one short stay are provided on the lid. Use one of them to open  
the lid to the desired angle.  
To open the lid:  
1 Raise and hold the right side of the lid (viewed  
open the lid with the longer  
stay using the inner recess.  
When the lid is closed or open  
with the shorter stay, the iAFC  
will not be turned on.  
1
from the keyboard end of the instrument).  
2 Raise the lid stay and carefully lower the lid so  
that the end of the stay fits into the recess in  
2
the lid.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Using Headphones  
For the longer stay, use the inner recess, and for the shorter stay, use the outer  
recess to support the lid.  
CAUTION  
Do not use the outer recess  
for the longer stay; doing so  
could make the lid unstable  
and may cause it to fall,  
resulting in damage or injury.  
Shorter stay  
Longer stay  
CAUTION  
• Make sure that the end of  
the stay fits securely in the  
lid recess. If the stay is not  
properly seated in the  
recess, the lid may fall, caus-  
ing damage or injury.  
• Be careful that you or oth-  
ers do not bump the stay  
while the lid is raised. The  
stay may be bumped out of  
the lid recess causing the lid  
to fall.  
To close the lid:  
1
1 Hold the lid stay and carefully raise the lid.  
3
2 Hold the lid in its raised position and lower the  
lid stay.  
3 Carefully lower the lid.  
2
• Be careful to avoid catching  
fingers (yours or others,  
especially children’s) when  
raising or lowering the lid.  
• Do not place any objects on  
the soundboard or the jer-  
sey cloth part; doing so may  
disturb the sound and even  
damage the instrument.  
Using Headphones  
Connect a pair of headphones to one of the  
[PHONES] jacks located on the bottom left of the  
instrument.  
Two sets of standard stereo headphones can be  
connected. (If you are using only one pair of  
headphones, you can plug them into either of  
these jacks.)  
Using the Headphone Hanger  
CAUTION  
A headphone hanger is included in the Clavinova  
package so that you can hang the headphones on the  
Clavinova. Install the headphone hanger using  
included two screws (4 x 10mm) as shown in the fig-  
ure.  
Do not listen with the head-  
phones at high volume for  
long periods of time. Doing  
so may cause hearing loss.  
Outputting sound from the speaker while headphones are con-  
nected  
CAUTION  
1 Call up the operation display.  
Do not hang anything other  
than the headphones on the  
hanger. Otherwise, the  
Clavinova or the hanger may  
be damaged.  
[FUNCTION][I] UTILITY TAB[][®] CONFIG 2  
π†  
2 Press the [3  
π†  
]/[4 ] (SPEAKER) button to select “ON.”  
Outputting sound only from the headphones  
π†  
π†  
]/[4 ]  
From the display called up in step 2 above, press the [3  
(SPEAKER) button to select “OFF.”  
When “OFF” is selected, the speakers will not sound and you can only hear  
the Clavinova sound via the headphones.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Changing the Display Language  
Changing the Display Language  
This determines the language used in the display for messages, file names, and  
character input.  
1
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB[][®] OWNER  
π†  
Press the [4  
π†  
]/[5 ] button to select a language.  
2
To return to the original display,  
press the [EXIT] button.  
Display Settings  
Adjusting the Contrast of the Display  
You can adjust the contrast of the display by turning the [LCD CONTRAST] knob  
located to the left of the display.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Display Settings  
Adjusting the Brightness of the Display  
Adjust the brightness of the display.  
1
2
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB[][®] CONFIG 2  
π†  
Press the [2  
] button to adjust the brightness of the display.  
Selecting a Picture for the Main Display Back-  
ground  
This function lets you select your favorite picture to be used as background for the  
Main display (page 25).  
1
2
3
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB[][®] OWNER  
Press the [J] (MAIN PICTURE) button to call up the Picture Selection  
Display.  
Use the [A]–[J] buttons to select a picture.  
2
3
3
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Display Settings  
After selecting, press the [DIRECT ACCESS] button then press the [EXIT] button to  
return to the Main display. The newly selected picture is shown as the background  
of the Main display.  
The explanation about picture  
compatibility at right applies  
also to the background of the  
Song Lyrics display.  
Importing a favorite picture for the Main display background  
Even though a variety of pictures are available on the Preset drive, you can  
load your own favorite picture data from USB storage device (USB flash  
memory/floppy disk, etc) to the instrument for use as background.  
Make sure to use images no larger than 640 x 480 pixels.  
If you select a picture file on the USB storage device (USB flash memory/  
floppy disk, etc), the background may take some time to appear. If you want  
to reduce this time, save the background from the USB drive to the USER  
drive of the Picture Selection display.  
If you select a picture file on the USB drive, the selected background will  
not be displayed when the power is turned on again unless the same media  
containing the data has been inserted into the drive.  
Entering the Owner Name in the Opening Display  
You can have your name appear in the opening display (the display that first  
appears when the power is turned on).  
1
2
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB[][®] OWNER  
Press the [I] (OWNER NAME) button and call up the Owner Name display.  
Refer to page 73 for character-entry details.  
Displaying the version number  
To check the version number of this instrument, press the [7π†]/[8π†  
]
(VERSION) buttons in the display in step 1 above. Press the [EXIT] button to  
return to the original display.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Handling the Floppy Disk Drive (FDD) and Floppy Disks  
(The floppy disk drive is optional. For instructions  
on installing the floppy disk drive, see page 213.)  
Cleaning the Disk Drive Read/Write Head  
• Clean the read/write head regularly. This instrument  
The floppy disk drive lets you save original data you’ve cre-  
employs a precision magnetic read/write head which,  
ated on the instrument to floppy disk, and allows you to  
after an extended period of use, will pick up a layer of  
load data from floppy disk to the instrument.  
magnetic particles from the disks used that will eventu-  
Be sure to handle floppy disks and treat the disk drive with  
ally cause read and write errors.  
care. Follow the important precautions below.  
To maintain the disk drive in optimum working order  
Yamaha recommends that you use a commercially-avail-  
able dry-type head cleaning disk to clean the head about  
once a month. Ask your Yamaha dealer about the avail-  
Floppy Disk Compatibility  
ability of proper headcleaning disks.  
• 3.5" 2DD and 2HD type floppy disks can be used.  
About Floppy Disks  
Formatting a Floppy Disk  
Handle floppy disks with care, and fol-  
low these precautions:  
• If you find that you are unable to use new, blank disks or  
old disks that have been used with other devices, you  
may need to format them. For details on how to format a  
disk, see page 68. Keep in mind that all data on the disk  
will be lost after formatting. Make sure to check before-  
hand whether or not the disk contains important data.  
• Do not place heavy objects on a disk or bend or apply  
pressure to the disk in any way. Always keep floppy disks  
in their protective cases when they are not in use.  
• Do not expose the disk to direct sunlight, extremely high  
or low temperatures, or excessive humidity, dust or liq-  
uids.  
n
Floppy disks formatted on this device may or may not be useable  
as is on other devices.  
• Do not open the sliding shutter and touch the exposed  
surface of the floppy disk inside.  
• Do not expose the disk to magnetic fields, such as those  
produced by televisions, speakers, motors, etc., since  
magnetic fields can partially or completely erase data on  
the disk, rendering it unreadable.  
Inserting/Removing Floppy Disks  
Inserting a Floppy Disk into the Disk Drive:  
• Never use a floppy disk with a deformed shutter or hous-  
ing.  
• Do not attach anything other than the provided labels to  
a floppy disk. Also make sure that labels are attached in  
the proper location.  
• Hold the disk so that the label of the disk is facing  
upward and the sliding shutter is facing forward, towards  
the disk slot. Carefully insert the disk into the slot, slowly  
pushing it all the way in until it clicks into place and the  
eject button pops out.  
n
Never insert anything but floppy disks into the disk drive. Other  
objects may cause damage to the disk drive or floppy disks.  
To Protect Your Data (Write-protect Tab):  
To prevent accidental erasure of important data, slide the  
disks write-protect tab to the “protect” position (tab  
open). When saving data, make sure that the disk’s write-  
protect tab is set to the “overwrite” position (tab closed).  
Removing a Floppy Disk  
• After checking that the instrument is not accessing* the  
floppy disk (checking that the use lamp on the floppy  
disk drive is off), firmly press the eject button at the  
upper right of the disk slot all the way in.  
When the floppy disk is ejected, pull it out of the drive. If  
the floppy disk cannot be removed because it is stuck,  
do not try to force it, but instead try pressing the eject  
button again, or try re-inserting the disk and attempt to  
eject it again.  
Write-protect tab open  
(protect position)  
* Access of the disk indicates an active operation, such as  
recording, playback, or deletion of data.  
If a floppy disk is inserted while the power is on, the disk is  
automatically accessed, since the instrument checks whether  
the disk has data.  
CAUTION  
Do not remove the floppy disk or turn off the instrument  
itself while the disk is being accessed.  
Doing so may result not only in loss of data on the disk  
but also damage to the floppy disk drive.  
• Be sure to remove the floppy disk from the disk drive  
before turning off the power. A floppy disk left in the  
drive for extended periods can easily pick up dust and  
dirt that can cause data-read and -write errors.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Handling the USB Storage Device (USB Flash Memory/Floppy Disk, etc)  
This instrument features a built-in [USB TO DEVICE] termi-  
nal. By connecting the instrument to a USB storage device  
Using USB Storage Devices  
• When connecting a USB storage device to the [USB TO  
DEVICE], make sure that the connector on the device is  
appropriate and that it is connected in the proper direc-  
tion. Before removing the media from the device, make  
sure that the instrument is not accessing data (such as in  
the Save, Copy and Delete operations).  
with a standard USB cable, you can save data you’ve cre-  
ated to the connected device, as well as read data from the  
connected device. Be sure to handle USB storage device  
with care. Follow the important precautions below.  
n
For more information about the handling of USB storage device,  
refer to the owner’s manual of the USB storage device.  
CAUTION  
• Avoid frequently turning the power on/off to the USB  
storage device, or connecting/disconnecting the cable  
too often. Doing so may result in the operation of the  
instrument “freezing” or hanging up. While the instru-  
ment is accessing data (such as in the Save, Copy and  
Delete operations), do NOT unplug the USB cable, do  
NOT remove the media from the device, and do NOT  
turn the power off to either device. Doing so may cor-  
rupt the data on either or both devices.  
• When connecting a USB storage device to the [USB TO  
DEVICE] on the top panel, remove it before closing the  
key cover. If the key cover is closed with the USB stor-  
age device connected, the USB storage device may be  
damaged.  
Compatible USB storage devices  
• Up to two USB storage devices, such as a floppy disk  
drive, hard disk drive, CD-ROM drive, flash memory  
reader/writer, etc., can be connected to the [USB TO  
DEVICE] terminal. (If necessary, use a USB hub. The num-  
ber of USB storage devices that can be used with musical  
instruments simultaneously even when a USB hub is used  
is a maximum of two.)This instrument can recognize up to  
four drives in one USB storage device. Other USB devices  
such as a computer keyboard or mouse cannot be used.  
• The instrument does not necessarily support all commer-  
cially available USB storage devices. Yamaha cannot  
guarantee operation of USB storage devices that you  
purchase. Before purchasing USB storage devices,  
please consult your Yamaha dealer, or an authorized  
Yamaha distributor (see list at end of the Owners Man-  
ual) for advice, or visit the following web page:  
• Though there are two [USBTO DEVICE] terminals on the  
instrument, if you are connecting two or three devices at  
the same time (such as two USB storage devices and a  
LAN adaptor), you should use a USB hub device. The  
USB hub must be self-powered (with its own power  
source) and the power must be on. Only one USB hub  
can be used. If an error message appears while using the  
USB hub, disconnect the hub from the instrument, then  
turn on the power of the instrument and re-connect the  
USB hub.  
http://music.yamaha.com/homekeyboard  
n Although CD-R/RW drives can be used to read data to  
the instrument, they cannot be used for saving data.  
• Though the instrument supports the USB 1.1 standard,  
you can connect and use a USB 2.0 storage device with  
the instrument. However, note that the transfer speed is  
that of USB 1.1.  
Formatting USB storage media  
• When a USB storage device is connected or media is  
inserted, a message may appear prompting you to format  
the device/media. If so, execute the Format operation.  
To protect your data (write-protect):  
CAUTION  
The format operation overwrites any previously existing  
data. Make sure that the media you are formatting does  
not contain important data. Proceed with caution, espe-  
cially when connecting multiple USB storage medias.  
To prevent important data from being inadvertently erased,  
apply the write-protect provided with each storage device  
or media. If you are saving data to the USB storage device,  
make sure to disable write-protect.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Quick Guide  
Playing the Demos  
The Demos are more than just songs—they also provide helpful, easy-to-understand introductions to the  
features, functions and operations of the instrument. In a way, the Demos are an interactive “mini-man-  
ual”—complete with sound demonstrations and text showing what it can do for you.  
1 Select the desired Language.  
1 Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [J]UTILITY TAB[][®] OWNER  
π†  
π†  
] buttons  
2 Press the [4  
]/[5  
to select the desired language.  
2 Press the [DEMO] button to start the Demos.  
Demos will play back continuously until  
stopped.  
3 Press the [EXIT] button to stop the Demo playback.  
When the Demo stops, the display returns  
to the MAIN display (page 65).  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Showing Specific Demo Topics  
π†  
1 Press the [7  
π†  
]/[8  
] buttons in the Demo display to call up the specific Demo menu.  
2 Press one of the [A]–[I] buttons to show a specific Demo.  
To return back to the previous display,  
press the [J] button.  
When the Demo has more than  
one screen.  
Press a [π†] button corresponding  
to the screen number.  
3 Press the [EXIT] button to exit from Demo.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Operations in the Basic Displays  
To start with, you should know a little about the basic displays that appear in the Quick Guide. There are  
three basic displays:  
Main display ➤  
See below.  
File selection display ➤  
Function display ➤  
Operation of the Main Display  
The Main display shows the basic settings and important information for the instrument (It is the same display that  
appears when the instrument is turned on.).You can also call up display pages related to the displayed function from  
the Main display.  
n About information in the Main display  
1 [A]–[J] buttons  
1
1
The [A]–[J] buttons correspond to the settings  
indicated next to the buttons.  
For example, press the [F] button, and the  
Voice (RIGHT 1) selection display will appear  
in the display.  
π† π†  
2 [1 ]–[8 ] buttons  
The [1π†]–[8π†] buttons correspond to  
the parameters which are indicated above the  
buttons.  
For example, pressing the [1  
π] button will  
3
3
3 [DIRECT ACCESS] and [EXIT] buttons  
Here’s a convenient way to return to the Main  
display from any other display: Simply press the  
[DIRECT ACCESS] button, then the [EXIT] button.  
2
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Operation of the File Selection Display  
In the File Selection display, you can select the Voice (page 28)/Song (page 35)/Style (page 44), etc.  
In the example here, we’ll call up and use the Song Selection display.  
2
1
3,5  
3,5  
4
1 Press the [SONG SELECT] button to call up the Song Selection display.  
2 Press the TAB [][®] buttons to select the desired drive (PRESET/USER/USB).  
About PRESET/USER/USB  
PRESET ..............Internal memory to which the preprogrammed data are installed as preset data.  
USER .................Internal memory that allows both reading and writing of data.  
USB...................USB storage device, such as USB flash memory/floppy disk drive, etc., which is connected  
to the [USB TO DEVICE] terminal.  
n Hereafter in this manual, any USB storage device such as USB flash memory/floppy disk, etc. will be referred to as “USB  
storage device.”  
3 Select a folder (if necessary).  
Several Songs may be together in a  
folder. In this case, the folder(s) will  
appear in the display (see the illustration  
at right). Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons  
to select a folder.  
Press the [8  
π] (UP) button to call up  
the next highest level folder.  
4 Select a page (if the display has several pages).  
When the drive contains more than ten Songs, the display is divided up into several pages. The page indica-  
tions are shown at the bottom of the display. Press one of the [1π]–[6π] buttons to select a page.  
5 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a Song.  
You can also select a Song by using the [DATA ENTRY] dial, then press the [ENTER] button to execute.  
6 Press the [EXIT] button to return to the previous display.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Operation of the Function Display  
In the Function display, you can make detailed settings.  
In the example here, we’ll call up and use the keyboard touch sensitivity setting display.  
1 Press the [FUNCTION] button.  
Categories of detailed settings are  
shown.  
2 Press the [D] button to select the category CONTROLLER.  
When the selected category is further  
divided into sub-categories, the tab(s)  
will be shown in the display.  
3 Press the TAB [®] button to select the KEYBOARD/PANEL tab.  
When the setting is further divided into  
additional settings, a list will be shown  
in the display.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
4 Press the [A] button to select the “1 INITIAL TOUCH.”  
4
5
π†  
π†  
] button to select touch sensitivity for the keyboard.  
5 Press the [1  
]/[2  
For details on the touch sensitivity settings, see page 29.  
Throughout this manual, arrows are used in the instructions, indicating in shorthand the process of calling up certain  
displays and functions.  
For example, the instructions above can be indicated in shorthand as: [FUNCTION] [D] CONTROLLER TAB [®  
]
KEYBOARD/PANEL [A] 1 INITIAL TOUCH.  
Playing Voices  
The instrument features a variety of Voices, including exceptionally realistic piano Voices.  
VOICE category selection buttons (page 32)  
METRONOME  
[ON/OFF] button  
[PIANO RESET] button  
Playing the Piano Voice  
Here, we’ll call up and play the piano voice. You can play the piano voice using the pedals or metronome.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
One-touch Piano Play  
This convenient, easy-to-use feature completely and automatically reconfigures the entire instrument for optimum  
piano performance. No matter what settings you’ve made from the panel, you can instantly call up the piano settings  
by a single button press.  
Press the piano-shaped [PIANO RESET] button on the lower right of the panel.  
Piano Lock Function  
The convenient Piano Lock function lets you “lock” the piano so that you don’t inadvertently change the settings by  
pressing another button on the panel. Once locked, the instrument stays in the piano mode, even if other buttons are  
pressed—preventing you from accidentally starting a Song (page 35) during your piano performance.  
1 Press and hold down the [PIANO RESET] button on the lower right of the panel for three seconds  
or longer, until a message appears prompting you to enable Piano Lock.  
2 Press the [F] (OK) button to enable Piano Lock.  
3 To turn Piano Lock off, press and hold down the [PIANO RESET] button again for three seconds or  
longer.  
Setting the touch sensitivity of the keyboard  
You can adjust the touch response of the instrument (how the sound responds to the way you play the keys). The touch  
sensitivity type becomes the common setting for all Voices.  
1 Call up the operation display:  
[FUNCTION] [D] CONTROLLER TAB [®] KEYBOARD/  
PANEL [A] 1 INITIAL TOUCH  
2 Press the [1π†]/[2π†] buttons to specify the touch response.  
HARD 2..... Requires strong playing to produce high volume. Best  
for players with a heavy touch.  
HARD 1..... Requires moderately strong playing for high volume.  
NORMAL... Standard touch response.  
SOFT 1....... Produces high volume with moderate playing strength.  
SOFT 2....... Produces relatively high volume even with light play-  
ing strength. Best for players with a light touch.  
• This setting does not change the weight of the keyboard.  
n
• When you do not want to apply touch sensitivity, setTouch to OFF for  
the corresponding parts by pressing the [5  
]–[7] buttons. When  
Touch is set to OFF, you can specify the fixed volume level by press-  
ing the [4π†] button.  
• The touch sensitivity settings may have no effect with certain voices.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Using the Pedals  
The instrument features three pedals.  
Left Pedal  
Damper Pedal  
Sostenuto Pedal  
Damper Pedal (Right)  
The damper pedal performs the same function as the damper pedal on an  
actual acoustic piano, letting you sustain the sound of the voices even  
after releasing the keys.  
• Some Voices may sound continuously or have a long decay after the notes  
n
have been released while the damper pedal is held.  
• Certain Voices in the “PERCUSSION & DRUM KIT,” “GM&XG” and “GM2”  
groups may not be affected by use of the damper pedal.  
When you press the damper pedal  
here, the notes you play before you  
release the pedal have a longer sustain.  
Sostenuto Pedal (Center)  
If you play a note or chord on the keyboard and press the sostenuto pedal  
while holding the note(s), the notes will sustain as long as the pedal is  
held. All subsequent notes will not sustain.  
• Certain Voices, such as [STRINGS] or [BRASS], sustain continuously when  
n
the sostenuto pedal is pressed.  
• Certain Voices in the “PERCUSSION & DRUM KIT”, “GM&XG” and “GM2”  
groups may not be affected by use of the sostenuto pedal.  
When you press the sostenuto  
pedal here while holding the  
note(s), the notes will sustain as  
long as you hold the pedal.  
Left Pedal  
When the Piano voice is selected, pressing this pedal reduces the volume  
and slightly changes the timbre of the notes you play.  
The settings assigned to this pedal may differ depending on the selected Voice.  
Foot Controller/Footswitch  
An optional Yamaha foot controller (FC7) or footswitch (FC4 or FC5) can be connected to the AUX PEDAL jack and  
used to control various functions assigned (page 191).  
Making Settings for the Pedals  
You can assign one of the various functions to the three pedals or an optional foot controller/footswitch, doing things  
like controlling the Super Articulation voices (page 78) or starting and stopping the Style (page 191).  
Using the Metronome  
The metronome provides a click sound, giving you an accurate tempo guide when you practice, or letting you hear and  
check how a specific tempo sounds.  
1 Press the METRONOME [ON/OFF] button to start the metronome.  
2 To stop the metronome, press the METRONOME [ON/OFF] button again.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Adjusting the Tempo or Setting the Time Signature of the Metronome Sound  
Adjusting the Metronome Tempo  
1 Press the TEMPO [–]/[+] button to call up the pop-up tempo setting display.  
2 Press the TEMPO [–]/[+] buttons to set the tempo.  
Pressing and holding either button lets you continuously increase or decrease the value.  
You can also use the [DATA ENTRY] dial to adjust the value. To reset the tempo, press the TEMPO [–]/[+] but-  
tons simultaneously.  
n About the Tempo display  
The number in the display indicates how many quarter-note beats there are in one minute. The range is between 5 and  
500. The higher the value, the faster the tempo.  
3 Press the [EXIT] button to close the Tempo display.  
Set the Popup Display Time  
1
2
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB [][®] CONFIG 2  
Select the [B] (2 POPUP DISPLAY TIME) button, and use the [7π†]/[8π†] buttons to set the time.  
Determine the Metronome Time Signature and Other Settings  
1 Call up the operation display:  
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB [] CONFIG 1 [B] 2 METRONOME  
π† π†  
Set the parameters by pressing the [2 ]–[7 ] buttons.  
2
VOLUME  
SOUND  
Determines the level of the metronome sound.  
Determines which sound is used for the metronome.  
Bell Off............... Conventional metronome  
sound, with no bell.  
Bell On............... Conventional metronome  
sound, with bell.  
English Voice...... Count in English  
German Voice .... Count in German  
Japanese Voice ... Count in Japanese  
French Voice....... Count in French  
Spanish Voice..... Count in Spanish  
TIME  
SIGNATURE  
Determines the time signature of the metronome  
sound.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Playing Various Voices  
The instrument features a variety of Voices such as strings or wind instruments, including exceptionally realistic piano  
Voices.  
Playing Preset Voices  
The presetVoices are categorized and contained in appropriate folders.VOICE category selection buttons on the panel  
correspond to the categories of the preset Voices. For example, press the [PIANO] button to display various piano  
Voices.  
n About the various Voices  
Refer to the Voice List in the separate Data List booklet.  
1 Use the [A]/[B]/[F]/[G] (RIGHT1) buttons in the Main display to select the RIGHT 1  
part.  
Make sure the PART ON/OFF [DUAL (RIGHT2)]/[SPLIT (LEFT)] buttons are off.  
The Voice selected here is the RIGHT 1 part. For the Voice part, see page 79.  
Determining how the Voice selection display is opened (when one of the VOICE category selection  
buttons is pressed).  
You can select how the Voice selection display is opened (when one of the VOICE category selection buttons is  
pressed).  
1
2
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB [][®] CONFIG 2  
Select the [B] (2 VOICE CATEGORY BUTTON OPTIONS) button, and use the [1π†]/[2π†] buttons to change  
how the Voice selection display is opened.  
• OPEN&SELECT:  
Opens theVoice selection display with the top (first) voice of the voice category automatically selected (when  
one of the Voice category selection buttons is pressed). With the default settings, the OPEN&SELECT function  
is turned on.  
• OPEN ONLY:  
Opens theVoice selection display with the currently selected voice (when one of theVOICE category selection  
2 Press one of the VOICE category selection buttons to select a Voice category and call  
up the Voice selection display.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
3 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select the desired Voice.  
You can call up the information for the selectedVoice by pressing the [7π] (INFORMATION) button.  
n The Voice type and its defining characteristics are indicated above the Preset Voice name. For details on the characteris-  
n You can instantly jump back to the original display by “double-clicking” on one of the [A]–[J] buttons.  
4 Play the keyboard.  
n Restoring the Piano settings  
Press the piano-shaped [PIANO RESET] button.  
Recalling your favorite Voices easily  
The instrument has a huge amount of high-qualityVoices, covering an exceptionally broad range of instrument sounds—  
making it perfect for virtually every musical application. However, the sheer number of Voices may seem overwhelming  
at first. To easily recall your favorite Voice, there are two methods:  
Save your favorite Voice to the USER display in the Voice Selection display and recall it by using the  
[USER] button  
1 Copy your favorite Voices from the Preset drive to the User drive.  
2 Call up the selection display.  
[USER] [F] VOICE (RIGHT1)  
3 Select the desired Voice.  
Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select the Voice.  
Register your favorite Voice to Registration Memory and recall it with the REGISTRATION MEMORY  
[1]–[8] buttons  
Refer to page 131 for details on Registration Memory operations.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Playing the Voice Demos  
To listen to the various Voices and hear how they sound especially in context, listen to the demo songs for each Voice.  
1 In the Voice Selection display (page 33 step 3), press the [8 ] (DEMO) button to start  
the Demo for the selected Voice.  
2 To stop the Demo, press the [8 ] (DEMO) button again.  
Selecting percussion sounds  
When one of the Drum Kit Voices in the [PERCUSSION & DRUM KIT] group is selected, you can play various drums  
and percussion instrument sounds on the keyboard. Details are given in the Drum Kit List of the separate Data List.  
To check which “Standard Kit 1” percussion sounds are assigned to each key, look at the icons printed above the keys.  
Selecting sound effects  
You can play individual sound effects, such as bird chirps and ocean sounds from the keyboard. The sound effects are  
categorized as “GM&XG”/“GM2.”  
1 Use the [A]/[B]/[F]/[G] (RIGHT 1) buttons to select the RIGHT 1 part.  
2 Press the [8π] (UP) button to call up the Voice categories.  
3 Press the [2π] button to display page 2.  
4 Press the [E]/[F] button to select “GM&XG”/“GM2.”  
5 Press the [2 ] button to display page 2.  
π
6 Press the [F] button to select “SoundEffect.”  
7 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select the desired sound effect.  
8 Play the keyboard.  
Selecting GM/XG/GM2 Voices  
You can select the GM/XG/GM2 Voices directly via the panel operation.  
Perform steps 1–4 described above, select the desired category, then select the desired voice.  
Playing different Voices simultaneously  
The instrument can play different Voices simultaneously (page 79).  
• Layering two different Voices  
This is useful for creating rich and thick sounds.  
• Setting separate Voices for the left and right sections of the keyboard  
You can play different Voices with the left and right hands. For example, you can set up the keyboard to play the  
bass Voice with your left hand and the piano Voice with your right hand.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Practicing with the Songs  
n Song  
On the instrument, performance data is called a “Song.”  
Playing Back Songs Before Practicing  
The instrument includes not only the preset demo Songs, but also many preset Songs. This section covers basic infor-  
mation on playing back the preset Songs or Songs in a CD-ROM.  
1 Press the [SONG SELECT] button to call up the Song selection display.  
2 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a Song category.  
The preset Songs are categorized and contained in appropriate folders.  
3 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select the desired Song.  
You can also select the file by using the [DATA ENTRY] dial, then press the [ENTER] button to execute.  
n You can instantly jump back to the original display by “double-clicking” on one of the [A]–[J] buttons.  
4 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start playback.  
5 Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop playback.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
1 Press the [SONG SELECT] button to call up the Song selection display.  
2 Press the TAB [][®] button to select the USER tab.  
3 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select the desired Song.  
n Select the file to which the data is saved.  
You can also select the specified file to which the data is saved by pressing the [USER] button.  
[USER] [A] SONG [A]–[J]  
For information on using USB storage devices, see page 22.  
1 Connect the USB storage device to the [USB TO DEVICE] terminal.  
2 Press the [SONG SELECT] button to call up the Song selection display.  
3 Press the TAB [][®] buttons to select the USB tab (“USB1”/“USB2”), corresponding to the USB storage device  
you inserted in Step 1.  
The indication “USB1”/“USB2” will be displayed depending on the number of the connected devices.  
4 Use the [A]–[J] buttons to select a Song.  
n Select the file to which the data is saved.  
You can also select the specified file to which the data is saved by pressing the [USB] button.  
[USB] [A] SONG [A]–[J]  
Playing Songs in sequence  
You can play all Songs in a folder continuously.  
1 Select a Song in the desired folder.  
2 Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [B] SONG SETTING  
3 Press the [H] (REPEAT MODE) button to select “ALL.”  
4 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start playback.  
All Songs in the folder play back continuously, in order.  
5 Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop continuous playback.  
6 To turn off the Song sequence playback, press the [H] button to select “OFF” in the display in step 2.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Boost the volume of the part to be practiced  
On the instrument, a single Song can contain separate data for up to sixteen MIDI channels. Specify the channel for  
practicing and increase the playback volume for the channel.  
1 Select a Song. The method for selecting a Song is the same as “Playing Back Songs Before Practicing (page 35 step  
1–5).”  
2 Press the [MIXING CONSOLE] button to call up the MIXING CONSOLE display.  
3
2,4  
3 Press the TAB [][®] buttons to select the VOL/VOICE tab.  
4 Press the [MIXING CONSOLE] button until “MIXING CONSOLE (SONG CH1–8)” is shown at the top of the dis-  
play.  
5 Press the [E]/[J] button to select “VOLUME.”  
π† π†  
].  
6 To raise the level of the desired channel(s), press the appropriate buttons [1  
]–[8  
If the desired channel is not shown in the MIXING CONSOLE (SONG CH1–8) display, press the [MIXING CON-  
SOLE] button to call up the MIXING CONSOLE (SONG CH9–16) display.  
If you don’t know which channel’s volume to raise:  
• Look at the illustrations of the instruments indicated below “VOICE.”  
• Look at the channel indicators, which light as the Song plays back. Watching these as you listen can show you  
which channel you wish to boost.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Displaying Music Notation (Score)  
You can view the music notation of the selected Song. We suggest that you read through the music notation before  
starting to practice.  
• The instrument can display the music notation of commercially-available music data or your recorded Songs.  
n
• The displayed notation is generated by the instrument based on the Song data. As a result, it may not be exactly the same as com-  
mercially available sheet music of the same song—especially when displaying notation of complicated passages or many short  
notes.  
• The notation functions cannot be used to create Song data by inputting notes. For information on creating Song data, see  
2 Press the [SCORE] button to display the music notation.  
n Look through the entire score before playing back the Song  
Press the TAB [®] button to select subsequent pages.  
3 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start playback.  
The “ball” bounces along through the score, indicating the current position.  
4 Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop playback.  
Changing the Notation Display  
You can change the notation display as desired to suit your personal  
preferences.  
1 Press the [SCORE] button to display the music nota-  
tion.  
2 Changing the following settings as desired.  
Changing the size of the music notation  
Press the [7π†] button to change the size of the  
music notation.  
Displaying only right-hand part/left-hand part  
notation  
Press the [1π†]/[2π†] button to disable display of  
the left-hand part/right-hand part.  
Customizing the notation display  
• Display the note name at the left of the note  
π†  
1 Press the [5  
2 Press the [8  
3 Press the [6  
] (NOTE) button to display the note name.  
π†  
] (SET UP) button to call up the detailed setting display.  
] (NOTE NAME) button to select “Fixed Do.”  
π
4 Press the [8 ] (OK) button to apply the setting.  
• Turn on the note colors  
Press the [6π†] button to turn the COLOR on.  
n About the note colors  
These colors are fixed for each note and cannot be changed.  
C: red, D: yellow, E: green, F: orange, G: blue, A: purple, and B: gray  
Increase the number of measures in the display  
You can increase the number of measures that will be displayed by decreasing the other items to be dis-  
played (part, lyrics, chords, etc.).  
Use the [1π†]–[4π†] buttons to turn off the items you want not to be displayed.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Set the detailed parameters of the view type as desired.  
π†  
1 Press the [8  
] (SETUP) button to call up the detailed setting display.  
π† π†  
2 Press the [1 ]–[6 ] buttons to set the view type.  
Determines which MIDI channel in the Song data is used for the left-hand/right-hand part. This set-  
ting returns to AUTO when a different Song is selected.  
AUTO  
The MIDI channels in the Song data for the right- and left-hand parts are assigned automatically—  
setting the parts to the same channel as the channel which is specified in the [FUNCTION] [B]  
SONG SETTING.  
LEFT CH/RIGHT CH  
1–16  
Assigns the specified MIDI channel (1–16) to each of the left- and right-hand parts.  
OFF (LEFT CH only)  
No channel assignment: This disables display of the left-hand key range.  
This lets you enter key signature changes in the middle of a song, at the stopped position. This menu  
is useful when the selected Song contains no key signature settings for displaying notation.  
KEY SIGNATURE  
QUANTIZE  
This gives you control over the note resolution in the notation, letting you shift or correct the timing  
of all displayed notes so that they line up to a particular note value. Make sure to select the smallest  
note value used in the song.  
Selects the type of the note name indicated at the left of the note in the notation from among the fol-  
lowing three types. The settings here are available when the NOTE parameter in “Display the note  
name at the left of the note” step 1 is set to ON.  
A, B, C  
Note names are indicated as letters (C, D, E, F, G, A, B).  
FIXED DO  
NOTE NAME  
Note names are indicated in solfeggio and differ depending on the selected language.  
The language is specified in LANGUAGE of the OWNER display (page 63).  
MOVABLE DO  
Note names are indicated in solfeggio according to the scale intervals, and as such are relative to the  
key. The root note is indicated as Do. For example, in the key of G major the root note of “So” would  
be indicated as “Do.” As with “Fixed Do,” the indication differs depending on the selected language.  
π
3 Press the [8 ] (OK) button to apply the setting.  
n Save the notation view settings  
The notation view settings can be saved as part of a Song (page 162).  
One-handed Practice with the Guide Lamps  
The key guide lamps indicate the notes you should play, when you should play them, and how long you should hold  
them down. You can also practice at your own pace—since the accompaniment waits for you to play the notes cor-  
rectly. Here, mute the right- or left-hand part and try practicing the part using the guide lamps.  
Practicing the Right-hand Part (TRACK 1) Using the Guide Lamps  
2 Turn the [GUIDE] button on.  
4
3
2
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
3 Press the [TRACK 1 (R)] button to mute the right-hand part.  
The indicator of the [TRACK 1 (R)] button goes out. You can now play that part by yourself.  
n Have the guide lamp flash a lead-in to the music  
4 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start playback.  
Practice the muted part using the guide lamps.  
n Adjusting the tempo  
Quickly changing tempo during a performance (Tap function)  
The tempo can also be changed during Song playback by tapping the [TAP TEMPO] button twice at the desired tempo.  
5 Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop playback.  
6 Turn the [GUIDE] button off.  
Adjusting the volume balance between the Song and the keyboard  
This lets you adjust the volume balance between Song playback and the sound you play on the keyboard.  
1 Call up the Main display.  
[DIRECT ACCESS] [EXIT]  
n The Balance display is indicated at the bottom of the Main display.  
When the Balance display is not indicated, press the [EXIT] button.  
2 To adjust the Song volume, press the [1π†] button. To adjust the keyboard (RIGHT 1) volume, press the [6π†]  
button.  
n About keyboard parts (Right 1, Right 2, Left)  
Other guide functions  
The initial setting “Follow Lights (page 142)” was used in the instructions “One-handed Practice with the Guide  
Lamps” above. There are additional functions in the Guide feature, as described below. To select a guide function, see  
For keyboard performance  
• Any Key  
This lets you practice the timing of playing the keys.  
For Karaoke  
• Karao-Key  
This function lets you control the Song playback timing with just one finger, while you sing along.  
• Vocal CueTIME  
This automatically controls the timing of the accompaniment to match the melody (pitch) of your singing—allow-  
ing you to practice singing with the correct pitch.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Practicing the Left-hand Part (TRACK 2) Using the Guide Lamps  
1,2 Follow the same steps as in “Practice the Right-hand Part (TRACK 1) Using the  
3 Press the [TRACK 2] button to mute the left-hand part.  
The indicator of the [TRACK 2 (L)] button goes out. You can now play that part by yourself.  
4 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start playback and practice the muted part  
using the guide lamps.  
5 Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop playback.  
6 Turn the [GUIDE] button off.  
Practicing with the Repeat Playback Function  
The Song Repeat functions can be used to repeatedly play back a Song or a specific range of measures in a Song. This  
is useful for repeated practicing of difficult-to-play phrases.  
Playing Back a Song Repeatedly  
1 Select a Song (page 35).  
2 Press the [REPEAT] button to turn on Repeat playback.  
3 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start playback.  
The Song will be played back repeatedly until you press the SONG [STOP] button.  
4 Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop playback.  
5 Press the [REPEAT] button to turn off Repeat playback.  
Specifying a Range of Measures and Playing them Back Repeat-  
edly (A-B Repeat)  
1 Select a Song (page 35).  
2 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start playback.  
3 Specify the repeat range.  
Press the [REPEAT] button at the starting point (A) of the range to be repeated. Press the [REPEAT] button  
again at the ending point (B). After an automatic lead-in (to help guide you into the phrase), the range from  
Point A to Point B is played back repeatedly.  
n Instantly returning to Point A  
Regardless of whether the Song is playing back or is stopped, pressing the [STOP] button returns to Point A.  
4 Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop playback.  
5 Press the [REPEAT] button to turn off Repeat playback.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Other Methods for Specifying the A–B Repeat Range  
Specifying the repeat range while Songs are stopped  
1 Press the [FF] button to advance to the Point A location.  
2 Press the [REPEAT] button to specify Point A.  
3 Press the [FF] button to advance to the Point B location.  
4 Press the [REPEAT] button again to specify Point B.  
Specifying the repeat range between Point A and the end of the Song  
Specifying only Point A results in repeat playback between Point A and the end of the Song.  
Recording Your Performance  
Record your performance by using the Quick Recording feature. This is an effective practice tool, allowing you to easily  
compare your own performance to the original song you are practicing. You can also use it to practice duet pieces by  
yourself, if you have your teacher or partner record his or her part beforehand.  
1 Press the [REC] and [STOP] buttons simultaneously.  
A blank Song for recording is automatically set.  
2 Select a Voice (page 32). The selected Voice will be recorded.  
3 Press the [REC] button.  
4 Start recording.  
Recording begins automatically as soon as you play a note on the keyboard.  
5 Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop recording.  
A message prompting you to save the recorded performance appears. To close the message, press the [EXIT]  
button.  
6 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to play back the recorded performance.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
7 Save the recorded performance.  
1 Press the [SONG SELECT] button to call up the Song selection display.  
2 Press the TAB [][®] buttons to select the appropriate tab (USER, USB, etc.) to which you want to  
save the data. Select USER to save the data to internal memory, or select USB to save the data to a  
USB storage device.  
3 Press the [6 ] (SAVE) button to call up the file naming display.  
4 Enter the file name (page 73).  
π
5 Press the [8 ] (OK) button to save the file.  
To cancel the Save operation, press the [8] (CANCEL) button.  
CAUTION  
The recorded song will be lost if you change to another Song or you turn the power off without executing the Save oper-  
ation.  
When the following message appears: “Song” changed. Save?/“Song” speichern?/“Song” modifié.  
Sauv.?/“Song” cambiado. ¿Guardar?/Salvare “’Song” ?  
The recorded data has not yet been saved. To save the data, press the [G] (YES) button to open the Song selection dis-  
play and save the data (see above). To cancel the operation, press the [H] (NO) button.  
Playing Songs saved to a USER/USB storage device  
Playing Backing Parts with the performance  
assistant Technology  
This feature makes it exceptionally easy to play the backing parts along with Song playback.  
n Before using performance assistant technology  
To use the performance assistant technology, the Song must contain chord data. If the Song contains this data, the current chord  
name will be displayed in the Main display during Song playback, letting you easily check whether the Song contains chord data or  
not.  
In these example instructions, we recommend that you use the Songs in the “Sing-a-long” folder.  
2 Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [B] SONG SETTING  
π†  
3 Press the [8  
] button to turn the [P.A.T.] (Performance Assistant) on.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
4 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start playback.  
5 Play the keyboard.  
The instrument automatically matches your performance on the keyboard to the Song playback and chords,  
no matter what keys you play. It even changes the sound according to the way you play. Try playing in the  
three different ways below.  
Playing the left and right hand together Playing the left and right hand together Playing the left hand and right hand  
(method 1).  
(method 2).  
alternately.  
Play three notes at the  
same time with your  
right hand.  
Play several notes one after  
the other with different fin-  
gers of your right hand.  
Play three notes at the  
same time with your  
right hand.  
6 Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop playback.  
π†  
7 Press the [8  
] button to turn the [P.A.T.] (Performance Assistant) off.  
Playing Accompaniment with the Auto Accom-  
paniment Feature (Style Playback)  
The Auto Accompaniment features let you produce automatic accompaniment playback simply by playing  
“chords” with your left hand. This lets you automatically recreate the sound of a full band or orchestra—  
even if you’re playing by yourself. The Auto Accompaniment sound is made up of the rhythm patterns of the  
Styles. The Styles of the instrument cover a wide range of different musical genres including pop, jazz, and  
many others.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Playing “Mary Had a Little Lamb” with the Auto  
Accompaniment Feature  
MARY HAD A LITTLE LAMB  
Traditional  
Style: Country Pop  
C
C
G
C
3
2
1
2
3
2
3
5
1
1
4
1
Ending  
C
C
G
C
3
2
1
2
3
2
3
2
1
1
1
4
1
1 Press the STYLE CONTROL “COUNTRY” button.  
Enabling tempo display above Style name  
You can select whether the tempo is displayed above the Style name or not.  
1
2
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB [][®] CONFIG 2  
Select the [B] (2 DISPLAY STYLE TEMPO) button, and use the [5π†]/[6π†] buttons to switch the tempo dis-  
play on/off.  
• ON:  
Tempo is displayed above the Style name.  
With the default settings, the Display Style Tempo function is on.  
• OFF:  
Tempo is not displayed above the Style name.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
2 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a Style “CountryPop.”  
• The Style type and its defining characteristics are indicated above the Preset Style name. For details on the character-  
n
• When the [7  
π] (REPERTOIRE) button is pressed after selecting a Style, you can call up the custom panel settings (for  
voices and tempos, etc.) designed to best match the selected Style. To return to the previous display, press the [EXIT]  
button.  
You can instantly jump back to the original display by “double-clicking” on one of the [A]–[J] buttons.  
3 Press the [ACMP ON/OFF] button to turn on Auto Accompaniment.  
Use the left-hand section (lower part) of the keyboard to play the chords for sounding the Auto Accompaniment.  
3
4
5
6
4 Press the [SYNC START] button to set Auto Accompaniment to standby—letting you  
simultaneously start the accompaniment as soon as you start playing.  
5 As soon as you play a chord with your left hand, the Auto Accompaniment starts.  
Try playing chords with your left hand and play a melody with your right hand.  
n Chord Fingerings  
There are seven different fingering methods you can use to specify chords (page 107).  
6 Automatically play an appropriate ending by pressing the [ENDING] button, at the  
When Ending playback is finished, the Style automatically stops.  
About the various Styles  
n
Refer to the Style List in the separate Data List booklet.  
Quickly changing the Style tempo during a performance (Tap function)  
The tempo can also be changed during playback by tapping the [TAP TEMPO] button twice at the desired tempo.  
Specifying the split point (the border between the right- and left-hand range)  
Turns touch response on/off for the Style playback (Style Touch)  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
This lets you adjust the volume balance between Style playback and the sound you play on the keyboard.  
1 Call up the Main display.  
[DIRECT ACCESS] [EXIT]  
n
The Balance display is indicated at the bottom of the Main display. If the Balance display is not selected, press the [EXIT] button.  
2 To adjust the Style volume, press the [2π†] button. To adjust the keyboard (RIGHT 1) volume, press the [6π†]  
button.  
Pattern Variation  
While you play, you can automatically add specially created intros and endings, as well as variations in the rhythm/  
chord patterns, for more dynamic, professional-sounding performances. There are several different auto accompani-  
ment pattern variations for each situation: starting your performance, during your performance, and ending your per-  
formance. Try out the variations and combine them freely.  
To Start Playing  
Start/Stop  
Styles start playing back as soon as the STYLE CONTROL [START/STOP] button is pressed.  
Intro  
This is used for the beginning of the song. Each preset Style features three different intros. When the intro finished play-  
ing, accompaniment shifts to the Main section (see “Main” in the “During Style playback” below).  
Press one of the INTRO [I]–[III] buttons before starting Style playback and press the STYLE CONTROL [START/STOP]  
button to start Style playback.  
Synchro Start  
This lets you start playback as soon as you play the keyboard.  
Press the [SYNC START] button when Style playback is stopped and play a chord in the chord section of the keyboard  
to start Style playback.  
Tap  
Tap out the tempo and automatically start the Style at that tapped speed. Simply tap (press/release) the [TAP TEMPO]  
button (four times for a 4/4 time signature), and the Style playback starts automatically at the tempo you tapped.  
n The particular drum sound and the velocity (loudness) of the sound when the Tap function is used can be selected in the following  
display.  
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB[] CONFIG 1 [B] 4 TAP  
Fade In  
For information on the settings, see page 191.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
During Style Playback  
Main  
This is used for playing the main part of the Song. It plays an accompaniment pattern of several measures, and repeats  
indefinitely. Each preset Style features four different patterns.  
Press one of the MAIN [A]–[D] buttons during Style playback.  
Fill In  
The fill-in sections let you add dynamic variations and breaks in the rhythm of the accompaniment, to make your per-  
formance sound even more professional.  
Turn on the [AUTO FILL IN] button before starting Style playback or during playback. Then, simply press one of the  
MAIN VARIATION (A, B, C, D) buttons as you play, and the selected fill-in section plays automatically (AUTO FILL), spic-  
ing up the auto accompaniment. When the fill-in is finished, it leads smoothly into the selected main section (A, B, C, D).  
Even when [AUTO FILL IN] button is turned off, pressing the same button of the currently playing section automatically  
plays a fill-in before returning to the same main section.  
Break  
This lets you add dynamic breaks in the rhythm of the accompaniment, to make your performance sound even more  
professional.  
Press the [BREAK] button during Style playback.  
To Finish Playing  
Start/stop  
Styles stop as soon as the STYLE CONTROL [START/STOP] button is pressed.  
Ending  
This is used for the ending of the Song. Each preset Style features three different endings. When the ending is finished,  
the Style stops automatically.  
Press one of the ENDING/rit. [I]–[III] buttons during Style playback. You can have the ending gradually slow down  
(ritardando) by pressing the same ENDING/rit. button again while the ending is playing back.  
n If you press the ENDING/rit. [I] button in the middle of your performance, a fill-in automatically plays before the ENDING/rit. [I].  
Fade Out  
For information on the settings, see page 191.  
Others  
Synchro Stop  
When Synchro Stop is on, you can stop and start the Style anytime you want by simply releasing or playing the keys (in  
the chord section of the keyboard). This is a great way to add dramatic breaks and accents to your performance.  
Press the [SYNC STOP] button before starting the Style playback.  
Enable Synchro Stop by pressing/releasing keys (Synchro Stop Window)  
n
Fixing the section pattern to either Intro or Main (Section Set)  
For example, you can set this function to Intro to conveniently have an Intro play automatically whenever you select a Style (page 110).  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
About the section button (INTRO/MAIN/ENDING, etc.) lamps  
• Green  
The section is not selected.  
• Red  
The section is currently selected.  
• Off  
The section contains no data and cannot be played.  
Learning How to Play (Indicate) Chords for Style Playback  
Learning the Notes to Play for Certain Chords  
If know the name of a chord but don’t know how to play it, you can have the instrument show you the notes to play  
(Chord Tutor function).  
1 Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [C] STYLE SETTING/SPLIT POINT/CHORD FINGERING TAB[][®] CHORD FINGERING  
π†  
2 Press the [6  
] button to select the root note.  
2 3  
π†  
π†  
] button to select the chord type.  
3 Press the [7  
]/[8  
The notes you need to play to make the selected chord are shown in the display.  
n The notes that are displayed correspond to Fingered, no matter which fingering type is selected (page 108).  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Checking How to Play Chords with the Guide Lamps  
For Songs containing chord data, you can have the individual notes of the chords indicated with the Guide lamps on  
the instrument.  
2 Press the [FUNCTION] button and press the [B] button to call up the Song Setting dis-  
play, and make sure that the GUIDE MODE is set to “Follow Lights.”  
3 Press the [ACMP ON/OFF] button to turn on Auto Accompaniment.  
4 Press the [GUIDE] button.  
5 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start playback.  
The Guide lamps in the chord section of the keyboard flash according to the chords of the Song. Try practic-  
ing the chords, matching the Guide lamps.  
Appropriate Panel Settings for the Selected Style (One Touch  
Setting)  
One Touch Setting is a powerful and convenient feature that automatically calls up the most appropriate panel settings  
(Voices or effects, etc.) for the currently selected Style, with the touch of a single button. If you’ve already decided  
which Style you wish to use, you can have One Touch Setting automatically select the appropriate Voice for you.  
2 Press one of the ONE TOUCH SETTING [1]–[4] buttons.  
Not only does this instantly call up all the  
settings (Voices, effects, etc.) that match the  
current Style—it also automatically turns on  
ACMP and SYNC START, so that you can  
immediately start playing the Style.  
3 As soon as you play a chord with your left hand, the selected Style starts.  
n Parameter Lock  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Helpful hints for using One Touch Setting  
Automatically changing One Touch Settings with the Main sections (OTS Link)  
The convenient OTS (One Touch Setting) Link function lets you automatically have One Touch Settings change when  
you select a different Main section (A–D).To use the OTS Link function, press the [OTS LINK] button.  
n Setting the timing for OTS changes  
The One Touch Settings can be set to change with the sections in one of two different timings (page 110).  
Memorizing the panel settings to the OTS  
You can also create your own One Touch Setting setups.  
1 Set up the panel controls (such as Voice, Style, effects,  
and so on) as desired.  
2 Press the [MEMORY] button.  
3 Press one of the ONE TOUCH SETTING [1]–[4] buttons.  
A message appears in the display prompting you to save  
the panel settings.  
It is possible to save the panel settings with another file  
(step 4), so register it in a favorite number from 1 to 4.  
2
3
4 Press the [F] (YES) button to call up the Style selection  
CAUTION  
The panel settings memorized to each OTS button will be lost if you change the Style or turn the power off without  
executing the Save operation.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Calling Up Ideal Setups for Each Song—Music Finder  
If you want to play in a certain genre of music but don’t know which Style and Voice settings would be  
appropriate, the convenient Music Finder function can help you out. Simply select the desired music genre  
from among the Music Finder “Records,” and the instrument automatically makes all appropriate panel set-  
tings to let you play in that music style.  
A new record can be created by editing the currently selected one (page 114).  
n The data (records) of the Music Finder are not the same as Song data and cannot be played back.  
1 Press the [MUSIC FINDER] button to call up the MUSIC FINDER display.  
2
1
3
2 Press the TAB [] button to select the ALL tab.  
The ALL tab contains the preset records.  
3 Select the desired record by using the following four search categories.  
π†  
π†  
]/[3 ] buttons.  
To select a record, press the [2  
You can also select the desired record by using the [DATA ENTRY] dial, then press the [ENTER] button to execute.  
Searching the records  
n
The Music Finder is also equipped with a convenient search function that lets you enter a song title or keyword—and  
instantly call up all the records that match your search criteria (page 112).  
MUSIC ...............Contains the song title or music genre that describes each record, letting you easily  
find the desired music style.  
n Skipping up or down through the song alphabetically  
When sorting records by song title, use the [1π†] button to skip up or down through the songs  
alphabetically. Simultaneously press the [π†] buttons to move the cursor to the first record.  
STYLE.................This is the preset Style assigned to the record.  
n Skipping up or down through the Style alphabetically  
When sorting records by Style name, use the [4π†]/[5π†] button to skip up or down through the  
Styles alphabetically. Simultaneously press the [π†] buttons to move the cursor to the first record.  
BEAT ..................This is the time signature registered to each Record.  
TEMPO ..............This is the assigned tempo setting for the record.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
4 Play the keyboard.  
Notice that the panel settings have been automatically changed to match the music genre of the selected record.  
Tempo Lock  
n
Tempo Lock function lets you avoid changing the Tempo during Style playback when selecting another record. To turn on the  
Tempo Lock function, press the [I] (TEMPO LOCK) button in the Music Finder display.  
Parameter Lock  
Calling up the panel settings to match the Style (Rep-  
ertoire)  
The convenient Repertoire function automatically calls up the most appropriate panel settings (voice number, etc.) for  
the currently selected Style.  
1 Select the desired Style for which you want to call up the panel settings from the  
“PRESET”/“USER” tab on Style selection display.  
n The Repertoire function is valid for Styles in the “PRESET”/“USER” tab. The Repertoire function cannot be used for Styles  
saved to a USB storage device. To use the Repertoire function, save the desired Style in “USER” tab.  
π
2 Press the [7 ] (REPERTOIRE) button.  
The panel settings that match the Style under selection is searched according to the record group of the  
Music Finder. The list of the search results is shown on the “SEARCH 2” display of the Music Finder.  
CAUTION  
When the result of searching the record in the “SEARCH 2” display has already been shown, the searched result is  
lost.  
π†  
3 Press the [2  
π†  
]–[3 ] buttons to select the desired panel settings.  
Sorting the records  
Press the [F] (SORT BY) button to sort the records.  
• MUSIC .................. The record is sorted by song title.  
• STYLE.................... The record is sorted by Style name.  
• BEAT ..................... The record is sorted by beat.  
• TEMPO ................. The record is sorted by tempo.  
Changing the order of the records  
Press the [G] (SORT ORDER) button to change the order of the records (ascending or descending).  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Singing Along with Song Playback (Karaoke) or  
Your Own Performance  
Connect a microphone to the instrument and sing along with Song playback (Karaoke) or your own perfor-  
mance.  
The lyrics can be displayed when the Song contains lyric data. Sing with the microphone as you read the lyr-  
ics shown in the display. Lyrics can also be displayed with the music score, letting you play and sing while fol-  
lowing along with the notation and lyrics.  
Connecting a Microphone  
1 Make sure you have a conventional dynamic microphone.  
2 Set the [INPUT VOLUME] knob on the bottom panel of the instrument to the minimum  
position.  
3 Connect the microphone to the [MIC./LINE IN] jack.  
n Always set the INPUT VOLUME to minimum when nothing is con-  
nected to the [MIC/LINE IN] jack. Since the [MIC/LINE IN] jack is  
highly sensitive, it may pick up and produce noise when nothing is  
connected.  
2, 5  
3 4  
4 Set the [MIC. LINE] switch to “MIC.”  
5 (For microphones having a power source, turn on the power first.) Adjust the [INPUT  
VOLUME] knob while singing into the microphone.  
Adjust the controls while checking the SIGNAL and OVER lamps. The SIGNAL  
lamp lights to indicate that an audio signal is being received. Make sure to  
adjust the INPUT VOLUME so that this lamp is light. The OVER lamp lights  
when the input level is too high. Make sure to adjust the INPUTVOLUME so  
that this lamp does not light.  
Disconnecting the microphone  
1
Set the [INPUT VOLUME] knob on the bottom panel of the instrument to the minimum position.  
2 Disconnect the microphone from the [MIC./LINE IN] jack.  
n Set the [INPUT VOLUME] knob to the minimum position before turning off the power.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Singing with the Lyrics Display  
Try singing while playing back a Song containing lyric data  
2 Press the [LYRICS/TEXT] button to display the lyrics.  
When the Text display appears, press the [1] (LYRICS) button to display the lyrics.  
3 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start playback.  
Sing while following along with the lyrics on the display. The color of the lyrics changes as the Song plays.  
4 Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop playback.  
When the lyrics are unreadable  
n
You may need to change the Lyrics Language setting to “International” or “Japanese” in the Song Setting display ([FUNCTION] [B]  
SONG SETTING), if the lyrics shown are garbled or unreadable.This setting can be memorized as part of the Song data (page 162).  
Changing the Lyrics Background Picture  
You can change the background picture of the Lyrics display. Press the [7π†]/[8π†] (BACKGROUND) button in the Lyrics dis-  
play to call up the Lyrics picture selection display for the available picture files and select the desired one. Press the [EXIT] button  
to return to the previous display.  
The lyrics background picture can be saved to the Song (page 162).  
Changing the lyrics  
Displaying Text  
This feature lets you show text files (created on a computer) in the display of the instrument, enabling various  
useful possibilities, such as the showing of lyrics, chord names, and text notes.  
1
2
Connect the USB storage device containing the text file to [USB TO DEVICE] terminal.  
Press the [LYRICS/TEXT] button to display the text.  
When the lyrics are displayed, press the [1] (TEXT) button to display the text.  
3
4
5
Press the [5π†]/[6π†] (TEXT FILE) buttons to call up the Text selection display.  
Press the TAB [][®] buttons to select the desired TAB.  
Double-click one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a text file.  
If the text is long, use the TAB [ ][ ] buttons to select other pages.  
®
The following additional settings are available in the TEXT display:  
LYRICS ..........................................Switches the screen to the Lyrics display.  
CLEAR...........................................Clears the text from the display (the text data itself is not erased).  
FIXED 16-PROPORTIONAL 28.....Determines the text type (fixed or proportional) and font size.  
TEXT FILE......................................Opens the Text selection display.  
BACK GROUND...........................Allows changing of the background picture of the text display, as in the Lyrics  
display described above. The background setting is common for both the Lyr-  
ics display and Text display.  
• The text file, which is copied in the USER tab can be showed.  
n
• Line feed (or “carriage return”) is not automatically performed in the instrument. If a sentence is not displayed in its  
entirety because of limitations in the screen space, execute the line feed on your computer.  
• When the background color is specified in the song data, the BACKGROUND setting cannot be changed.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Displaying the lyrics/text on an external TV, video, or computer monitor  
The lyrics/text indicated on the display can also be output via the VIDEO OUT/RGB OUT terminal.  
1
Use an appropriate cable to connect the [VIDEO OUT]/[RGB OUT] con-  
nector of the instrument to the video input connector on theTV/computer  
monitor.  
2 Set the external television, video, or computer monitor signal (NTSC,  
PAL, or RGB) used by your video equipment, if necessary.  
1 Call up the operation display.  
TV monitor  
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB [][®] SCREEN OUT  
2
Press the [1π†] button to select the external television, video, or com-  
puter monitor signal.  
computer monitor  
Convenient Functions for Karaoke  
Adjusting the tempo  
Transpose  
See below.  
See below.  
Applying Effects to Your Voice  
Adding Harmony Vocals to Your Voice  
Practicing Singing with Proper Pitch (Vocal CueTIME)  
Transpose  
You can use this to adjust the key of the Song if it is too high or low.  
• Transposing the Song key up................ Press the TRANSPOSE [+] button.  
• Transposing the Song key down........... Press the TRANSPOSE [–] button.  
• Resetting the transposition ................... Press the TRANSPOSE [+][–] buttons simultaneously.  
Applying Effects to Your Voice  
You can also apply various effects to your voice.  
1 Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [G] MIC SETTING/VOCAL HARMONY  
π†  
2 Press the [4  
π†  
]/[5 ] buttons to turn the effect on.  
n Selecting an effect type  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Adding Harmony Vocals to Your Voice  
You can also automatically apply various harmony vocals to your voice.  
If the Song contains this data, the current chord name will be displayed in the Main display during Song  
playback, letting you easily check whether the Song contains chord data or not.  
2 Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [G] MIC SETTING/VOCAL HARMONY  
π†  
3 Press the [6  
π†  
]/[7 ] buttons to turn the harmony vocals (Vocal Harmony) on.  
4
3
4 Press the [H] button to call up the Vocal Harmony selection display.  
5 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a Vocal Harmony type.  
For details on the Vocal Harmony types, refer to the separate Data List.  
6 Press the [ACMP ON/OFF] button to turn on Auto Accompaniment.  
7 Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button and sing into the microphone.  
The harmony is applied to your voice according to the chord data.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
You can adjust the volume balance between the Song playback and the microphone.  
1 Call up the Main display.  
[DIRECT ACCESS] [EXIT]  
n The Balance display is indicated at the bottom of the Main display.  
If the Balance display is not indicated, press the [EXIT] button.  
2 To adjust the microphone volume, press the [4π†] button.  
To adjust the Song volume, press the [1π†] button.  
Convenient Functions for Singing Along with Your  
Own Performance  
Changing the Key (Transpose)  
See below.  
Displaying the Music Score on the Instrument and the Lyrics and Text on external monitor  
Making Announcements Between Songs  
Controlling Playback Timing by Your Voice (Karao-Key)  
Changing the Key (Transpose)  
You can match both the Song and your keyboard performance to a certain key. For example, the Song data is in F, but  
you feel most comfortable singing in D, and you are accustomed to playing the keyboard part in C. To match up the  
keys, set the Master Transpose to “0,” the Keyboard Transpose to “2,” and the Song Transpose to “-3.” This brings the  
keyboard part up and the song data down to your desired singing key.  
1 Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [D] CONTROLLER TAB [®] KEYBOARD/PANEL [B] TRANSPOSE ASSIGN  
π†  
2 Press the [4  
π†  
] button to select the desired transpose type.  
]/[5  
The following types are available. Select the one most suited to your purpose.  
KEYBOARD  
Transpose pitch of the keyboard played Voices and Style playback (controlled by what you play in the chord  
section of the keyboard).  
SONG  
Transposes the pitch of Song playback.  
MASTER  
Transpose the overall pitch of the instrument.  
3 Press the TRANSPOSE [–]/[+] button to transpose.  
You can set the value in semitone steps.  
To reset the transpose value, press the [+][–] buttons simultaneously.  
4 Press the [EXIT] button to close the TRANSPOSE display.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Displaying the Music Score on the Instrument and the Lyrics  
and Text on external monitor  
This convenient sing-along function lets you have the music score shown on the display of the instrument (for your  
playing purposes), while only the lyrics are shown on a separate external monitor (page 56) so your audience can sing  
along.  
1 Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB [][®] SCREEN OUT  
π
π
2 Press the [3 ]/[4 ] button to select LYRICS.  
Making Announcements Between Songs  
This function is ideal for making announcements between your singing performances. When singing a song, several  
effects are usually assigned to the MIC Setup. When speaking to your audience, however, these effects may sound dis-  
turbing or unnatural. Whenever the TALK function is turned on, effects are automatically turned off.  
1 Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [G] MIC SETTING/VOCAL HARMONY  
π
π
2 Press the [2 ]/[3 ] (TALK) button to turn the function on.  
n Talk settings can be customized as well, allowing you to add any desired effects to your voice as you speak to your audi-  
2
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Recording Your Performance as Audio (USB  
Audio Recorder)  
Here you’ll learn how to record your performance as audio data to a USB flash memory. For example, by connecting a  
guitar, microphone or other device to the instrument, you can record an ensemble performance of guitar and keyboard  
together or record yourself singing along with Song playback. The performance data is saved as a WAV file of conven-  
tional CD quality (44.1 kHz/16 bit). Since it is possible to play back the file on computer, a listener doesn’t need to  
have the particular instrument in order to hear the performance. This makes it possible to easily share your perfor-  
mances and recordings with your friends via e-mail, record your own CDs, or upload the recordings to websites for  
many others to enjoy as well.  
Recording methods on the instrument include MIDI recording as well as audio recording. For details about the differ-  
ence between audio and MIDI recording, see page 196. For specific instructions on MIDI recording, refer to page 200.  
• When recording with the USB Audio Recorder function, make sure to use an appropriate USB flash memory device.  
n
• In order to record your own original CD, you’ll need a CD-R drive (or compatible device). Refer to the manual that came with your  
specific computer for details.  
• When you attach a recorded file in an e-mail message, make sure the file size is small enough to be sent.  
The following sounds can be recorded.  
• Internal tone generator of the instrument.  
Keyboard parts (Right 1, Right 2, Left), Song parts, Style parts  
• Input from a microphone, guitar or other instrument (via the [MIC./LINE IN] jack).  
• Input from another audio device, such as a CD player, MP3 player or the like (via the [MIC./LINE IN] jack).  
n Songs protected by copyright, such as preset songs, and the metronome sound cannot be recorded. Moreover, the effect of the  
soundboad is not reflected in the recording.  
Also, the Sustain Samples, which simulate resonance of piano strings with the damper pedal down, cannot be recorded when the  
iAFC effect (page 82) is on. If you want to record the Sustain Samples, turn the iAFC effect off.  
The recorded data using this function is saved as:  
• Stereo WAV data  
• 44.1 kHz sample rate/16 bit resolution  
Recording Your Performance as Audio  
Now, try recording a performance of your singing along with Song playback with a connected microphone. The maxi-  
mum amount of recording time is 80 minutes, though this may differ depending on the capacity of the particular USB  
flash memory.  
1 Set the desired Voice, etc. which you want to use for your performance, and connect  
a microphone. (For information on setting the Voice, see page 28; for connecting a  
Here, you’ll also see by example how to sing along with accompaniment/Style playback. To set the Style, go  
on to step 6 (page 46).  
2 Connect the USB flash memory to the [USB TO DEVICE] terminal.  
To record your performance by USB Audio Recorder, use the compatible USB flash memory. When the USB flash  
n
memory is not compatible, it is not likely to be able to record/playback normally.  
• Before using a USB flash memory, be sure to read “Handling the USB Storage Device (USB Flash Memory/Floppy  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
3 Press the [USB] button.  
3
4
4 Press the [E] (USB AUDIO RECORDER) button to call up the recording display  
(USB AUDIO RECORDER display).  
5 If necessary, press the [E] (PROPERTY) button to call up the Property display, then  
check the information of the USB flash memory.  
5
6, 7  
8
The following information is indicated on the PROPERTY display.  
• DRIVE NAME ...................................... Number of the USB storage device (USB 1, USB 2, etc.)  
• ALL SIZE.............................................. Size of USB storage device  
• FREE AREA........................................... Available recording space on the USB storage device  
• POSSIBLE TIME.................................... Available time for recording  
Press the [F] (OK)/[EXIT] button to close the PROPERTY display.  
n The USB storage device of “USB1” is selected as the recording destination when multiple USB storage devices are connected. If a  
floppy disk drive is assigned to “USB1,” “USB1” will be skipped. To check the number of the USB storage device (USB1 and USB2,  
etc.), press the [A]/[B]/[F] button on the display of step 4, and change the tab. Press the [EXIT] button to return to the previous display.  
6 Start recording by pressing the [J] (REC) button, then start your performance.  
When recording begins, the “RECORDING” indication on the display changes to red, and the elapsed  
recording time is displayed.  
CAUTION  
Avoid frequently connecting/disconnecting the USB flash memory, or turning the power on/off too often. Doing so  
may corrupt the USB flash memory data or the recording data.  
7 Stop recording by pressing the [J] (STOP) button.  
The file name is automatically named (and is always given a new, unique name), and a message indicating  
the file name is displayed.  
n The recording operation continues, even if you close the Recording display by pushing the [EXIT] button. To stop the  
recording, press the [J] (STOP) button on the Recording display.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playing Back the Recorded Performance  
Play back the recorded performance.  
1 Call up the USB AUDIO RECORDER display.  
[USB] [E] (USB AUDIO RECORDER).  
π†  
π†  
] (AUDITION) button to display the audio files (WAV data)  
2
Press the [7  
]/[8  
saved to the connected USB flash memory.  
The file recorded is selected in step 1-7 (page 60). For information about the operation method to change the  
play” on page 68. However, the operation that copies/moves file/folder to the User tab cannot be done here.  
3 Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons corresponding to the file you want to listen to, then  
press the [8 ] (AUDITION) button.  
The song is played back from the beginning, and the display indicates the auditioning process. This display  
closes automatically when auditioning is stopped. Press the [G] (CANCEL) or [EXIT] button to stop audition-  
ing.  
CAUTION  
Avoid frequently connecting/disconnecting the USB flash memory, or turning the power on/off too often. Doing so  
may corrupt the USB flash memory data or the auditioning data.  
n Audio recording is processed internally so that playback volume will be appropriate when played on a computer. There-  
fore, the playback sound might be distorted if you record at too high a volume. In this case, lower and adjust the volume  
4 Press the [EXIT] button to return to the USB AUDIO RECORDER display shown in step 4  
of “Recording Your Performance as Audio” above.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Basic Operation  
Selecting Message Language  
You can select the desired language of the display messages.  
1
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB[][®] OWNER  
The language selected here is  
also used for various “Mes-  
sages” shown during operations.  
π†  
Use [4  
π†  
]/[5 ] (LANGUAGE) buttons to select the language.  
2
3
Press the [EXIT] button to return to the previous display.  
3
2
The Messages Shown in the Display  
A message (information or confirmation dialog) sometimes appears on the screen  
to facilitate operation. When the message appears, simply press the appropriate  
button.  
In this example, press the [F] (YES) button  
to start formatting the MEDIA (USB storage  
device such as USB flash memory/floppy  
disk, etc).  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Instant Selection of the Displays—Direct Access  
Instant Selection of the Displays—  
Direct Access  
With the convenient Direct Access function, you can instantly call up the desired  
display—with just a single additional button press.  
1
2
Press the [DIRECT ACCESS] button.  
A message appears in the display prompting you to press the appropriate  
button.  
Press the button corresponding to the desired setting display to  
instantly call up that display.  
Refer to the separate Data List for a list of the displays that can be called up  
with the Direct Access function.  
Example of calling up the Guide function display  
Press the [DIRECT ACCESS] button, then press the [GUIDE] button.  
1
2
Returning to the Main display  
You can conveniently return to the Main display from any other display by  
simply pressing the [DIRECT ACCESS] button, then the [EXIT] button.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Basic Displays (Main Display and File Selection Display)  
Basic Displays (Main Display and File  
Selection Display)  
There are two basic display types – Main and Selection. Here are explanations of  
each display segment and its basic operation.  
Main Display  
The Main display shows the current basic settings of the instrument such as the cur-  
rently selected Voice and Style, allowing you to see them at a single glance. The  
Main display is the one you’ll usually see when you play the keyboard.  
Returning to the Main display  
Heres a convenient way to  
return to the Main display from  
any other display: Simply press  
the [DIRECT ACCESS] button,  
then the [EXIT] button.  
)
7
8
9
!
1
4
5
2
3
6
1 Voice name  
• RIGHT 1 (indicated at the right edge):  
• RIGHT 2 (indicated at the right edge):  
When you select the RIGHT 1  
part,  
appears at the right of  
the Voice name.  
When you select the RIGHT 2  
part,  
the Voice name.  
appears at the right of  
• LEFT (indicated at the right edge):  
When the Left Hold function is ON, an “H” indication appears (page 86). Pressing one of  
the [A]–[C] and [F]–[H] buttons calls up theVoice Selection display for each part (page 32).  
When you select the LEFT part,  
®
appears at the left of theVoice  
name.  
2 Style name and related information  
Displays the currently selected Style name, time signature and tempo. Pressing the [D]  
button calls up the Style Selection display (page 45).  
3 Current chord name  
If the [ACMP ON/OFF] button is set to On, the chord specified in the chord section of the  
keyboard will be displayed.  
4 Song name and related information  
Displays the currently selected Song name, time signature and tempo.  
If the Song contains the chord data, the current chord name will be displayed in the “CHORD”  
segment (see 3 above). Pressing the [I] button calls up the Song Selection display (page 35).  
5 Registration Memory Bank name  
Displays the currently selected Registration Memory Bank name.  
Pressing the [J] button calls up the Registration Memory Bank Selection display (page 132).  
When the Freeze function is ON, an “F” indication appears (page 133).  
6 Volume Balance  
Displays the volume balance among the parts.  
Adjust the volume balance among the parts by using the [1π†]–[8π†] buttons.  
7 Transpose  
8 Tempo  
Displays the current tempo of the Song or Style.  
9 BAR (current position of the Song or Style)  
Displays the current position of the Song or bar and beat number from playback start of the Style.  
) Recording status of USB Audio recorder  
While recording, a “REC” indication appears.  
! Registration Sequence  
Appears when the Registration Sequence is active (page 134).  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Basic Displays (Main Display and File Selection Display)  
File Selection Display Configuration and Basic Operation  
The File Selection display appears when you press one of the buttons shown below. From here you can select  
Voices, Styles, and other data.  
VOICE category selection buttons  
SONG SELECT button  
STYLE category  
selection buttons  
REGIST BANK  
selection buttons  
File Selection Display Configuration  
• Location (drive) of data  
Preset  
Location where pre-programmed Location where recorded or  
(preset) data is stored. edited data is saved.  
User  
USB  
Location where data on USB storage device  
(USB flash memory/floppy disk, etc) is saved.  
Hereafter in this manual, any USB storage device such as USB flash memory/floppy disk, etc. will be referred to as “USB storage device.”  
• Data files and folders  
The data, both pre-programmed and your own original, are saved as “files.”  
You can drop files into a folder.  
Folder  
File  
Folder  
Icon  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Basic Displays (Main Display and File Selection Display)  
File Selection Display Basic Operation  
1
Select the file to which the  
data is saved.  
You can also select the specified  
file to which the data is to be  
saved by pressing the [USB]/  
[USER] buttons.  
[USB]/[USER] [A] SONG/[B]  
STYLE/[F] VOICE [A]–[J]  
3
4
3
3
2
1
2
Select the tab containing the desired file by using the TAB [  
buttons.  
][®]  
π
π
]
Select the page containing the desired file by using the [1 ]–[7  
π
π
π
π
buttons ([1 ]–[5 ] buttons for Voice, [1 ]–[6 ] buttons for Song  
and Style).  
3
4
Select the file. There are two ways to do so.  
• Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons.  
• Select the file by using the [DATA ENTRY] dial, then press the [ENTER]  
button to execute.  
Press the [EXIT] button to return to the previous display.  
Closing the current folder and calling up the next highest level  
folder  
To close the current folder and call up the next highest level folder, press  
the [8π] (UP) button.  
Example of the PRESET Voice Selection display  
The PRESET Voice files are categorized and contained in appropriate folders.  
This display shows the Voice files  
in a folder.  
The next highest level—in this case,  
folder—is shown. Each folder shown in  
this display contains appropriately cat-  
egorized Voices.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Basic Displays (Main Display and File Selection Display)  
File/Folder Operations in the File Selection  
Display  
• Saving Files.............................................................................................page 69  
• Copying Files/Folders (Copy & Paste).......................................................page 70  
• Moving Files (Cut & Paste).......................................................................page 71  
• Deleting Files/Folders..............................................................................page 71  
• Renaming Files/Folders............................................................................page 72  
• Selecting Custom Icons for Files (shown at the left of file name)..............page 72  
• Creating a New Folder ............................................................................page 72  
• Entering characters..................................................................................page 73  
Formatting USB storage media  
When a USB storage device is connected or media is inserted, a message  
may appear prompting you to format the device/media. If so, execute the  
format operation.  
CAUTION  
The format operation deletes any previously existing data. Make sure that the media  
you are formatting does not contain important data. Proceed with caution, espe-  
cially when connecting multiple USB storage medias.  
The indications USB 1, USB 2,  
etc. will be displayed depending  
on the number of the connected  
devices.  
1 Insert a USB storage device for formatting into the [USB TO  
DEVICE].  
2 Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB[][®]MEDIA  
3 Press the [A]/[B] button to select the “USB” Tabs (USB1/USB2) con-  
nected to the devices in step 1.  
4 Press the [H] button to format the media.  
3
4
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Basic Displays (Main Display and File Selection Display)  
Saving Files  
This operation lets you save your original data (such as Songs and Voices you’ve  
created) to a file.  
Internal memory (User tab  
displays) capacity  
The internal memory capacity of  
the instrument is about 3.2MB.  
This capacity applies to all file  
types, including Voice, Style,  
Song, and Registration data files.  
1
After you’ve created a Song or Voice in the relevant SONG CREATOR  
or VOICE SET display, press the [SAVE] display button.  
The File Selection display for the corresponding data appears. Keep in mind  
that the Save operation is executed from the File Selection display.  
2
3
Select the appropriate tab (USER/USB) to which you want to save the  
data by using the TAB [][®] buttons.  
Press the [6 ] (SAVE) button to call up the file naming display.  
4
5
π
Press the [8 ] (OK) button to save the file.  
If you want to cancel the Save operation, press the [8  
] (CANCEL) button.  
The saved file will be automatically located at the appropriate position  
among the files in alphabetical order.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Basic Displays (Main Display and File Selection Display)  
Restrictions for protected Songs  
Commercially available song data may be copy protected to prevent illegal  
copying or accidental erasure. They are marked by the indications at the  
upper left side of the file names. The indications and relevant restrictions  
are detailed below.  
Prot. 1  
Indicates Preset Songs saved to the User tab display, Disk Orchestra  
Collection (DOC) Songs, and Disklavier Piano Soft Songs. These  
cannot be copied/moved/saved to USB storage device.  
Prot. 2 Orig  
Prot. 2 Edit  
Indicates Yamaha-protection-formatted Songs. These cannot be  
copied. These can be moved/saved only to the USER tab display  
and USB storage device.  
Indicates edited “Prot. 2 Orig” Songs. Make sure to save these to  
the same folder containing the corresponding “Prot. 2 Orig” Song.  
These cannot be copied. These can be moved/saved only to the  
USER tab display and USB storage device.  
Note for “Prot. 2 Orig” and “Prot. 2 Edit” Song file operation  
Make sure to save the “Prot. 2 Edit” Song to the same folder containing its  
original “Prot. 2 Orig” Song. Otherwise the “Prot. 2 Edit” Song cannot be  
played back. Also, if you move a “Prot. 2 Edit” Song, be sure to move its  
original “Prot. 2 Orig” Song to the same location (folder) at the same time.  
Copying Files/Folders (Copy & Paste)  
This operation lets you copy a file/folder and paste it to another location (folder).  
1
2
Call up the display containing the file/folder you want to copy.  
Press the [3 ] (COPY) button to copy the file/folder.  
The pop-up window for the Copy operation appears at the bottom of the dis-  
play.  
3
Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons corresponding to the desired file/  
folder.  
To cancel the selection, press the same [A]–[J] button again.  
Selecting all files/folders  
Press the [6  
rent display including the other pages.  
To cancel the selection, press the [6  
] (ALL) button to select all files/folders indicated on the cur-  
] (ALL OFF) button again.  
4
5
6
Press the [7  
To cancel the Copy operation, press the [8  
] (OK) button to confirm the file/folder selection.  
] (CANCEL) button.  
Select the destination tab (USER/USB) to paste the file/folder, by  
using the TAB [][®] buttons.  
Press the [4 ] (PASTE) button to paste the file/folder.  
The folder/file copied and pasted appears on the display at the appropriate  
position among the files in alphabetical order.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Basic Displays (Main Display and File Selection Display)  
Moving Files (Cut & Paste)  
This operation lets you cut a file and paste it to another location (folder).  
1
2
Call up the display containing the file you want to move.  
Press the [2 ] (CUT) button to cut the file.  
The pop-up window for the Cut operation appears at the bottom of the dis-  
play.  
3
Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons corresponding to the desired file.  
To cancel the selection, press the same [A]–[J] button again.  
Selecting all files  
Press the [6] (ALL) button to select all files indicated on the current dis-  
play including the other pages.  
To cancel the selection, press the [6] (ALL OFF) button again.  
Press the [7 ] (OK) button to confirm the file selection.  
4
5
6
To cancel the Cut operation, press the [8] (CANCEL) button.  
Select the destination tab (USER/USB) to which the file is to be  
pasted, by using the TAB [][®] buttons.  
Press the [4 ] (PASTE) button to paste the file.  
The file moved and pasted appears on the display at the appropriate position  
among the files in alphabetical order.  
Deleting Files/Folders  
This operation lets you delete a file/folder.  
1
2
Call up the display containing the file/folder you want to delete.  
Press the [5 ] (DELETE) button.  
The pop-up window for the Delete operation appears at the bottom of the  
display.  
3
Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons corresponding to the desired file/  
folder.  
To cancel the selection, press the same [A]–[J] button again.  
Selecting all files/folders  
Press the [6  
rent display including the other pages.  
To cancel the selection, press the [6  
] (ALL) button to select all files/folders indicated on the cur-  
] (ALL OFF) button again.  
4
5
Press the [7] (OK) button to confirm the file/folder selection.  
To cancel the Delete operation, press the [8] (CANCEL) button.  
Follow the on-display instructions.  
YES........................Delete the file/folder  
YES ALL .................Delete all selected files/folders  
NO........................Leave the file/folder as is without deleting  
CANCEL ................Cancel the Delete operation  
Deleting all data in a USB  
storage device at once  
Formatting a USB storage device  
completely erases all data on the  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Basic Displays (Main Display and File Selection Display)  
Renaming Files/Folders  
This operation lets you rename files/folders.  
1
2
Call up the display containing the file/folder you want to rename.  
Press the [1 ] (NAME) button.  
The pop-up window for the Rename operation appears at the bottom of the  
display.  
3
4
Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons corresponding to the desired file/folder.  
Press the [7 ] (OK) button to confirm the file/folder selection.  
To cancel the Rename operation, press the [8 ] (CANCEL) button.  
5
6
The renamed folder/file appears on the display at the appropriate position  
among the files in alphabetical order.  
π
Press the [8 ] (OK) button to actually enter the new name.  
Selecting Custom Icons for Files (Shown at the  
Left of File Name)  
You can select custom icons for files (shown at the left of file name).  
1–4  
Operations are the same as the above “Renaming Files/Folders” section.  
5
6
Press the [1 ] (ICON) button to call up the ICON display.  
π† π†  
]–[5  
Select the icon by using the [A]–[J] buttons or [3  
The ICON display includes several pages. Press the TAB [  
] buttons.  
®] button to select  
different pages.  
To cancel the operation, press the [8] (CANCEL) button.  
π
Press the [8 ] (OK) button to apply the selected icon.  
7
8
π
Press the [8 ] (OK) button to actually enter the new name.  
Creating a New Folder  
This operation lets you create new folders. Folders can be created, named and  
organized as desired, making it easier to find and select your original data.  
A new folder cannot be made in  
the PRESET tab.  
1
2
Call up the page of the File Selection display for which you wish to  
create a new folder.  
Folder directories for the  
USER tab display  
Press the [7 ] (FOLDER) button to call up the naming display for a  
new folder.  
In the USER tab display, folder  
directories can contain up to  
four levels. The maximum total  
number of files and folders  
which can be stored is 2550, but  
this may differ depending on the  
length of the file names. The  
maximum number of files/folders  
which can be stored in a folder  
in the USER tab is 250.  
3
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Basic Displays (Main Display and File Selection Display)  
Entering Characters  
The instructions that follow show you how to enter characters in naming your files/  
folders and when entering the Keyword for Music Finder function/website. The  
method is much the same as entering names and numbers to a conventional  
mobile phone. Entering characters should be done in the display shown below.  
π
Change the type of character by pressing the [1 ] button.  
1
• If you select a language other than Japanese as the Language  
Depending on the display for  
character entry you are working  
in, some types of characters can-  
not be entered.  
CASE......................Alphabet (capital letters, half size), numbers (half  
size), marks (half size)  
case.......................Alphabet (lowercase letters, half size), numbers (half  
size), marks (half size)  
different types of characters and sizes can be entered:  
(kana-kan) ...Hiragana and Kanji, marks (full size)  
(kana) ............Katakana (normal size), marks (full size)  
(kana) ..............Katakana (half size), marks (half size)  
A B C.....................Alphabet (capital and small letters, full size), num-  
bers (full size), marks (full size)  
Even if you select Japanese as the  
Language, when you enter the  
characters in the lyrics editing  
Setting display (page 183), or  
website, the type of characters  
“CASE”/“case” may be entered.  
ABC.......................Alphabet (capital and small letters, half size), num-  
bers (half size), marks (half size)  
2
3
Use the [DATA ENTRY] dial to move the cursor to the desired position.  
π†  
Press the [2  
π†  
]–[6  
π
] and [7 ] buttons, corresponding to the  
character you wish to enter.  
For details on entering characters, refer to the following section, below  
instruction step 4.  
The following half-size marks  
cannot be entered for a file/  
folder name.  
\ / : * ? " < > |  
Entering password or WEP key of  
wireless LAN connection in the  
website, those characters are  
converted to “*“.  
Several different characters are assigned to each button, and the  
characters change each time you press the button.  
π
Press the [8 ] (OK) button to actually enter the new name and  
return to the previous display.  
4
Entering letters, numerals and symbols can be done by moving the cursor or  
pressing one of the character entry buttons. Alternately, you can wait for a  
short time and the characters will be entered automatically.  
• Deleting characters  
Move the cursor to the character you wish to delete by using the [DATA  
ENTRY] dial, and press the [7  
ters on the line at once, press and hold the [7  
] (DELETE) button. To delete all charac-  
] (DELETE) button.  
• Entering special character marks (Japanese “ ” and “ ”)  
Select a character to which a character mark is to be added and press  
the [6  
] button before actual entry of the character.  
In the case of characters which  
are not accompanied by special  
character marks (with the excep-  
tion of kanakan and half-size  
katakana), you can call up the  
• Entering marks  
1 After actually entering a character by moving the cursor, press the  
[6] button to call up the mark list.  
2 Use the [DATA ENTRY] dial to move the cursor to the desired mark,  
then press the [8 ] (OK) button.  
mark list by pressing the [6  
]  
π
button after selecting a charac-  
ter (before actual entry of a char-  
acter).  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Restoring the Factory-programmed Settings  
• Inserting a Character  
1 Move the cursor to the desired position.  
Use the same operation as in “Deleting Characters” above.  
2 Press the [2π†]–[6π†], [7  
π] buttons to enter numbers and sym-  
bols.  
3 Press the [8π] (OK) button to enter characters.  
• Entering a Space  
1 Move the cursor to the desired position.  
Use the same operation as in “Deleting Characters” above.  
2 Press [6  
3 Make sure the cursor is at the beginning space (blank) of the mark list,  
and press the [8 ] (OK) button.  
• Entering numbers  
] button to call up the mark list.  
π
First, select one of the following: “A B C” (full-size alphabet), “ABC”  
”CASE“ (half-size capital alphabet) and “case” (half-size lowercase  
alphabet). Then, press and hold down the appropriate button, [2π†]–  
[5π†], [6π] and [7π] button, for a while, or press it repeatedly until  
the desired number is selected.  
• Converting into Kanji (Japanese language)  
When the entered “hiragana” characters are shown in reverse display  
(highlighted), press the [1  
convert the characters into the appropriate kanji. To actually enter the  
change, press the [1 ]/[8 ] (OK) button or enter the next character.  
π]/[ENTER] button one or several times to  
π
When the entered “hiragana” characters are shown in reverse  
display (highlighted):  
• Re-converting the characters into other kanji  
Press the [1π]/[ENTER] button.  
• Changing the reversed area  
Use the [DATA ENTRY] dial.  
• Changing the converted kanji back to “hiragana”  
Press the [7  
• Clearing the reversed area at once  
Press the [8 ] (CANCEL) button.  
• Entering the “hiragana” itself (without converting it)  
Press the [8 ] (OK) button.  
• Canceling the character-entering operation  
Press the [8 ] (CANCEL) button.  
] (DELETE) button.  
π
Restoring the Factory-programmed  
Settings  
Restoring the Factory-programmed System  
The operation of restoring the  
factory-programmed settings  
does not affect the Internet Set-  
tings. To reset the Internet Set-  
While holding the C7 key (right-most key on the keyboard), turn the [POWER] but-  
ton ON.  
This operation has the same result as and is a shortcut for the System Setup restore  
operation explained in step 2 of the following section.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Restoring the Factory-programmed Settings  
Restoring the Factory-programmed Settings  
Independently by Item  
CAUTION  
1
2
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB[®]SYSTEM RESET  
This operation deletes all your  
original data for the respec-  
tive item (MIDI SETUP, USER  
EFFECT, MUSIC FINDER, and  
FILES&FOLDERS).  
π†  
π†  
]–[3 ] buttons.  
Select items by pressing the [1  
SYSTEM SETUP  
Restores the System Setup parameters to the original factory resettings.  
Refer to the separate Data List booklet for details about which parameters  
belong to the System Setup.  
MIDI SETUP  
USER EFFECT  
Restores the MIDI settings including the MIDI templates on the User tab  
display to the original factory status.  
Restores the User Effect settings including the user effect types, user master  
EQ types, user master compressor types, and user vocal harmony types cre-  
ated via the Mixing Console display to the original factory resettings.  
MUSIC FINDER  
Restores the Music Finder data (all records) to the original factory resettings.  
FILES&FOLDERS Deletes all files and folders stored in the User tab display.  
REGIST  
Temporarily deletes the current Registration Memory settings of the  
selected Bank. The same can be done also by turning the [POWER] button  
ON while holding the B6 key (right-most B key on the keyboard).  
4
2
3
3
4
Checkmark the box of the item to be reset to the factory pro-  
π
grammed settings by pressing the [4 ] button.  
Press the [D] button to execute the Factory Reset operation for all  
checkmarked items.  
Saving and Recalling Your Original Settings as  
a Single File  
For the items below, you can save your Original Settings as a Single File for future recall.  
1
2
Make all desired settings on the instrument.  
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB[®]SYSTEM RESET  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Data Backup  
3
Press one of the [F]–[I] buttons to call up the relevant display for sav-  
ing your data.  
SYSTEM SETUP Parameters set on the various displays such as the [FUNCTION] UTILITY and  
microphone setting display are handled as a single System Setup file. Refer to the sep-  
arate Data List booklet for details on which parameters belong to the System Setup.  
MIDI SETUP  
The MIDI settings including the MIDI templates on the User tab display are  
handled as a single file.  
USER EFFECT  
The User Effect settings including the user effect types, user master EQ types,  
user master compressor types, and user vocal harmony types created via the  
Mixing Console displays are managed as a single file.  
MUSIC FINDER All the preset and created records of the Music Finder are handled as a single file.  
4
Select one of the tabs (other than the PRESET) by pressing the TAB  
][ ] buttons.  
[√  
®
Note that the file in the PRESET tab display is the file of factory-programmed  
settings. If you select it, the factory-programmed settings for the respective  
Factory-programmed Settings Independently by Item”.)  
5
6
To recall your file, select the tab and page to which you’ve saved the  
file (same tab and page as specified in step 4), and press the corre-  
sponding [A]–[J] button.  
Data Backup  
For maximum data security Yamaha recommends that you copy or save your  
important data to a USB storage device. This provides a convenient backup if the  
internal memory is damaged.  
Data that can be saved  
1 Song*, Style, Registration Memory Bank and Voice  
2 Music Finder Record, Effect**, MIDI Template and System File  
* Protected Songs (those with a “Prot.1/Prot.2” indication at the upper left of the file name)  
cannot be saved.  
However, Songs with a “Prot.2” indication can be moved (cut-and-paste operation)  
to a USB flash memory.  
**Effect data includes the following:  
- Edited or saved data in the Mixing Console “EFFECT/EQ/CMP.”  
- Edited or saved data of the Vocal Harmony type.  
3 All data listed in 1 and 2 above, as well as the Internet settings.  
The backup procedure is different for the data types in 1, 2, and 3 above.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Data Backup  
Backup procedure  
2 Music Finder Record, Effect, MIDI Tem-  
plate and System Data  
1 Song, Style, Registration Memory Bank  
and Voice Data  
1
Insert/connect the backup USB storage  
device (destination).  
1
2
Insert/connect the backup USB storage  
device (destination).  
2
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB [][®  
SYSTEM RESET  
]
Call up the display containing the desired  
file to be copied.  
3
4
Press one of the [F]–[I] buttons to call up  
the relevant display for saving your data.  
Song:  
Press the [SONG SELECT] button.  
Select the appropriate USB tab to which  
you want to save the data by using the  
Style:  
Press the STYLE category selection buttons.  
TAB [][®] buttons.  
Registration Memory Bank:  
Press simultaneously REGISTRATION MEM-  
ORY [REGIST BANK] buttons [+][–] .  
5
Voice:  
3 All data listed in 1 and 2 above  
Press one of the VOICE category selection but-  
tons.  
1
Insert/connect the backup USB storage  
device (destination).  
3
4
Select the USER tab by using the TAB  
[
][  
®
] buttons.  
2
3
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB [][®  
OWNER  
]
Press the [3 ] (COPY) button to copy the  
file/folder.  
The pop-up window for the Copy operation  
Press the [D] (BACKUP) button to save the  
data to the USB storage device.  
To restore the data, press the [E] (RESTORE)  
button in step 3 above.  
appears at the bottom of the display.  
• It takes a few minutes to complete the backup/restore  
operation.  
• Backup data which has not been created on the CGP-  
1000 cannot be restored.  
n
Press the [6 ] (ALL) button to select all  
files/folders indicated on the current dis-  
play and all other pages.  
5
6
To cancel the selection, press the [6  
] (ALL  
CAUTION  
OFF) button again.  
Move the Protected Songs which are saved to the USER dis-  
play before restoring. If the songs are not moved, the opera-  
tion deletes the data.  
Press the [7 ] (OK) button to confirm the  
file/folder selection.  
To cancel the Copy operation, press the [8  
]  
(CANCEL) button.  
7
8
Select the destination USB tab to which  
the file/folder is to be copied, by using the  
TAB [][®] buttons.  
Press the [4 ] (PASTE) button to paste  
the file/folder.  
If a message appears indicating data  
cannot be copied  
Protected Songs (“Prot. 1/Prot.2” is indicated  
at the upper left side of the file names) are  
included in the copied files. These protected  
Songs cannot be copied. However, Songs  
with a “Prot.2” indication can be moved (cut-  
and-paste operation) to a USB flash memory.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Using, Creating and Editing Voices  
Reference to Quick Guide pages  
Playing Voices ................................................................................ page 28  
Playing the Piano Voice........................................................... page 28  
Playing Various Voices............................................................. page 32  
Voice Characteristics  
The Voice type and its defining characteristics are indicated above the Preset Voice  
name.  
Natural!  
These rich and luscious Voices are comprised mostly of keyboard instrument  
sounds and are especially intended for playing piano and other keyboard parts.  
They also take full advantage ofYamaha’s advanced sampling technology such as  
Stereo Sampling, Dynamic Sampling, Sustain Sampling, and Key-off Sampling.  
S. Articulation! The Super Articulation voices sound remarkably authentic and natural, featuring  
the unique performance characteristics of each instrument—for example, guitar  
scratching sounds or the legato phrasing of wind instruments. They provide many  
of the same benefits as the MegaVoices (see below), but with greater playability  
and expressive control in real time. To effectively play these natural sounds in  
performance of certain voices, you may need to use the pedal or footswitch. For  
details on how to best play each voice, call up the Information window (pressing  
the [7  
π] button in the Voice Selection display).  
MegaVoice  
The MegaVoices are not intended to be played from the keyboard. They are  
primarily designed for use with recorded MIDI sequence data (such as songs  
and styles). Some of the guitar and bass Voices in particular have been cre-  
ated as MegaVoices.  
MegaVoices Compatibility  
MegaVoices are unique to the  
Clavinova and are not compati-  
ble with other models. Any song/  
style data you’ve created on the  
Clavinova using the MegaVoices  
will not sound properly when  
played back on other instru-  
ments.  
What makes MegaVoices special is their use of velocity switching. Normal  
Voices use velocity switching, too—to make the sound quality and/or level of a  
Voice according to how strongly or softly you play it. This makes the instrument’s  
Voices sound authentic and natural. However, with MegaVoices, each velocity  
range (the measure of your playing strength) has a completely different sound.  
For example, a Mega guitar Voice includes the sounds of various performance  
techniques. In conventional instruments, different Voices having those sounds  
would be called up via MIDI and played in combination to achieve the desired  
effect. However, now with MegaVoices, a convincing guitar part can be played  
with just a singleVoice, using specific velocity values to play the desired sounds.  
Because of the complex nature of these Voices and the precise velocities need to  
play the sounds, they’re not intended for playing from the keyboard. They are,  
however, very useful and convenient when creating MIDI data—especially when  
you want to avoid using several different Voices just for a single instrument part.  
Live!  
These acoustic instrument sounds were sampled in stereo, to produce a truly  
authentic, rich sound—full of atmosphere and ambience.  
Cool!  
These Voices capture the dynamic textures and subtle nuances of electric  
instruments—thanks to a huge amount of memory and some very sophisti-  
cated programming.  
Sweet!  
These acoustic instrument sounds also benefit from Yamaha’s sophisticated  
technology—and feature a sound so finely detailed and natural, you’ll swear  
you’re playing the real thing!  
Live!Drums  
Live!SFX  
These are high-quality drum sounds taking full advantage of Stereo Sampling  
and Dynamic Sampling.  
These are high-quality Latin percussion sounds taking full advantage of Stereo  
Sampling and Dynamic sampling. They give you a broader and more versatile  
range of Latin percussion than the normal drum Voices.  
Drums  
Various drum and percussion sounds are assigned to individual keys, letting  
you play the sounds from the keyboard.  
SFX  
Various special effect sounds are assigned to individual keys, letting you play  
the sounds from the keyboard.  
Organ Flutes!  
This authentic organ Voice lets you use the Voice Set to adjust the various foot-  
ages and craft your own original organ sounds. See page 103 for details.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                               
Playing Different Voices Simultaneously  
Playing Different Voices Simulta-  
neously  
The instrument keyboard features various functions and performance conveniences  
that are simply unavailable on an acoustic instrument. It allows you to play several  
differentVoices together in a layer, or play oneVoice with your left hand while you  
play a different Voice (or even two layered Voices!) with your right.  
Keyboard Parts (Right 1, Right 2, Left)  
Voices can be assigned independently to each keyboard part: Right 1, Right 2, and  
Left. You can combine these parts by using the PART ON/OFF buttons to create a  
rich, ensemble sound.  
Keyboard Part Combinations  
Playing a single Voice (Right 1 part)  
Adjusting the volume balance  
among parts  
Adjust the volume balance  
among the parts in the BALANCE  
You can play a single Voice over the entire keyboard range. This is used for nor-  
mal performance—for example, with the piano Voice.  
Make sure the PART ON/OFF [DUAL (RIGHT2)]/[SPLIT (LEFT)] buttons are  
turned off.  
Right 1 part  
Dual: Playing Two Voices Simultaneously (Right 1 and 2 parts)  
You can simulate a melody duet or combine two similarVoices to create a thicker sound.  
Right 2 part  
Right 1 part  
Refer to page 80 for Voice selection operations for the Right 2 part.  
Split: Playing Different Voices with the Left and Right Hands (Right 1 and  
Left parts)  
Specifying the split point (the  
border between the right-  
and left-hand range)  
You can play differentVoices with the left and right hands. For example, try play-  
ing the bass Voice with your left hand and the piano Voice with your right.  
The keyboard lamp will light at the split point of the keyboard.  
Left part  
Right 1 part  
Refer to page 81 for Voice selection operations for the Left part.  
Dual+Split: Playing Three Different Voices with the Left and Right Hands  
(Right 1, 2 and Left parts)  
You can combine these three parts to create a rich, ensemble sound.  
Right 2 part  
Left part  
Right 1 part  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                     
Playing Different Voices Simultaneously  
Playing Two Voices Simultaneously (Right 1  
and 2 Parts)  
You can play two Voices simultaneously with the Right 1 and 2 parts by turning  
Dual on.  
1
Press the PART ON/OFF [DUAL (RIGHT2)] button to play two Voices  
simultaneously with the Right 1 and 2 parts.  
For the selected part, a LEFT  
mark appears at the right of the  
Voice name in the Main display.  
2
Press one of the VOICE category selection buttons to call up the Voice  
selection display for the Right 2 part.  
Quickly selecting Voices for  
Right 1 and 2 parts  
You can quickly select the Right  
1 and 2 partVoices, just from the  
VOICE category selection but-  
tons. Press and hold one VOICE  
category selection button, then  
press another. The Voice of the  
first pressed button is automati-  
cally set for the Right 1 part,  
while the Voice of the second  
pressed button is set for the Right  
2 part.  
3
Press the TAB [] button to select the PRESET display.  
3
4
4
4
5
6
Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a Voice.  
Play the keyboard.  
Press the PART ON/OFF [DUAL (RIGHT2)] button again to turn it off.  
Switching the Dual on/off  
with a pedal  
You can use a pedal to switch the  
Dual on/off (when the PART ON/  
OFF [DUAL (RIGHT2)] is appro-  
is useful for turning the Dual on  
and off while you play.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Playing Different Voices Simultaneously  
Playing Different Voices with the Left and  
Right Hands (Right 1 and Left Parts)  
You can play different Voices with the Left and Right Hands (Right 1 and Left parts)  
by turning Split on.  
1
Press the PART ON/OFF [SPLIT (LEFT)] button to play different Voices  
with the Right and Left Hands (Right 1 and Left parts).  
For the selected part, a RIGHT  
mark appears at the left of the  
Voice name in the Main display.  
2
Press one of the VOICE category selection buttons to call up the Voice  
selection display for the Left part.  
3
Press the TAB [] button to select the PRESET display.  
3
4
4
4
5
6
Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a Voice.  
Play the keyboard.  
Switching the Split on/off  
with a pedal  
Press the PART ON/OFF [SPLIT (LEFT)] button again to turn it off.  
You can use a pedal to switch the  
Split on/off (when the PART ON/  
OFF [SPLIT (LEFT)] is appropri-  
useful for turning the Split on  
and off while you play.  
Specifying the split point (the  
border between the right-  
and left-hand range)  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Enhancing the Acoustic Realism of the Sound (iAFC)  
Enhancing the Acoustic Realism of  
the Sound (iAFC)  
When iAFC is engaged, the instrument will sound deeper and more resonant, similar  
to an acoustic musical instrument. This lets you experience the ambience and rever-  
beration that are characteristic of performing on stage or simulates the sustain sound  
that occur when you press the damper pedal of a grand piano.  
iAFC cannot be used in the  
following cases.  
• When the lid is closed or open  
with the shorter stay.  
• When the Speaker setting is  
and headphones are con-  
nected.  
This section describes how to make various settings for the iAFC function.  
• When the Speaker setting is  
Off.  
Adjusting the iAFC Depth  
The depth of the acoustic piano resonance simulation and stage ambience simula-  
tion can be set.  
iAFC uses Yamahas EMR (Elec-  
tronic Microphone Rotator) tech-  
nology to ensure stability against  
acoustic feedback.  
1
2
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [H] iAFC SETTING  
Press the [D] button to turn the iAFC on.  
2
3
4
π†  
Press the [3  
EFFECT depth.  
π†  
]/[4 ] buttons to adjust the DYNAMIC DAMPER  
3
• DYNAMIC DAMPER Effect  
This simulates the sustain sound that occurs when you press the damper  
pedal of a grand piano. The microphone is not used, but the sound pro-  
duced within the instrument is processed to create a spacious sensation.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Enhancing the Acoustic Realism of the Sound (iAFC)  
π†  
π†  
]/[6 ] buttons to adjust the SPATIAL EFFECT depth.  
4
Press the [5  
• SPATIAL EFFECT  
Spatial Effect creates a sense of reverberation and spaciousness by picking  
up the output sound using internal microphones and output the sound  
from the soundboard. The spread and spaciousness of the sound is differ-  
ent depending on the depth. The default setting for the depth is 30.  
For lower depth settings: This uses the built-in soundboard to create reso-  
nance and enhance the acoustic realism of the sound to give it the charac-  
teristics of actual acoustic instruments.  
Higher depth settings may cause  
audio feedback. If this happens,  
lower the depth to eliminate the  
feedback.  
For deeper depth settings: The sound of the instrument itself and the sound  
of singing and other instruments played nearby is picked up by internal  
microphones, and processed to simulate the spatial characteristics of per-  
forming together on stage.  
If the iAFC effect is slight or inaudible:  
If it seems that iAFC is not effective when playing back Songs or Styles, turn  
the iAFC feature off.  
1 Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [H] iAFC SETTING  
2 Press the [D] button to turn iAFC off.  
2
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Changing Pitch  
Changing Pitch  
Transpose  
Transpose the pitch of the keyboard up or down (in semitones).  
• Transposing during performance  
You can easily set the desired transposition of the overall sound of the instru-  
ment by pressing the TRANSPOSE [–]/[+] buttons.  
• Transposing before performance  
Change the transpose settings in the MIXING CONSOLE display. You can set the  
transposition for the keyboard pitch (KBD), song playback (SONG), or overall  
sound of the instrument (MASTER), respectively.  
1 Call up the operation display.  
[MIXING CONSOLE] TAB [][®] TUNE  
π†  
2 Use the [1  
π†  
]–[3 ] buttons to set the transposition.  
Fine-tuning the Pitch of the Entire Instrument  
Please note that the Tune func-  
tion does not affect the Drum Kit  
or SFX Kit Voices.  
You can fine-tune the pitch of the entire instrument—useful when you play the  
instrument along with other instruments or CD music.  
1
2
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [A] MASTER TUNE/SCALE TUNE TAB [] MASTER  
TUNE  
π†  
π†  
π
Use the [4  
Press the 4 or 5s [  
the factory resetting of 440.0 Hz.  
]/[5  
] buttons to set the tuning.  
] and [ ] buttons simultaneously to reset the value to  
Hz (Hertz):  
This unit of measurement refers  
to the frequency of a sound and  
represents the number of times a  
sound wave vibrates in a second.  
Scale Tuning  
You can select various scales for playing in custom tunings for specific historical  
periods or music genres.  
1
2
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [A] MASTER TUNE/SCALE TUNE TAB [®] SCALE TUNE  
Select the desired part for which you want to set the scale by using  
π†  
π†  
] buttons.  
the [6  
Checkmark the box by pressing the [8  
]/[7  
π
] button.  
3
Use the [A]/[B] buttons to select the desired scale.  
The tuning of each note for the currently selected scale is indicated in the  
keyboard illustration at the upper right of the display.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Changing Pitch  
4
Change the following settings as necessary.  
• Tuning the individual notes of the keyboard (TUNE)  
π†  
] button to select the note for tuning.  
1
2
Press the [3  
Use the [4  
Cent:  
π†  
π†  
]/[5 ] buttons to set the tuning in cents.  
In musical terms a “cent” is 1/  
100th of a semitone. (100 cents  
equal one semitone.)  
• Determines the base note for each scale.  
π†  
Press the [2  
] button to select the base note.  
When the base note is changed, the pitch of the keyboard is transposed,  
yet maintains the original pitch relationship between the notes.  
Instantly recalling the desired  
scale  
Register the desired scale to the  
Registration Memory. Be sure to  
checkmark the SCALE item when  
Preset Scale Types  
EQUAL  
The pitch range of each octave is divided equally into twelve parts, with  
TEMPERAMENT  
each half-step evenly spaced in pitch. This is the most commonly used  
tuning in music today.  
PURE MAJOR  
PURE MINOR  
These tunings preserve the pure mathematical intervals of each scale,  
especially for triad chords (root, third, fifth). You can hear this best in  
actual vocal harmonies – such as choirs and a cappella singing.  
PYTHAGOREAN  
This scale was devised by the famous Greek philosopher and is created  
from a series of perfect fifths, which are collapsed into a single octave.  
The 3rd in this tuning are slightly unstable, but the 4th and 5th are  
beautiful and suitable for some leads.  
MEAN-TONE  
This scale was created as an improvement on the Pythagorean scale, by  
making the major third interval more “in tune.” It was especially popu-  
lar from the 16th century to the 18th century. Handel, among others,  
used this scale.  
WERCKMEISTER  
KIRNBERGER  
This composite scale combines the Werckmeister and Kirnberger sys-  
tems, which were themselves improvements on the mean-tone and  
Pythagorean scales. The main feature of this scale is that each key has  
its own unique character. The scale was used extensively during the  
time of Bach and Beethoven, and even now it is often used when per-  
forming period music on the harpsichord.  
ARABIC  
Use these tunings when playing Arabic music.  
Tuning values for Preset Scales (base note: C) (in cents)  
#
b
#
b
b
B
C
C
D
E
E
F
F
G
A
A
B
EQUAL TEM-  
PERAMENT  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
-29.7 3.9  
15.6 -14.1 -2.3 -9.4  
15.6 -14.1 -2.3 31.3  
2.3 -27.3 -15.6 18.0 -11.7  
PURE MAJOR  
PURE MINOR  
PYTHAGOREAN  
MEAN-TONE  
WERCKMEISTER  
KIRNBERGER  
ARABIC 1  
33.6  
14.1  
3.9  
3.9  
2.3  
2.3  
14.1 -15.6 18.0 -11.7  
15.6 6.3 -3.9 10.2  
-6.3  
7.8  
-2.3 11.7  
-24.2 -7.0 10.2 -14.1 3.1 -20.3 -3.1 -27.3 -10.2 7.0 -17.2  
-10.2 -7.8 -6.3 -10.2 -2.3 -11.7 -3.9 -7.8 -11.7 -3.9 -7.8  
-10.2 -7.0 -6.3 -14.1 -2.3 -10.2 -3.1 -7.8 -10.2 -3.9 -11.7  
0
0
-50.0  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
-50.0  
0
0
0
0
-50.0  
-50.0  
ARABIC 2  
* In the display, the rounded off value is shown.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Adding Effects to Voices Played on the Keyboard  
Adding Effects to Voices Played on  
the Keyboard  
The instrument features a sophisticated multi-processor effect system which can  
add extraordinary depth and expression to your sound.  
1
2
Call up the operation display.  
[DIRECT ACCESS] [EXIT]  
Select the desired part for which you want to add effects by pressing  
one of the [A]–[C], [F]–[H] buttons.  
3
4
Press the [VOICE EFFECT] button to call up the VOICE EFFECT display.  
Use the buttons at the lower/right part of the display to apply effects  
to the Voices.  
Effect Parameters  
You can use a pedal to turn the  
Harmony/Echo effects on and off  
LEFT HOLD  
This function causes the LEFT part Voice to be held even when the keys are  
released. Non-decaying voices such as strings are held continuously, while decay-  
type voices such as piano decay more slowly (as if the sustain pedal has been  
pressed).  
Portamento:  
Portamento is a function that cre-  
ates a smooth transition in pitch  
from the first note played on the  
keyboard to the next. The porta-  
mento time (the pitch transition  
time) can be set via the MIXING  
CONSOLE display (page 90).  
HARMONY/  
ECHO  
The Harmony/Echo types are applied to the right-hand Voices (page 87).  
MONO/POLY This determines whether the parts Voice is played monophonically (only one note  
at a time) or polyphonically. Using the MONO mode lets you play single, lead  
sounds (such as brass instruments) more realistically. It also lets you expressively  
control the Portamento effect (depending on the selectedVoice) by playing legato.  
DSP:  
DSP/DSP  
VARIATION  
With the digital effects built into the instrument, you can add ambience and  
depth to your music in a variety of ways—such as adding reverb that makes  
you sound like you are playing in a concert hall.  
• The DSP switch is used to turn the DSP (Digital Signal Processor) effect on  
or off for the currently selected keyboard part.  
• The DSP Variation switch is used to change between variations of the DSP  
effect. You could use this while you play, for example, to change the rotat-  
ing speed (slow/fast) of the rotary speaker effect.  
Stands for Digital Signal Proces-  
sor (or Processing). DSP changes  
and enhances the audio signal in  
the digital realm to produce a  
wide range of effects.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                     
Adding Effects to Voices Played on the Keyboard  
Selecting the Harmony/Echo type  
You can select the desired Harmony/Echo effect from a variety of types.  
In order to make the type you’ve selected here effective, set HARMONY/ECHO to  
On in the display shown in step 4 above.  
1
2
Call up the operation display by pressing the [J] (TYPE SELECT) button.  
π†  
π†  
]–[3  
Use the [1  
(See below).  
] buttons to select the Harmony/Echo type  
π†  
Use the [4  
π†  
3
]–[8  
] buttons to select various Harmony/Echo set-  
The available settings differ depending on the Harmony/Echo type.  
Harmony/Echo Types  
The Harmony/Echo types are divided into the following groups, depending on the  
particular effect applied.  
Harmony Types  
These types apply the harmony effect  
to notes played in the right-hand sec-  
tion of the keyboard according to the  
chord specified in the left-hand sec-  
tion of the keyboard. (Note that the  
“1+5” and “Octave” settings are not  
affected by the chord.)  
Echo Types  
Multi Assign Type  
These types apply echo  
effects to notes played in  
the right-hand section of  
the keyboard in time with  
the currently set tempo.  
This type applies a special effect to  
chords played in the right-hand section  
of the keyboard.  
Harmony Types  
When one of the Harmony Types is selected, the Harmony effect is applied to notes  
played in the right-hand section of the keyboard according to the type selected  
above and the chord specified in the chord section of the keyboard shown below.  
Canceling the chord sound  
for the harmony effect  
This cancels the sound of the  
chord played in the chord range  
of the keyboard—letting you  
hear only the Harmony effect.  
Set [ACMP ON/OFF] to On, set  
[SYNC START] to Off, and select  
“Off” for the Stop Accompani-  
ment parameter.  
Split point  
Split point  
Chord section for Style playback and  
Harmony effect  
Left Voice and  
chord section for  
Harmony effect  
Right 1  
Right 2  
Voices  
Split Point  
(for Style)  
Split Point  
(for keyboard Voice)  
Chord section  
for Style  
playback and  
Harmony effect  
Right 1  
Right 2  
Voices  
Left Voice  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance (MIXING CONSOLE)  
Multi Assign Type  
Multi Assign effect automatically assigns notes played simultaneously in the right-hand  
section of the keyboard to separate parts (Voices). Both of the keyboard part [RIGHT  
1] and [RIGHT 2] should be turned on when using the Multi Assign effect. The Right 1  
and Right 2 Voices are alternately assigned to the notes in the order you play.  
Echo Types  
When one of the Echo Types is selected, the corresponding effect (echo, tremolo, trill) is  
applied to the note played in the right-hand section of the keyboard in time with the cur-  
rently set tempo, regardless of the [ACMP ON/OFF] and the LEFT part on/off status. Keep  
in mind that Trill works when you hold down two notes on the keyboard simultaneously  
(last two notes if more than two notes are held), and it plays those notes alternately.  
Harmony/Echo Settings  
VOLUME This parameter is available for all types with the exception of “MultiAssign.” It determines  
the level of the harmony/echo notes generated by the Harmony/Echo effect.  
SPEED  
This parameter is only available when Echo, Tremolo, or Trill is selected in Type  
above. It determines the speed of the Echo, Tremolo, and Trill effects.  
ASSIGN This parameter is available for all types with the exception of “Multi Assign.” This lets  
you determine the keyboard part via which the harmony/echo notes will be sounded.  
CHORD This parameter is available when one of the Harmony Types is selected. When this is set to  
NOTE  
ONLY  
“ON,” the Harmony effect is applied only to the note (played in the right-hand section of  
the keyboard) that belongs to a chord played in the chord section of the keyboard.  
TOUCH  
LIMIT  
This parameter is available for all types with the exception of “MultiAssign.” It determines  
the lowest velocity value at which the harmony note will sound. This allows you to selec-  
tively apply the harmony by your playing strength, letting you create harmony accents in the  
melody. The harmony effect is applied when you play the key strongly (above the set value).  
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance  
(MIXING CONSOLE)  
The Mixing Console gives you intuitive control over aspects of the keyboard parts  
and Song/Style channels, including volume balance and the timbre of the sounds.  
It lets you adjust the levels and stereo position (pan) of each Voice to set the opti-  
mum balance and stereo image, and lets you set how the effects are applied.  
Basic Procedure  
1
Press the [MIXING CONSOLE] button to call up the MIXING CON-  
SOLE display.  
2
1,3  
4
4
5
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance (MIXING CONSOLE)  
2
3
Use the TAB [][®] buttons to call up the relevant setting display.  
For information on the available parameters, see the section “Adjustable  
items (parameters) in the MIXING CONSOLE displays” on page 90.  
About Parts  
See below.  
Press the [MIXING CONSOLE] button repeatedly to call up the MIX-  
ING CONSOLE display for the relevant parts.  
The MIXING CONSOLE displays actually consist of several different  
part displays. The part name is indicated at the top of the display. The  
various MIXING CONSOLE displays alternate among the following:  
PANEL PART display STYLE PART display SONG CH 1–8 display →  
SONG CH 9–16 display  
4
5
6
Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select the desired parameter.  
π†  
Use the [1  
π†  
]–[8 ] buttons to set the value.  
Instantly setting all parts to  
the same value  
Save your MIXING CONSOLE settings.  
Once you’ve selected a parame-  
ter in step 4, you can instantly  
set the same value to all other  
parts. To do this, simultaneously  
hold down one of the [A]–[J] but-  
tons, and use the [1]–[8] buttons  
or the [DATA ENTRY] dial.  
• Saving the PANEL PART display settings  
Register them to Registration Memory (page 131).  
• Saving the STYLE PART display settings  
Save them as Style data.  
1 Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [F] DIGITAL REC MENU [B] STYLE CREATOR  
2 Press the [EXIT] button to close the RECORD display.  
3 Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Style Selection display for sav-  
ing your data, then save it (page 69).  
• Saving the SONG CH 1–8/9–16 display settings  
First register the edited settings as part of the Song data (SET UP), then save  
the Song.  
See the SONG CREATOR CHANNEL display SETUP item explana-  
About Parts  
PANEL PART  
In the PANEL PART display of the MIXING CONSOLE, you can indepen-  
dently adjust the level balance among the Keyboard parts (RIGHT 1, RIGHT  
2 and LEFT), SONG, STYLE, and MIC parts. The part components are the  
same as those that appear in the display when you press the panel [BAL-  
STYLE PART  
A Style consists of eight separate channels. Here you can adjust the level  
balance among these eight channels or parts. These part components are the  
same as those that appear in the display when you press the panel [CHAN-  
NEL ON/OFF] button to call up the STYLE display.  
SONG CH 1–8/9–16  
A Song consists of sixteen separate channels. Here you can adjust the level  
balance among these sixteen channels or parts. These part components are  
the same as those that appear in the display when you press the panel  
[CHANNEL ON/OFF] button to call up the SONG display.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance (MIXING CONSOLE)  
Adjustable Items (parameters) in the MIXING CONSOLE Dis-  
plays  
The following explanations cover the available items (parameters) in the MIXING  
CONSOLE displays.  
VOL/VOICE  
• The RHY2 channel in the  
STYLE PART display can only  
be assigned to Drumkit Voices  
and SFX kit Voices.  
• When playing GM song data,  
channel 10 (in the SONG CH  
9–16 page) can only be used  
for a Drum Kit Voice.  
SONG AUTO REVOICE  
VOICE  
Allows you to re-select the Voices for each part. When the Style  
channels are called up, neither Organ Flutes Voices nor User  
Voices can be selected. When the Song channels are called up,  
User Voices cannot be selected.  
PANPOT  
VOLUME  
Determines the stereo position of the selected part (channel).  
Determines the level of each part or channel, giving you fine  
control over the balance of all the parts.  
FILTER  
HARMONIC CONTENT  
Allows you to adjust the resonance effect (page 101) for each  
part.  
BRIGHTNESS  
Determines the brightness of the sound for each part by adjusting  
the cutoff frequency (page 101).  
TUNE  
PORTAMENTO TIME  
Portamento is a function that creates a smooth transition in pitch  
from the first note played on the keyboard to the next. The Porta-  
mento Time determines the pitch transition time. Higher values  
result in a longer pitch change time. Setting this to “0” results in  
no effect. This parameter is available when the selected keyboard  
part is set to Mono (page 86).  
PITCH BEND RANGE  
OCTAVE  
Determines the range of the PITCH BEND in semitones for each  
keyboard part (when a pedal is assigned to this function).  
Determines the range of the pitch change in octaves for each  
keyboard part.  
TUNING  
Determines the pitch of each keyboard part.  
TRANSPOSE  
Allows you to set the transposition for the keyboard pitch (KEY-  
BOARD), Song playback (SONG), or overall sound of the instru-  
ment (MASTER), respectively.  
EFFECT  
TYPE  
Select the desired effect type (page 93). After editing various  
parameters for the selected effect type, you can save it as an orig-  
inal effect.  
REVERB  
CHORUS  
DSP  
Adjusts the amount of the Reverb sound for each part or chan-  
nel.  
Adjusts the amount of the Chorus sound for each part or chan-  
nel.  
Adjusts the amount of the DSP sound for each part or channel.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance (MIXING CONSOLE)  
EQ (Equalizer)  
TYPE  
Select the desired EQ type to suit the type of music and the per-  
formance environment (page 95). This affects the overall sound  
of the instrument.  
EDIT  
For editing the EQ (page 95).  
EQ HIGH  
Determines the center frequency of the high EQ band that is  
attenuated/boosted for each part.  
EQ LOW  
Determines the center frequency of the low EQ band that is  
attenuated/boosted for each part.  
CMP (Master Compressor)  
See page 97. This affects the overall sound of the instrument.  
Song Auto Revoice  
This feature lets you use the high-quality sounds of the instrument to full advantage  
with XG-compatible song data. When you play back any commercially available  
XG song data or that created on other instruments, you can use Auto Revoice to  
automatically assign the specially createdVoices of the instrument (Natural!, Live!,  
Cool!, etc.) instead of the conventional XG Voices of the same type.  
1–3  
4
select the VOL/VOICE tab.  
Press the [G] (SETUP) button to call up the AUTO REVOICE SETUP dis-  
play.  
π†  
Use the [1  
π†  
]–[3 ] buttons to select the Voice to be replaced.  
5
5
6
7
π†  
π†  
] buttons to select the Voice for replacing the  
6
Use the [4  
]–[6  
XG selected in step 5.  
Several different Revoice settings are available by using the [F]/[G]/[I] but-  
tons, for conveniently calling up the recommended Revoice settings in one  
action.  
ALL REVOICE:  
Replaces all of the replaceable XG Voices with the  
high-quality Voices of the instrument.  
PIANO REVOICE:  
BASIC REVOICE:  
Replaces only the piano Voices.  
Replaces only the recommended Voices that are suit-  
able for playing back the song.  
ALL NO REVOICE:  
All Voices are returned to the original XG Voices.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance (MIXING CONSOLE)  
π
Press the [8 ] (OK) button to apply your Revoice settings.  
7
8
To cancel the Revoice operation, press the [8] (CANCEL) button.  
In the VOL/VOICE tab display, press the [F] button to set SONG AUTO  
REVOICE to ON.  
Effect Type  
Selecting an Effect type  
1–3  
4
select the EFFECT tab.  
Press the [F] (TYPE) button to call up the Effect Type selection display.  
π†  
Use the [1  
π†  
]/[2 ] buttons to select the effect BLOCK.  
5
DSP:  
Stands for Digital Signal Proces-  
sor (or Processing). DSP changes  
and enhances the audio signal in  
the digital realm to produce a  
wide range of effects.  
5
6
7
8
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance (MIXING CONSOLE)  
Effect Block  
REVERB  
Effect-applicable parts  
Effect characteristics  
All parts  
Reproduces the warm ambience of playing  
in a concert hall or jazz club.  
CHORUS  
DSP1  
All parts  
Produces a rich “fat” sound as if several  
parts are being played simultaneously.  
STYLE PART  
In addition to the Reverb and Chorus types,  
SONG CHANNNEL 1–16 the instrument has special DSP effects, that  
include additional effects usually used for a  
specific part, such as distortion and tremolo.  
DSP2  
DSP3  
DSP4  
DSP5  
RIGHT 1, RIGHT 2, LEFT, Any unused DSP blocks are automatically  
SONG CHANNEL 1–16  
assigned to the appropriate parts (channels)  
as needed.  
DSP6  
Microphone sound  
Dedicated for use only with the microphone  
sound.  
π†  
π†  
] buttons to select the part to which you want  
6
Use the [3  
to apply the effect.  
]/[4  
π†  
π†  
7
8
Use the [5  
]/[6  
]/[8  
] buttons to select the effect CATEGORY.  
] buttons to select the effect TYPE.  
π†  
Use the [7  
π†  
If you want to edit the effect parameters, go on to the next operation.  
Editing and Saving the effect  
9
Press the [F] (PARAMETER) button to call up the display for editing  
the effect parameters.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance (MIXING CONSOLE)  
10  
If you have selected one of the DSP 2–5 effect blocks in step 5:  
You can edit its standard parameters as well as its variation parameter.  
To select the standard type of parameters, press the [B] button. To select its  
variation parameter, press the [E] button.  
Re-selecting the Effect block,  
category and type  
Use the [1π†]–[3π†] but-  
tons. The re-selected effect con-  
figuration is displayed at the  
upper left side box in the display.  
10  
13  
11 12  
π†  
]/  
11  
12  
Select one of the parameters you want to edit by using the [4  
π†  
[5  
Available parameters differ depending on the selected Effect type.  
] buttons.  
π†  
Adjust the value for the selected parameter by using the [6  
]/  
] buttons. If you have selected the REVERB, CHORUS or DSP1  
Effect Return Level:  
Determines the level or amount  
of effect applied.  
This is set for all parts or chan-  
nels.  
π†  
[7  
effect block in step 5:  
Adjust the Effect Return Level by pressing [8π†] button.  
13  
14  
Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the display for saving your origi-  
nal effect.  
π†  
Use the [3  
the effect.  
π†  
]–[6 ] buttons to select the destination for saving  
The maximum number for effects that can be saved differs depending on the  
effect block.  
15  
14  
15  
When recalling the saved effect, use the same procedure as in step 8.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance (MIXING CONSOLE)  
EQ (Equalizer)  
Equalizer (also called “EQ”) is a sound processor that divides the frequency spec-  
trum into multiple bands that can be boosted or cut as required to tailor the overall  
frequency response. Usually an equalizer is used to correct the sound from speak-  
ers to match the special character of the room. For example, you can cut some of  
the low range frequencies when playing in large spaces where the sound is too  
“boomy,” or boost the high frequencies in rooms and close spaces where the sound  
is relatively “dead” and free of echoes. The instrument possesses a high-grade five-  
band digital EQ. With this function, a final effect—tone control can be added to the  
output of your instrument. You can select one of the five preset EQ settings in the  
EQ display. You can even create your own custom EQ settings by adjusting the fre-  
quency bands, and save the settings to one of two User Master EQ types.  
Bandwidth  
(also called “Shape” or “Q”)  
Gain  
0
Freq (Frequency)  
5 bands →  
LOW LOW MID MID HIG MID HIGH  
EQ1  
EQ2  
EQ3  
EQ4 EQ5  
Select a Preset EQ type  
1–3  
4
select the EQ tab.  
Use the [A]/[B] buttons to select a preset EQ type to suit your perfor-  
mance (music style or environment).  
If you want to edit the EQ parameters, go on to the next operation.  
Editing and Saving the selected EQ  
5
Press the [F] (EDIT) button to call up the MASTER EQ EDIT display.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance (MIXING CONSOLE)  
6
Use the [A]/[B] buttons to select a preset EQ type.  
6
9
8
7
π†  
π†  
] buttons to boost or cut each of the five  
7
8
Use the [3  
bands.  
]–[7  
Use the [8π†] button to boost or cut all the five bands at the same time.  
Adjust the Q (bandwidth) and the FREQ (center frequency) of the  
band selected in step 7.  
• Bandwidth (also called “Shape” or “Q”)  
π†  
Use the [1  
]button. The higher the value of Q, the narrower the band  
width.  
• FREQ (center frequency)  
Use the [2π†]button. The available FREQ range is different for each  
band.  
9
Press the [H] or [I] (STORE 1 or 2) button to save the edited EQ type  
Up to two types of EQ can be created and saved. When recalling the saved  
EQ type, use the same procedure as in step 6.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance (MIXING CONSOLE)  
Master Compressor  
Compressor is an effect commonly used to limit and compress the dynamics (soft-  
ness/loudness) of an audio signal. For signals that vary widely in dynamics, such as  
vocals and guitar parts, it “squeezes” the dynamic range, effectively making soft  
sounds louder and loud sounds softer. When used with gain to boost the overall  
level, this creates a more powerful, more consistently high-level sound. Compres-  
sion can be used to increase sustain for electric guitar, smooth out the volume of a  
vocal, or bring a drum kit or rhythm pattern further up-front in the mix. The instru-  
ment has a sophisticated multi-band compressor that allows you to adjust the com-  
pression effect for individual frequency bands—giving you detailed sonic control.  
You can edit and save your own custom Compressor types, or conveniently select  
from one of the presets.  
Selecting a Master Compressor type  
1–3  
4
select the CMP tab.  
Use the [A]/[B] buttons to select a preset Master Compressor type.  
Selecting a Master Compressor type automatically sets the parameters (at the  
bottom of the display) to the optimum values for the type.  
5
4
5
Press the [F] button to set the Master Compressor to ON.  
If you want to edit the Master Compressor parameters, go on to the next operation.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance (MIXING CONSOLE)  
Editing and Saving the selected Master Compressor  
π†  
π†  
] buttons to select the frequency curve for the  
6
Use the [1  
]/[2  
Compressor, or which frequencies compression is applied to.  
For example, select “LOW” when you want to emphasize low frequencies,  
and “HIGH” when you want to emphasize high frequencies.  
8
6
7
π†  
π†  
] buttons to determine the Threshold (mini-  
7
Use the [3  
]–[7  
Threshold:  
mum level at which compression starts) and Gain (level of com-  
pressed signal at three separate frequency bands).  
These values offset those of the frequency curve settings in step 6.  
Determines the minimum level  
at which compression starts. The  
compressor affects only the  
sound of levels higher than that  
of Threshold.  
8
9
Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the display for saving your origi-  
nal Master Compressor settings.  
π†  
Use the [3  
π†  
]–[6 ] buttons to select the destination for saving  
the Master Compressor settings.  
10  
9
10  
Press the [I] (SAVE) button to save the Master Compressor settings  
When recalling the saved Master Compressor settings, use the same proce-  
dure as in step 4.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Voice Creating (Voice Set)  
Voice Creating (Voice Set)  
Editing the ORGAN FLUTES  
Voices  
The instrument has aVoice Set feature that allows you to create your ownVoices by  
editing some parameters of the existing Voices. Once you’ve created a Voice, you  
can save it as a User Voice to the USER/(USB) display for future recall. The editing  
method is different for the ORGAN FLUTES Voices and for other Voices.  
The editing method is different  
for the ORGAN FLUTES Voices  
compared to other Voices. For  
instructions on editing the  
ORGAN FLUTES Voices, see  
Basic Procedure  
1
2
Select the desired Voice (other than an Organ Flutes Voice) (page 32).  
π
Press the [6 ] (VOICE SET) button to call up the VOICE SET display.  
3
Use the TAB [][®] buttons to call up the relevant setting display.  
For information on the available parameters, see the “Editable Parameters in  
the VOICE SET Displays” on page 100.  
3
4
6
7
5
4
As necessary, use the [A]/[B] buttons to select the item (parameter)  
to be edited.  
CAUTION  
π†  
π†  
] buttons to edit the Voice.  
5
6
Use the [1  
]–[8  
If you select another Voice  
without saving the settings,  
the settings will be lost. If you  
wish to store the settings  
here, make sure to save the  
settings as a User Voice before  
selecting another Voice or  
turning the power off.  
Press the [D] (COMPARE) button to compare the sound of the edited  
Voice with the unedited Voice.  
7
Press the [I] (SAVE) button to save your edited Voice (page 69).  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Voice Creating (Voice Set)  
Editable Parameters in the VOICE SET Displays  
The available parameters differ  
depending on the Voice.  
The following covers in detail the editable parameters that are set in the displays  
explained in step 3 of the “Basic Procedure” on page 99. The Voice Set parameters  
are organized into five different displays. The parameters in each display are  
described separately, below. These are also treated as part of theVoice Set parame-  
ters (page 106), which are automatically called up when the Voice is selected.  
Changes to velocity curve  
according to Touch sensitivity  
TOUCH SENSE DEPTH  
Changes to velocity curve  
according to VelDepth (with Off-  
set set to 64)  
PIANO  
This display is available only when the Natural! piano Voice (page 78) is selected.  
TUNING CURVE  
Determines the tuning curve. Select “FLAT” if you feel the tuning  
curve of the piano Voice does not quite match that of other instru-  
ments Voices.  
Actual Velocity  
for tone generator  
STRETCH  
Tuning curve particularly for pianos  
FLAT  
Depth=127  
(twice)  
Depth=64  
(normal)  
127  
64  
0
Tuning curve in which the frequency is octave doubled over the  
entire keyboard range  
Depth=32  
(half)  
KEY OFF SAMPLE  
Adjusts the volume of the key-off sound (the subtle sound that  
occurs when you release a key).  
Depth=0  
SUSTAIN SAMPLE  
Adjusts the depth of sustain sampling for the damper pedal.  
Adjusts the depth of string resonance.  
64  
127  
Received Velocity  
(Actual KeyOn speed)  
STRING RESONANCE  
COMMON  
TOUCH SENSE OFFSET  
Changes to velocity curve  
according to VelOffset (with  
Depth set to 64)  
VOLUME  
Adjusts the volume of the current edited Voice.  
Actual Velocity  
TOUCH SENSE  
Adjusts the touch sensitivity (velocity sensitivity), or how greatly the  
volume responds to your playing strength.  
DEPTH  
Determines the velocity sensitivity, or how much the level of the  
voice changes in response to your playing strength (velocity).  
OFFSET  
for tone generator  
Offset=96 (+64)  
Offset=127  
(+127)  
127  
64  
0
Offset=64  
(normal)  
Depends on  
offset  
Determines the amount by which received velocities are adjusted  
for the actual velocity effect.  
Offset=32  
(-64)  
PART OCTAVE  
Shifts the octave range of the edited Voice up or down in octaves.  
When the edited Voice is used as any of the RIGHT 1–2 parts, the  
R1/R2 parameter is available; when the edited Voice is used as the  
LEFT part, the LEFT parameter is available.  
Depends on  
64  
offset  
127  
Received  
Velocity  
(Actual  
KeyOn speed)  
MONO/POLY  
Determines whether the edited Voice is played monophonically or  
polyphonically (page 86).  
Offset=0 (-127)  
PORTAMENTO TIME  
Sets the portamento time when the editedVoice is set to “MONO” above.  
Portamento Time:  
The Portamento Time deter-  
mines the pitch transition time.  
Portamento is a function that cre-  
ates a smooth transition in pitch  
from the first note played on the  
keyboard to the next.  
CONTROLLER  
1. MODULATION  
When a pedal function is assigned to MODULATION, the pedal can be used to  
modulate the parameters below as well as the pitch (vibrato). Here, you can set the  
degree to which the pedal modulates each of the following parameters.  
FILTER  
Determines the degree to which the pedal modulates the Filter Cut-  
off Frequency. For details about the filter, see page 101.  
AMPLITUDE  
LFO PMOD  
LFO FMOD  
LFO AMOD  
Determines the degree to which the pedal modulates the amplitude  
(volume).  
Determines the degree to which the pedal modulates the pitch, or  
the vibrato effect.  
Determines the degree to which the pedal modulates the Filter  
modulation, or the wah effect.  
Determines the degree to which the pedal modulates the amplitude,  
or the tremolo effect.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
100  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Voice Creating (Voice Set)  
2. LEFT PEDAL  
This allows you to select the function to be assigned to the left pedal.  
FUNCTION  
Selects the function to be assigned to the left pedal. For details on  
the pedal functions, see page 191.  
π† π†  
]–[8  
tons (RIGHT 1, RIGHT  
2, LEFT, etc.)  
[2  
] but-  
Determines whether the assigned function is effective or not for the  
respective keyboard part. This also determines the depth for the  
function. For details, see page 192.  
SOUND  
FILTER  
Filter is a processor that changes the timbre or tone of a sound by either blocking  
or passing a specific frequency range. The parameters below determine the overall  
timbre of the sound by boosting or cutting a certain frequency range. In addition to  
making the sound either brighter or mellower, Filter can be used to produce elec-  
tronic, synthesizer–like effects.  
BRIGHTNESS  
Determines the cutoff frequency or effective frequency range of the  
filter (see diagram). Higher values result in a brighter sound.  
Volume  
Cutoff frequency  
Frequency (pitch)  
Cutoff range  
These frequencies are  
“passed” by the filter.  
HARMONIC CONTENT Determines the emphasis given to the cutoff frequency (resonance),  
set in BRIGHTNESS above (see diagram). Higher values result in a  
more pronounced effect.  
Volume  
Resonance  
Frequency (pitch)  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Voice Creating (Voice Set)  
EG  
The EG (Envelope Generator) settings determine how the level of the sound  
changes in time. This lets you reproduce many sound characteristics of natural  
acoustic instruments—such as the quick attack and decay of percussion sounds, or  
the long release of a sustained piano tone.  
ATTACK  
Determines how quickly the sound reaches its maximum level after  
the key is played. The lower the value, the quicker the attack.  
DECAY  
Determines how quickly the sound reaches its sustain level (a  
slightly lower level than maximum). The lower the value, the  
quicker the decay.  
RELEASE  
Determines how quickly the sound decays to silence after the key is  
released. The lower the value, the quicker the decay.  
Level  
Sustain level  
ATTACK  
DECAY  
RELEASE  
Time  
Key on  
Key off  
VIBRATO  
Vibrato:  
DEPTH  
Determines the intensity of the Vibrato effect. Higher settings result  
in a more pronounced Vibrato.  
A quavering, vibrating sound  
effect that is produced by regu-  
larly modulating the pitch of the  
Voice.  
SPEED  
DELAY  
Determines the speed of the Vibrato effect.  
Determines the amount of time that elapses between the playing of  
a key and the start of the Vibrato effect. Higher settings increase the  
delay of the Vibrato onset.  
SPEED  
Pitch  
DEPTH  
DELAY  
Time  
EFFECT/EQ  
1. REVERB DEPTH/CHORUS DEPTH/DSP DEPTH  
REVERB DEPTH  
CHORUS DEPTH  
DSP DEPTH  
Adjusts the chorus (page 93) depth.  
Adjusts the DSP (page 93) depth.  
If you want to re-select the DSP type, you can do so in the DSP  
menu explained on page 103.  
Switching the VIBE ROTOR  
on/off with a pedal  
You can use a pedal to switch the  
VIBE ROTOR on/off (when the  
VIBE ROTOR ON/OFF function  
DSP ON/OFF  
VIBE ROTOR  
Determines whether the DSP is on or off.  
This will be displayed only if VIBE VIBRATE is selected for the DSP  
Type parameter explained on page 93. Determines whether VIBE  
VIBRATE should be set to on or off when selecting the Voice.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
102  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Voice Creating (Voice Set)  
2. DSP  
DSP TYPE  
Selects the DSP effect category and type. Select a type after select-  
ing a category.  
VARIATION  
Two variations are provided for each DSP type.  
Here, you can edit the VARIATION on/off status and variation-  
parameter value setting.  
ON/OFF  
The factory-programmed assignments are set to variation-off for  
all Voices (standard variation of DSP is assigned). If you select  
VARIATION ON here, a variation of the DSP effect is assigned to  
the Voice. The variation parameter value can be adjusted in the  
VALUE menu explained below.  
PARAMETER  
Displays the variation parameter.  
VALUE  
Adjusts the value of the DSP variation parameter.  
3. EQ  
EQ LOW/HIGH  
These determine the Frequency and Gain of the Low and High EQ  
bands.  
HARMONY  
Harmony sets the Right 1 and 2 parts together. Select the Right 1 part (page 32,  
step 1) in the Main display, before you set it. This has the same settings as the dis-  
Creating Your Original Organ Flutes Voices  
The instrument features a variety of lush, dynamic organ Voices that you can call  
up with the [ORGAN FLUTES] button. It also gives you the tools to create your  
own original organ sounds by using the Voice Set function. Just as on a traditional  
organ, you can create your own sounds by adjusting the levels of the flute footages.  
Basic Procedure  
1
Select the desired Organ Flutes Voice to be edited (page 32).  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Voice Creating (Voice Set)  
π
In the ORGAN FLUTES Voice Selection display, press the [6 ] (FOOT-  
AGE) button to call up the VOICE SET [ORGAN FLUTES] display.  
2
3
Use the TAB [][®] buttons to call up the relevant setting display.  
For information on the available parameters, see the following “Editable  
Parameters in the VOICE SET [ORGAN FLUTES] displays.”  
3
6
4
(When selecting  
the EFFECT/EQ  
tab display.)  
5
4
5
6
If you select the EFFECT/EQ tab display, use the [A]/[B] buttons to  
select the parameter to be edited.  
π†  
π†  
]–[8 ] buttons to edit the  
Use the [A]–[D], [F]–[H] and [1  
Voice.  
CAUTION  
Press the [I] (SAVE) button to save your edited ORGAN FLUTES Voice  
If you select another Voice  
without saving the settings,  
the settings will be lost. If you  
wish to store the settings  
here, make sure to save the  
settings as a User Voice before  
selecting another Voice or  
turning the power off.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
104  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Voice Creating (Voice Set)  
Editable Parameters in the VOICE SET [ORGAN FLUTES] displays  
The following covers in detail the editable parameters that are set in the displays  
parameters are organized into three different pages. The parameters in each page  
are described separately, below. These are also treated as part of the Voice Set  
parameters (page 106), which are automatically called up when the Voice is  
selected.  
FOOTAGE, VOLUME/ATTACK (common parameters)  
ORGAN TYPE  
Specifies the type of organ tone generation to be simulated: Sine or  
Vintage.  
ROTARY SP SPEED  
Alternately switches between the slow and fast rotary speaker  
speeds when a rotary speaker effect is selected for the Organ Flutes  
(see “EFFECT/EQ” DSP TYPE parameter on page 103), and theVoice  
Effect DSP (page 103) is turned on (this parameter has the same  
effect as the Voice Effect VARIATION ON/OFF parameter).  
VIBRATO ON/OFF  
VIBRATO DEPTH  
Alternately turns the vibrato effect for the Organ Flutes Voice ON or  
OFF.  
Sets the Vibrato depth to one of three levels: 1 (low), 2 (mid), or 3  
(high).  
FOOTAGE  
Footage:  
Which footage (16' or 5 1/3') is operated with the [1π†] button can  
be switched by pressing the [D] button.  
16' ← → 5 1/3'  
The term “footage” is a reference  
to the sound generation of tradi-  
tional pipe organs, in which the  
sound is produced by pipes of  
different lengths (in feet).  
Determines the basic sound of the organ flutes. The longer the pipe, the  
lower the pitch of the sound. Hence, the 16' setting determines the low-  
est pitched component of the Voice, while the 1' setting determines the  
highest pitched component. The higher the value of the setting, the  
greater the volume of the corresponding footage. Mixing various vol-  
umes of the footages lets you create your own distinctive organ sounds.  
16'–1'  
VOLUME/ATTACK  
VOL  
Adjusts the overall volume of the Organ Flutes. The longer the  
graphic bar, the greater the volume.  
RESP  
Affects both the attack and release (page 102) portion of the sound,  
increasing or decreasing the response time of the initial swell and  
release, based on the FOOTAGE controls. The higher the value, the  
slower the swell and release.  
VIBRATO SPEED  
MODE  
Determines the speed of the vibrato effect controlled by the Vibrato  
On/Off and Vibrato Depth above.  
The MODE control selects between two modes: FIRST and EACH.  
In the FIRST mode, attack is applied only to the first notes played  
and held simultaneously; while the first notes are held, any subse-  
quently played notes have no attack applied. In the EACH mode,  
attack is applied equally to all notes.  
4', 2 2/3', 2'  
LENG  
These determine the attack sound volume of the ORGAN FLUTE  
Voice. The 4', 2-2/3' and 2' controls increase or reduce the volume  
of attack sound at the corresponding footages. The longer the  
graphic bar, the greater the attack sound volume.  
Affects the attack portion of the sound producing a longer or shorter  
decay immediately after the initial attack. The longer the graphic  
bar, the longer the decay.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Voice Creating (Voice Set)  
EFFECT/EQ  
Same parameters as in the VOICE SET “EFFECT/EQ” tab display explained on  
Disabling automatic selection of Voice Sets (effects, etc.)  
Each Voice is linked to its related parameter settings that are indicated in the  
VOICE SET displays, including effects and EQ. Usually these settings are  
automatically called up when a Voice is selected. However, you can also  
disable this feature by the operation in the relevant display as explained  
below.  
For example, if you want to change the Voice yet keep the same Harmony  
effect, set the HARMONY/ECHO parameter to OFF (in the display explained  
below).  
You can set these independently by keyboard part and parameter group.  
1 Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [E] REGIST.SEQUENCE/FREEZE/VOICE SET TAB [®  
]
VOICE SET  
2 Use the [A]/[B] buttons to select a keyboard part.  
π†  
3 Use the [4  
π†  
]–[8 ] buttons to enable/disable automatic calling  
up of the settings (ON or OFF) independently for each parameter  
group.  
Refer to the separate Data List for a list of parameters contained in each  
parameter group.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
106  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Using, Creating and Editing the Auto Accompaniment Styles  
Reference to Quick Guide pages  
Playing “Mary Had a Little Lamb” with the Auto  
Accompaniment Feature.....................................................................page 45  
Pattern Variation ...................................................................... page 47  
Learning How to Play (Indicate) Chords for Style Playback...... page 49  
Appropriate Panel Settings for the Selected Style  
(One Touch Setting)................................................................. page 50  
Style Characteristics  
The Style type and its defining characteristics are indicated above the Preset Style  
name.  
Pro  
These Styles provide professional and exciting arrangements combined  
with perfect playability. The resulting accompaniment exactly follows the  
chords of the player. As a result, your chord changes and colorful harmo-  
nies are instantly transformed into lifelike musical accompaniment.  
Session  
These Styles provide even greater realism and authentic backing by  
mixing in original chord types and changes, as well as special riffs with  
chord changes, with the Main sections. These have been programmed  
to add “spice” and a professional touch to your performances of certain  
songs and in certain genres. Keep in mind, however, that the Styles may  
not necessarily be appropriate—or even harmonically correct—for all  
songs and for all chord playing. In some cases for example, playing a  
simple major triad for a country song may result in a “jazzy” seventh  
chord, or playing an on-bass chord may result in inappropriate or unex-  
pected accompaniment.  
Pianist  
These special Styles provide piano-only accompaniment. Just by play-  
ing the proper chords with your left hand, you can automatically add  
complicated, professional-sounding arpeggios and bass/chord patterns.  
Selecting a Chord Fingering Type  
Style playback can be controlled by the chords you play in the chord section of the  
keyboard. There are seven types of fingerings.  
1
2
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [C] STYLE SETTING/SPLIT POINT/CHORD FINGERING →  
TAB [®] CHORD FINGERING  
π†  
Press the [1  
π†  
]–[3 ] buttons to select a fingering.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Playing Only the Rhythm Channels of a Style  
SINGLE FINGER  
Makes it simple to produce  
orchestrated accompani-  
ment using major, seventh,  
minor and minor-seventh  
chords by pressing a mini-  
mum number of keys on the  
Chord section of the key-  
board. This type is available  
only for Style playback.  
The abbreviated chord fin-  
gerings described at right are  
used:  
C
For a major chord,  
press the root key only.  
Cm  
For a minor chord,  
simultaneously press the root  
key and a black key to its left.  
C
7
For a seventh chord,  
simultaneously press the root  
key and a white key to its left.  
Cm  
7
For a minor-seventh chord,  
simultaneously press the root key and  
both a white and black key to its left.  
MULTI FINGER  
FINGERED  
Automatically detects Single Finger or Fingered chord fingerings, so you  
can use either type of fingering without having to switch fingering types.  
Lets you finger your own chords on the Chord section of the keyboard,  
while the instrument supplies appropriately orchestrated rhythm, bass,  
and chord accompaniment in the selected Style. The Fingered type rec-  
ognizes the various chord types which are listed on the separate Data List  
booklet and can be looked up using the Chord Tutor function (page 49).  
FINGERED ON  
BASS  
Accepts the same fingerings as the Fingered, but the lowest note played  
in the Chord section of the keyboard is used as the bass note, allowing  
you to play “on bass” chords (in the Fingered mode the root of the  
chord is always used as the bass note).  
FULL KEYBOARD  
AI FINGERED  
Detects chords in the entire key range. Chords are detected in a way  
similar to Fingered, even if you split the notes between your left and  
right hands—for example, playing a bass note with your left hand and a  
chord with your right, or by playing a chord with your left hand and a  
melody note with your right.  
Basically the same as Fingered, with the exception that less than three  
notes can be played to indicate the chords (based on the previously  
played chord, etc.).  
AI FULL KEYBOARD When this advanced fingering type is engaged, the instrument will auto-  
matically create appropriate accompaniment while you play just about  
anything, anywhere on the keyboard using both hands. You don’t have  
to worry about specifying the Style chords. Although the AI Full Key-  
board type is designed to work with many songs, some arrangements  
may not be suitable for use with this feature. This type is similar to Full  
Keyboard, with the exception that less than three notes can be played to  
indicate the chords (based on the previously played chord, etc.). 9th,  
11th and 13th chords cannot be played. This type is available only for  
Style playback.  
AI:  
Artificial Intelligence  
Playing Only the Rhythm Channels  
of a Style  
Starting the rhythm with Sync  
Start  
You can also start the rhythm  
simply by playing the keyboard,  
if Sync Start is enabled (turn on  
the [SYNC START] button).  
Rhythm is one of the most important parts of a Style. Try to play the melody along  
with just the rhythm. You can sound different rhythms for each Style. Keep in mind,  
however, that not all Styles contain rhythm channels.  
1
2
3
The rhythm does not sound for  
the Pianist Styles (or other similar  
Styles). When you want to use  
any of these Styles, always make  
sure that ACMP ON/OFF is  
turned on.  
Press the [ACMP ON/OFF] to turn Auto Accompaniment off.  
Press the STYLE CONTROL [START/STOP] button to play back the  
rhythm channels.  
4
Press the STYLE CONTROL [START/STOP] button to stop the rhythm.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
108  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
Style Playback-related Settings  
Turning channels of the Style on/off  
A Style contains eight channels: RHY1 (Rhythm 1) – PHR2 (Phrase 2). You  
can add variations and change the feeling of a Style by selectively turning  
channels on/off as the Style plays.  
1 Press the [CHANNEL ON/OFF] button to call up the CHANNEL ON/  
OFF display.  
When the STYLE tab is not selected, press the [CHANNEL ON/OFF] but-  
ton again.  
2 Press the [1 ]–[8 ] buttons to turn the channels on or off.  
To listen to only one instrument by itself, hold down the appropriate but-  
ton for the channel to set the channel to SOLO. To cancel SOLO, simply  
press the appropriate channel button again.  
Playing the chords in free tempo (without Style playback)  
You can have the accompaniment chords sound without playing back the  
Style, by setting [ACMP ON/OFF] to on, and [SYNC START] to off. For  
example, if MULTI FINGER is selected (page 108), you can perform with  
your own pace while sounding the chord by pressing the chord section of  
the keyboard with your one finger.  
Setting the fade in/out time  
1 Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB[] CONFIG 1 [A] FADE IN/OUT/  
HOLD TIME  
π†  
π†  
]–[5 ] buttons.  
2 Set the parameters by using the [3  
FADE IN TIME  
Determines the time it takes for the volume to fade in, or go  
from minimum to maximum.  
FADE OUT TIME Determines the time it takes for the volume to fade out, or go  
from maximum to minimum.  
FADE OUT HOLD Determines the time the volume is held at 0 following the fade  
TIME  
out.  
Style Playback-related Settings  
The instrument has a variety of Style playback functions, which can be accessed in  
1
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [C] STYLE SETTING/SPLIT POINT/CHORD FINGERING →  
TAB[] STYLE SETTING  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Style Playback-related Settings  
π†  
Use the [1  
π†  
]–[8 ] buttons for each setting.  
2
• Stop Accompaniment  
When [ACMP ON/OFF] is turned on and [SYNC START] is off, you can play chords  
in the chord section of the keyboard with the Style stopped, and still hear the accom-  
paniment chord. In this condition—called “Stop Accompaniment”—any valid chord  
fingerings are recognized and the chord root/type are shown in the display.  
From the display above, you can determine whether the chord played in the  
chord section will sound or not in the Stop Accompaniment status.  
OFF...............................The chord played in the chord section will not sound.  
STYLE...........................The chord played in the chord section will sound via the  
Voices of the selected Style.  
Data that is recorded when  
recording a Song  
Please note that both the Voice  
that is sounded and the chord  
data will be recorded when set  
to “STYLE,” and only the chord  
data will be recorded when set  
to “OFF” or “FIXED.”  
FIXED...........................The chord played in the chord section will sound via the  
specified Voice, regardless of the selected Style.  
• OTS Link Timing  
This applies to the OTS Link function (page 51). This parameter determines the  
timing in which the One Touch Settings change with the MAIN VARIATION [A]–  
[D] change. (The [OTS LINK] button must be on.)  
Real Time.....................One Touch Setting is immediately called up when you  
press a MAIN VARIATION button.  
Next Bar ......................One Touch Setting is called up at the next measure, after  
you press a MAIN VARIATION button.  
• Synchro Stop Window  
This determines how long you can hold a chord before the Synchro Stop function is  
automatically cancelled. When the [SYNC STOP] button is turned on and this is set to a  
value other than “OFF,” this automatically cancels the Synchro Stop function if you hold  
a chord for longer than the time set here.This conveniently resets Style playback control  
to normal, letting you release the keys and still have the Style play. In other words, if you  
release the keys sooner than the time set here, the Synchro Stop function works.  
• Style Touch  
Turns touch response for the Style playback on/off. When this is set to “ON,” the Style vol-  
ume changes in response to your playing strength in the chord section of the keyboard.  
• Style Change Behavior  
There are three types as shown below.  
Section Set  
Determines the default section that is automatically called up when selecting differ-  
ent Styles (when Style playback is stopped). When set to “OFF” and Style playback  
is stopped, the active section is maintained even if the different Style is selected.  
When any of the MAIN A-D sections is not included in the Style data, the nearest  
section is automatically selected. For example, when MAIN D is not contained in  
the selected Style, MAIN C will be called up.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Split Point Settings  
Tempo  
This determines whether the tempo changes or not when you change Styles dur-  
ing Style playback.  
HOLD ................The tempo setting of the previous Style is maintained.  
RESET.................The tempo changes to that of the initial default tempo for the  
selected Style.  
Part On/Off  
This determines whether the Style Channel On/Off status changes or not when  
you change Styles during Style playback.  
HOLD ................. The Style Channel On/Off status of the previous Style is maintained.  
RESET.................All Style Channels are set to On.  
Split Point Settings  
These are the settings (there are two Split Points) that separate the different sec-  
tions of the keyboard: the Chord section, the LEFT part section and the RIGHT 1  
and 2 section. The two Split Point settings (below) are specified as note names.  
1
2
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [C] STYLE SETTING/SPLIT POINT/CHORD  
FINGERING TAB [][®] SPLIT POINT  
Use the [F]–[H] buttons to set the Split Point (see below).  
• Split Point (S)separates the Chord section for Style playback from the  
section(s) for playing Voices (RIGHT 1, 2 and LEFT)  
• Split Point (L)separates the two sections for playing Voices, LEFT and  
RIGHT 1– 2.  
These two settings can be set to the same note (as in the default) or two different  
notes as desired.  
Setting the Split Point (S) and the Split Point (L) to the same note  
Split Point (S+L)  
Chord section +  
Voice LEFT  
Voice RIGHT 1and 2  
Press the [F] (S+L) button and rotate the [DATA ENTRY] dial.  
Setting the Split Point (S) and the Split Point (L) to different notes  
Specifying the Split Point by  
note name  
Split Point (L)  
Split Point (S)  
Press the [1π†]–[4π†] but-  
tons. You can specify the Split  
Point of the Voice and chord sec-  
tion of the keyboard by using  
STYLE in the display, and you can  
specify the Split Point of the left  
and right Voices by using LEFT.  
Voice RIGHT 1and 2  
Voice LEFT  
Chord section  
Press the [H] (S) button or the [G] (L) button and rotate the [DATA ENTRY] dial.  
Split Point (L) cannot be set lower than Split Point (S), and Split Point (S) cannot be  
set higher than Split Point (L).  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Editing the Volume and Tonal Balance of the Style (MIXING CONSOLE)  
Editing the Volume and Tonal Bal-  
ance of the Style (MIXING CONSOLE)  
You can set various mixing-related parameters of the Style. (See “Adjustable items  
(parameters) in the MIXING CONSOLE display” on page 90.) Call up the “STYLE  
PART” display in step #3 of the Basic Procedure in “Editing theVolume Balance and  
Voice Combination (MIXING CONSOLE)” on page 88, and follow the instructions.  
Convenient Music Finder feature  
Music Finder (page 52) is a convenient feature that calls up pre-programmed panel  
settings (for Voices, Styles, etc.) that match the song or type of music you want to  
play. The records of the Music Finder can be searched and edited.  
Searching the Records  
You can search the records by specifying a song name or keyword, using the Search func-  
tion of the Music Finder. You can also save your favorite records in the FAVORITE display.  
1
2
Press the [MUSIC FINDER] button to call up the MUSIC FINDER display.  
Press the TAB [ ] button to select the ALL tab.  
The ALL tab display contains the preset Records.  
π
Press the [6 ] (SEARCH 1) button to call up the Search display.  
3
4
Enter the search criteria.  
Clear the search criteria  
To clear the entered Music/Key-  
word/Style, press the [F]/[G]/[H]  
(CLEAR) button.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
112  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Convenient Music Finder feature  
• Search by song title or music genre (MUSIC) or keyword  
1 Press the [A] (MUSIC)/[B] (KEYWORD) button to call up the character  
Entering several different key-  
words  
You can search several different  
keywords simultaneously by  
inserting a separator (comma)  
between each.  
entry display.  
• Search by Style name  
1 Press the [C] (STYLE) button to call up the Style selection display.  
2 Use the [A]–[J] buttons to select a Style.  
3 Press the [EXIT] button to return to the search display.  
• Adding other Search Criteria  
You can specify other search criteria in addition to the song name/keyword/Style  
name.  
BEAT ............................Select the beat (time signature) you want to use in your  
performance by pressing the [D] button. All beat settings  
are included in the search if you select ANY.  
SEARCH AREA .............Select the pages to be included in the search by pressing  
the [E] button. (These correspond to the tabs at the top  
of the Music Finder display.)  
TEMPO.........................Set the range of the tempo you want to use in your per-  
formance by using the [1π†]/[2π†] (TEMPO) but-  
tons.  
GENRE .........................Select the desired music genre by using the [5π†]/  
[6π†] (GENRE) buttons.  
π
Press the [8 ] (START SEARCH) button to start the search.  
The Search 1 display appears, showing the results of the search. To cancel  
5
searching, press the [8] (CANCEL) button.  
Searching other music genres  
When you want to search other music genres, press the [6] (SEARCH 2)  
button in the Music Finder display. The search result is displayed in the  
SEARCH 2 display.  
Calling up the panel settings to match the style (REPERTOIRE)  
When searching by style name, the same search result is obtained even if  
details.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Convenient Music Finder feature  
Creating a Set of Favorite Records  
As convenient as the Search function is in plumbing the depths of the Music Finder  
records, you may want to create a “folder” of favorite records—so you can quickly  
call up those Styles and settings you use most often in your performance.  
1
Select the desired record from the Music Finder display.  
2
Press the [H] (ADD TO FAVORITE) button to add the selected record  
to the FAVORITE display.  
3
Call up the FAVORITE display by using the TAB [][®] buttons, and  
check to see if the record has been added.  
Deleting Records from the FAVORITE Display  
1
2
Select the record you want to delete from the FAVORITE display.  
Press the [H] (DELETE FROM FAVORITE) button.  
Editing Records  
You can create a new record by editing the currently selected record. The newly  
created records are automatically saved in the internal memory.  
1
2
Select the desired record to be edited in the Music Finder display.  
CAUTION  
You can also change a preset  
record to create a new one. If  
you want to keep the original  
preset, make sure to change  
the name and register the  
edited record as a new record  
π†  
Press the [8  
] (RECORD EDIT) button to call up the Edit display.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
114  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Convenient Music Finder feature  
3
Edit the record as desired.  
• Editing the song name/keyword/Style name  
Input each item in the same way as done in the Search display (page 113).  
• Changing the Tempo  
Press the [1π†] (TEMPO) button.  
• Memorizing the Section (Intro/Main/Ending)  
Use the [2π†]/[4π†] buttons to select the section that will automatically be  
called up set when the record is selected. This is useful, for example, when you  
want to have a selected Style automatically be set up to start with an Intro sec-  
tion.  
• Editing the Genre  
Keep in mind that the Beat set-  
ting made here is only for the  
Music Finder search function;  
this does not affect the actual  
Beat setting of the Style itself.  
Select the desired genre by using the [5π†]/[6π†] (GENRE) buttons. When  
creating a new genre, press the [7π†] (GENRE NAME) button and input the  
• Deleting the Currently Selected Record  
Press the [I] (DELETE RECORD) button.  
• Canceling and Quitting the Edit functions  
Press the [8] (CANCEL) button.  
4
5
To enter the edited record to the FAVORITE display, press the [E]  
(FAVORITE) button to turn on the FAVORITE.  
Enter the edits you’ve made to the record as described below.  
• Creating a new record  
The maximum number of  
records is 2500, including inter-  
nal records.  
Press the [J] (NEW RECORD) button. The record is added to the ALL display. If  
you’ve entered the record to the FAVORITE display in step 4 above, the record is  
added to both the ALL display and the FAVORITE display.  
• Overwriting an existing record  
Press the [8π] (OK) button. If you set the record as a Favorite in step 4 above,  
the record is added to the FAVORITE display. When you edit the record in the  
FAVORITE display, the record is overwritten.  
Saving the Record  
The Music Finder feature handles all the Records including the presets and addi-  
tionally created records as a single file. Keep in mind that individual records (panel  
setups) cannot be handled as separate files.  
1
2
3
Call up the Save display.  
[MUSIC FINDER]TAB[][®]ALL[7π†] (FILES)  
Press the TAB [][®] buttons to select the location for saving (USER/  
USB).  
All records are saved together as a single file.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Convenient Music Finder feature  
Calling up Music Finder Records Saved to USER/USB  
To call up the Music Finder records you’ve saved to USER/USB, follow the  
instructions below.  
1 Call up the [MUSIC FINDER] display.  
[MUSIC FINDER] TAB [][®] ALL  
π†  
the Music Finder.  
2 Press the [7  
] (FILES) button to open the File selection display of  
3 Use the TAB [][®] buttons to select USER/USB.  
4 Press the [A]–[J] buttons to select the desired Music Finder file.  
The message is displayed according to the content of the file when the file  
is chosen, and the desired button is pressed.  
CAUTION  
• Selecting “REPLACE” auto-  
matically deletes all your  
original records from inter-  
nal memory.  
Make sure that all impor-  
tant data has been archived  
to another location before-  
hand.  
• REPLACE  
All Music Finder records currently in the instrument are deleted and  
replaced with the records of the selected file.  
• APPEND  
The records called up are added.  
• Make sure that all impor-  
tant data has been archived  
to another location before-  
hand, when the file to  
delete all records of the  
Music Finder is down-  
loaded from the web  
Execute the operation to call up the Music Finder file. Select “CANCEL”  
to abort this operation.  
Restoring the Music Finder  
Data  
You can restore the instruments  
Music Finder to its original fac-  
2
3
4
4
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
116  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Style Creator  
Viewing information about Music Finder records  
Information on the record about which you like in Music Finder is called,  
and the song of the model is downloaded, or it is possible to add it to  
musical instruments by downloading the Music Finder record which you  
like. For more details about this service, refer to the following website.  
http://music.yamaha.com/idc  
The available contents of the ser-  
vice described at left are subject  
to change.  
the [MUSIC FINDER] button to call up the MUSIC FINDER display.  
π†  
π†  
] buttons in the display to select the record  
2 Use the [1  
]–[5  
for which you want to view information on the Web.  
You can also use the [DATA ENTRY] dial to make a selection. After using  
the dial to make a selection, press [ENTER].  
3 Press the [J] (MUSIC FINDER +) button to open the Web page.  
3
4
4 Press the [EXIT] button to exit the browser screen and return to the  
MUSIC FINDER display.  
Style Creator  
You can create your own Styles—recording them by yourself or by combining the  
internal Style data. The created Styles can be edited.  
Style Structure  
Styles are made up of fifteen different sections and each section has eight separate  
channels. With the Style Creator feature, you can create a Style by separately  
recording the channels, or by importing pattern data from other existing Styles.  
Style  
Section  
Four different  
Fill-ins are  
available.  
Channel  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Style Creator  
Creating a Style  
You can use one of the three different methods described below to create a Style.  
Realtime Recording See below  
This method lets you record the Style by simply playing the instrument. You can  
select an internal Style that most closely matches your image of the Style you want  
to create and then re-record parts of the Style as desired, or you can create a new  
Style from scratch.  
Step Recording See page 121  
This method is like writing music notation on paper, since it allows you to enter  
each note or individually, and specify its length.  
This allows you to create a Style without having to play the parts on the instrument,  
since you can enter each event manually.  
Style Assembly See page 122  
This convenient feature lets you create composite Styles by combining various pat-  
terns from the internal preset Styles. For example, if you want to create your own  
original 8-beat Style, you could take rhythm patterns from the “70’s 8Beat” Style,  
use the bass pattern from “ 60s Rock1” Style and import the chord patterns from  
the “Cool8Beat” Style—combining the various elements to create one Style.  
70’s 8Beat  
Cool8Beat  
Rhythm 1  
Rhythm 2  
Bass  
Rhythm 1  
Rhythm 2  
Bass  
60’s Rock1  
Rhythm 1  
Rhythm 2  
Bass  
Chord 1  
Chord 2  
Pad  
Chord 1  
Chord 2  
Pad  
Rhythm 1  
Rhythm 2  
Bass  
Phrase 1  
Phrase 2  
Phrase 1  
Phrase 2  
Chord 1  
Chord 2  
Pad  
Chord 1  
Chord 2  
Pad  
Phrase 1  
Phrase 2  
Phrase 1  
Phrase 2  
Realtime Recording (BASIC)  
Create a single Style by recording the individual channels one-by-one, using real-  
time recording.  
Realtime Recording Characteristics  
• Loop Recording  
Style playback repeats the rhythm patterns of several measures in a “loop,” and  
Style recording is also done using loops. For example, if you start recording with  
a two-measure main section, the two measures are repeatedly recorded. Notes  
that you record will play back from the next repetition (loop), letting you record  
while hearing previously recorded material.  
• Overdub Recording  
This method records new material to a channel already containing recorded  
data, without deleting the original data. In Style recording, the recorded data is  
not deleted, except when using functions such as Rhythm Clear (page 120) and  
Delete (page 120). For example, if you start recording with a two-measure MAIN  
section, the two measures are repeated many times. Notes that you record will  
play back from the next repetition, letting you overdub new material to the loop  
while hearing previously recorded material.  
When creating a Style based on an existing internal Style, overdub recording is  
applied only to the rhythm channels. For all other channels (except rhythm),  
delete the original data before recording.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
118  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Style Creator  
When using realtime recording based on the internal Styles:  
Overdub recording not possible.  
Delete the data before recording.  
Overdub recording possible.  
1
2
Select the desired Style to serve as the basis for recording/editing  
When creating a new Style from scratch, press the [C] (NEW STYLE) button  
When recording channels BASS-  
PHR2 based on an internal Style,  
delete the original data before  
recording. Overdub recording is  
not possible on channels BASS-  
from the display shown in step 5 below.  
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [F] DIGITAL REC MENU  
When the RECORD display (chan-  
nel indication) at the lower part of  
the STYLE CREATOR display dis-  
appears, you can press the [F]  
(REC CH) button to re-display it.  
3
4
Press the [B] button to call up the Style Creator display.  
Use the TAB [][®] buttons, then select the BASIC tab to call up the  
RECORD display.  
Muting specific channels dur-  
ing recording  
Turn off the desired channels by  
5
6
Call up the display for selecting sections, etc. by pressing the [EXIT]  
button.  
pressing the [1  
tons.  
]–[8] but-  
π†  
Use the [3  
π†  
be recorded.  
Specifying sections from the  
panel buttons  
You can specify the sections to  
be recorded by using the Section  
buttons ([INTRO]/[MAIN]/[END-  
ING], etc) on the panel. Pressing  
one of the Section buttons calls  
up the SECTION display. Change  
the sections by using the  
[6π†]/[7π†] buttons and  
execute the selection by pressing  
7-2  
the [8  
π] button.  
The INTRO 4/ENDING 4 sec-  
tions cannot be specified with  
the panel controls.  
6
7-1  
π†  
π†  
] buttons to determine the length (number of  
7
Use the [5  
]/[6  
measures) of the selected section.  
Actually enter the specified length for the selected section by pressing the  
[D] (EXECUTE) button.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Style Creator  
8
Specify the channel to be recorded by simultaneously holding down  
the [F] (REC CH) button and pressing the appropriate numbered but-  
ton, [1 ]–[8 ].  
To cancel the selection, press the appropriate numbered button [1  
]–[8]  
again.  
8
10  
9
8
Limits on the recordable  
Voices  
RHY1 channel:  
π
π
]
9
Call up the Voice Selection display by using the [1 ]–[8  
buttons  
and select the desired Voice for the corresponding recording channels.  
Any except Organ Flute Voice/  
S. Articulation Voice  
RHY2 channel:  
Press the [EXIT] button to return to the previous display.  
10  
To delete a channel, simultaneously hold down the [J] (DELETE) but-  
Only drum/SFX kits  
π
π
ton and press the appropriate numbered button, [1 ]–[8 ].  
You can cancel the deletion by pressing the same numbered button again,  
before releasing your finger from the [J] button.  
BASS–PHR2 channels:  
Any except Organ FluteVoice,  
Drum/SFX kits, and S. Articula-  
tion Voice  
11  
Start recording by pressing the Style Control [START/STOP] button.  
Playback of the specified section starts. Since the accompaniment pattern  
plays back repeatedly in a loop, you can record individual sounds one by  
one, listening to the previous sounds as they play. For information on  
recording to channels other than the rhythm channels (RHY1, 2), refer to the  
section “Rules when recording non-rhythm channels” (see below).  
Deleting the recorded rhythm  
channel (RHY 1, 2)  
To delete a specific instrument  
sound, simultaneously hold  
down the [E] (RHY CLEAR) but-  
ton (from the display where the  
recorded channels are shown)  
and press the appropriate key.  
12  
To continue recording with another channel, simultaneously hold  
]
down the [F] (REC CH) button and press the appropriate [1 ]–[8  
button to specify the channel, then play the keyboard.  
13  
14  
Stop recording by pressing the Style Control [START/STOP] button.  
Call up the display for selecting sections, etc. by pressing the [EXIT]  
button.  
CAUTION  
The recorded Style will be lost  
if you change to another Style  
or you turn the power off  
without executing the Save  
15  
Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Style Selection display to  
save your data.  
Save the data in the Style Selection display (page 69).  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
120  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Style Creator  
Rules when recording non-rhythm channels  
• Use only the CM7 scale tones when recording the BASS and PHRASE  
channels (i.e., C, D, E, G, A, and B).  
• Use only the chord tones when recording the CHORD and PAD chan-  
nels (i.e., C, E, G, and B).  
Any desired chord or chord pro-  
gression can be used for the  
INTRO and ENDING sections.  
C = Chord notes  
C, R = Recommended notes  
C R C  
C R C  
Using the data recorded here, the auto accompaniment (Style playback) is appro-  
priately converted depending on the chord changes you make during your per-  
formance. The chord which forms the basis for this note conversion is called the  
Source Chord, and is set by default to CM7 (as in the example illustration above).  
You can change the Source Chord (its root and type) from the PARAMETER dis-  
play on page 127. Keep in mind that when you change the Source Chord from  
the default CM7 to another chord, the chord notes and recommended notes will  
Changing the Source Chord  
If you want to record the pattern  
with a Source Chord other than  
CM7, set the PLAY ROOT and  
PLAY CHORD parameters on the  
before recording.  
Step Recording (EDIT)  
The explanation here applies when selecting the EDIT tab in step 4 of “Realtime  
In the EDIT display, you can record notes with absolutely precise timing. This Step  
with the exception of the points listed below:  
• In the Song Creator, the End Mark position can be changed freely; in the Style  
Creator, it cannot be changed. This is because the length of the Style is automati-  
cally fixed, depending on the selected section. For example, if you create a Style  
based on a section of four measures length, the End Mark position is automati-  
cally set to the end of the fourth measure, and cannot be changed in the Step  
Recording display.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Style Creator  
• Recording channels can be changed in the Song Creator 1–16 tab display; how-  
ever, they cannot be changed in the Style Creator. Select the recording channel  
in the BASIC tab display.  
• In the Style Creator, the channel data can be entered and System Exclusive data can  
be edited (delete, copy, or move). You can switch between the two by pressing the  
[F] button. However, Chord, Lyrics, and System Exclusive data cannot be entered.  
Style Assembly (ASSEMBLY)  
Style Assembly allows you to create a single Style by mixing the various patterns  
(channels) from existing internal Styles.  
1
2
Select the basic Style, then call up the display for Style Assembly.  
The operation steps are the same as steps 1–4 in “Realtime recording”  
Select the desired section (Intro, Main, Ending, etc.) for your new Style.  
Call up the SECTION display by pressing one of the Section buttons  
([INTRO]/[MAIN]/[ENDING], etc.) on the panel. Change the section as  
desired by using the [6π†]/[7π†] buttons and execute the operation by  
pressing the [8π] (OK) button.  
Section display  
Indicates the channels  
that make up the section.  
3
Select the channel for which you wish to replace the pattern by using  
the [A]–[D] and [F]–[I] buttons. Call up the Style Selection display by  
pressing the same button again. Select the Style containing the pat-  
tern you want to replace in the Style Selection display.  
To return to the previous screen, press the [EXIT] button after selecting the Style.  
4
5
Select the desired section of the newly imported Style (chosen in step  
You cannot select the SECTION  
INTRO 4/ENDING 4 directly via  
the panel operation.  
π†  
π†  
]/[3 ] (SECTION) buttons.  
3 above) by using the [2  
Select the desired channel for the section (chosen in step 4 above) by  
π†  
using the [4  
π†  
]/[5 ] (CHANNEL) buttons.  
6
7
Repeat steps 3–5 above to replace the patterns of other channels.  
Press the [J] (SAVE) button to call up the Style Selection display, and  
CAUTION  
The recorded Style will be lost  
if you change to another Style  
or you turn the power off  
without executing the Save  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
122  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Style Creator  
Playing the Style During Style Assembly  
While you are assembling a Style, you can play back the Style and select  
the method of playback. Use the [6π†]/[7π†] (PLAY TYPE) buttons in  
the Style Assembly display to select the playback method.  
SOLO  
Mutes all but the selected channel in the ASSEMBLY tab display. Any  
channels set to ON in the RECORD display on the BASIC page are played  
back simultaneously.  
ON  
Plays back the selected channel in the ASSEMBLY tab display. Any chan-  
nels set to something other than OFF in the RECORD display on the BASIC  
page are played back simultaneously.  
OFF  
Mutes the selected channel in the ASSEMBLY tab display.  
Editing the Created Style  
You can edit the Style you’ve created by using Realtime recording, Step recording  
and/or Style Assembly.  
Basic Operation for Editing Styles  
1
2
Select a Style to be edited.  
Select the file to which the  
data is saved.  
You can also select the specified  
file to which the data is to be  
saved by pressing the [USB]/  
[USER] buttons.  
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [F] DIGITAL REC MENU  
3
4
Call up the Style Creator/Edit display by pressing the [B] button.  
[USB]/[USER] [B] STYLE →  
[A]–[J]  
Press the TAB[][®] button to select a tab.  
• Changing the Rhythmic Feel (GROOVE) See page 124  
These versatile features give you a wide variety of tools for changing the  
rhythmic feel of your created Style.  
• Editing Data for each Channel (CHANNEL) See page 126  
The editing features let you delete data as desired and apply quantize set-  
tings for each channel in the Style data.  
• Making Style File Format Settings (PARAMETER) See page 127  
For playback of your created Style, you can decide how notes will be con-  
verted and sounded for the accompaniment when changing chords in the  
chord section of the keyboard.  
5
Edit the selected Style.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Style Creator  
Changing the Rhythmic Feel (GROOVE)  
The explanation here applies when you select the GROOVE tab in step 4 of “Basic  
1
1
3
4
2
π†  
π†  
] buttons to edit the data.  
2
3
Use the [1  
]–[8  
For details on editable parameters, see page 125.  
Press the [D] (EXECUTE) button to actually enter the edits for each  
display.  
After the operation is completed, you can execute the edition and this but-  
ton changes to “UNDO,” letting you restore the original data if you’re not  
satisfied with the Groove or Dynamics results. The Undo function only has  
one level; only the previous operation can be undone.  
4
Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Style Selection display to  
save your data.  
CAUTION  
Save the data in the Style Selection display (page 69).  
The edited Style will be lost if  
you change to another Style  
or you turn the power off  
without executing the Save  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
124  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Style Creator  
GROOVE  
This lets you add swing to the music or change the “feel” of the beat by making  
subtle shifts in the timing (clock) of the Style. The Groove settings are applied to all  
channels of the selected Style.  
ORIGINAL BEAT  
Specifies the beats to which Groove timing is to be applied. In other  
words, if “8 Beat” is selected, Groove timing is applied to the 8th notes;  
if “12 Beat” is selected, Groove timing is applied to 8th-note triplets.  
BEAT CONVERTER  
Actually changes the timing of the beats (specified in the ORIGINAL  
BEAT parameter above) to the selected value. For example, when  
ORIGINAL BEAT is set to “8 Beat” and BEAT CONVERTER is set to “12,”  
all 8th notes in the section are shifted to 8th-note triplet timing. The  
“16A” and “16B” Beat Converter which appear when ORIGINAL BEAT  
is set to “12 Beat” are variations on a basic 16th-note setting.  
SWING  
Produces a “swing” feel by shifting the timing of the back beats,  
depending on the ORIGINAL BEAT parameter above. For example, if  
the specified ORIGINAL BEAT value is “8 Beat,” the Swing parameter  
will selectively delay the 2nd, 4th, 6th, and 8th beats of each measure  
to create a swing feel. The settings “A” through “E” produce different  
degrees of swing, with “A” being the most subtle and “E” being the most  
pronounced.  
FINE  
Selects a variety of Groove “templates” to be applied to the selected  
section. The “PUSH” settings cause certain beats to be played early,  
while “HEAVY” settings delay the timing of certain beats. The numbered  
settings (2, 3, 4, 5) determine which beats are to be affected. All beats  
up to the specified beat—but not including the first beat—will be  
played early or delayed (for example, the 2nd and 3rd beats, if “3” is  
selected). In all cases, “A” types produce minimum effect, “B” types  
produce medium effect, and “C” types produce maximum effect.  
DYNAMICS  
This changes the velocity/volume (or accent) of certain notes in the Style playback.  
The Dynamics settings are applied to each channel or all channels of the selected  
Style.  
CHANNEL  
Selects the desired channel (part) to which Dynamics is to be applied.  
ACCENT TYPE  
Determines the type of accent applied—in other words, which notes in  
the part(s) are emphasized with the Dynamics settings.  
STRENGTH  
Determines how strongly the selected Accent Type (above) will be  
applied. The higher the value, the stronger the effect.  
EXPAND/COMP.  
Expands or compresses the range of velocity values. Values higher than  
100% expand the dynamic range, while values lower than 100% com-  
press it.  
BOOST/CUT  
Boosts or cuts all velocity values in the selected section/channel. Values  
above 100% boost the overall velocity, while values below 100%  
reduce it.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Style Creator  
Editing Data for Each Channel (CHANNEL)  
The explanation here applies when you select the CHANNEL tab in step 4 of  
1
Press the [A]/[B] button to select the edit menu (see below).  
1
4
5
2
3
π†  
π†  
] (CHANNEL) buttons to select the channel to  
2
Use the [1  
be edited.  
The selected channel is shown at the upper left of the display.  
]/[2  
π†  
π†  
] buttons to edit the data.  
3
4
Use the [4  
]–[8  
For details on editable parameters, see below.  
Press the [D] (EXECUTE) button to actually enter the edits for each  
display.  
After the operation is completed, you can execute the edition and this but-  
ton changes to [UNDO], letting you restore the original data if you’re not  
satisfied with the results of the edit. The Undo function only has one level;  
only the previous operation can be undone.  
5
Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Style Selection display to  
save your data.  
CAUTION  
Save the data in the Style Selection display (page 69).  
The edited Style will be lost if  
you change to another Style  
or you turn the power off  
without executing the save  
operation.  
QUANTIZE  
Same as in the Song Creator (page 161), with the exception of the two  
additional available parameters below.  
C
Eighth notes with swing  
C
Sixteenth notes with swing  
VELOCITY  
CHANGE  
Boosts or cuts the velocity of all notes in the specified channel, accord-  
ing to the percentage specified here.  
BAR COPY  
This function allows data to be copied from one measure or group of  
measures to another location within the specified channel. SOURCE  
specifies the first (TOP) and last (LAST) measures in the region to be  
copied. DEST specifies the first measure of the destination location, to  
which the data is to be copied.  
BAR CLEAR  
This function clears all data from the specified range of measures within  
the selected channel.  
REMOVE EVENT  
This function lets you remove specific events from the selected channel.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
126  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Style Creator  
Making Style File Format Settings (PARAMETER)  
Special Parameter Settings Based on Style File  
Format  
Editing of Style File Format data  
is related only to note conver-  
sion. Editing the rhythm chan-  
nels has no effect.  
The Style File Format (SFF) combines all of Yamahas auto  
Source Pattern  
SOURCE ROOT  
(Chord Root setting of a Source Pattern)  
SOURCE CHORD  
accompaniment (Style playback) know-how into a single  
unified format. By using the Style Creator, you can take  
advantage of the power of the SFF format and freely create  
your own Styles.  
(Chord Type setting of a Source Pattern)  
The chart shown at left indicates the process by which the  
Style is played back. (This does not apply to the rhythm  
track.) These parameters can be set via the Style Creator  
feature.  
Chord change via the  
chord section of the  
keyboard.  
• Source Pattern  
Note Transposition  
NTR  
(Note Transposition Rule applied to the  
Chord Root change)  
NTT  
There are a variety of possibilities for Style playback  
notes, depending on the particular root note and chord  
type that are selected. The Style data is appropriately con-  
verted depending on the chord changes you make during  
your performance. This basic Style data that you create  
with the Style Creator is referred to as the “Source Pat-  
tern.”  
(NoteTranspositionTable applied to the  
Chord Type change)  
• Note Transposition  
This parameter group features two parameters that deter-  
mine how the notes of the Source Pattern are to be con-  
verted in response to chord changes.  
Other Settings  
HIGH KEY  
• Other Settings  
(Upper limit of the octaves of the note  
transposing caused by the Chord Root  
change)  
NOTE LIMIT (Note range in which the  
note is sounded)  
Using the parameters of this group, you can fine-tune how  
Style playback responds to the chords you play. For exam-  
ple, the Note Limit parameter allows you to have the  
Voices of the Style sound as realistic as possible by shift-  
ing the pitch to an authentic range—ensuring that no  
notes sound outside the natural range of the actual instru-  
ment (e.g., very low notes of a piccolo sound).  
RTR  
(Retrigger Rules that determine how  
notes held through chord changes will be  
handled)  
Output  
The explanation here applies when you select the PARAMETER tab in step 4 of  
1
1
4
2
3
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Style Creator  
π†  
Use the [1  
be edited.  
π†  
]/[2 ] (CHANNEL) buttons to select the channel to  
2
CAUTION  
The selected channel is shown at the upper left of the display.  
The edited Style will be lost if  
you change to another Style  
or you turn the power off  
without executing the Save  
operation.  
π†  
Use the [3  
π†  
]–[8 ] buttons to edit the data.  
3
4
For details on editable parameters, see below.  
Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Style Selection display to  
save your data.  
Save the data in the Style Selection display (page 69).  
Auditioning Your Style with a  
Specific Chord  
Normally in the Style Creator,  
you can hear your original Style-  
in-process with the Source Pat-  
tern. However, there is a way to  
hear it played by a specific chord  
and root. To do this, set NTR to  
“Root Fixed,” NTT to “Bypass,”  
and NTT BASS to “OFF” then  
change the newly displayed  
“Play Root” and “Play Chord”  
parameters to the desired set-  
tings.  
SOURCE ROOT/CHORD  
These settings determine the original key of the source pattern (i.e., the key used  
when recording the pattern). The default setting of CM7 (with a Source Root of “C”  
and a Source Type of “M7”), is automatically selected whenever the preset data is  
deleted prior to recording a new Style, regardless of the Source Root and Chord  
included in the preset data. When you change Source Root/Chord from the default  
CM7 to another chord, the chord notes and recommended notes will also change,  
depending on the newly selected chord type.  
When the Source Root is C:  
(9)  
(#11)  
(9)  
CM  
CM  
CM  
CM  
CM add9  
CM  
C
6
7
7
7
6
C
C
R
C
C
R
C
R
C
C
C
R
C
R
6
C
C
C
C
C
R
C
C
C
R
C
C
R
C
C
C
C
C
R
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
R
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
R
(9)  
b5  
(9)  
Cm  
C
Cm  
Cm  
Cm  
Cm  
7
7
7
Caug  
Cm  
C
C
C
R
C
C
C
R
C
C
C
C
C
C
R
C
R
C
C
C
R
R
R
R
R
C
R
R
C
C
R
C
C
R
C
C
R
7
C
C
R
R
R
C
C
(11)  
Cm  
(9)  
CmM  
Cdim  
C
sus  
4
Cdim  
C
7
CmM  
7
7
7
7
C
C
C
C
R
C
C
C
C
C
R
C
R
C
C
C
R
C
C
R
C
R
C
C
(b13)  
C
C
C
C
C
b5  
(9)  
(#11)  
(13)  
(#9)  
(b9)  
C
C
C
C
C
7
7
C
C
7
7
7
7
7
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
R
C
C
R
C
R
C
C
C
C
C
C
R
C
R
C
R
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
R
C
C
C
C
C
Csus  
Csus  
CM aug  
C
aug  
1+8  
1+5  
4
2
7
7
C
R
C
C
C
R
C
R
R
C
C
R
C
C
C
C
R
C
C
C
R
R
C = Chord notes  
C, R = Recommended notes  
NTR (Note Transposition Rule)  
This determines the relative position of the root note in the chord, when converted  
from the Source Pattern in response to chord changes.  
ROOT TRANS  
(Root Transpose)  
When the root note is transposed, the  
pitch relationship between notes is  
maintained. For example, the notes  
C3, E3 and G3 in the key of C become  
F3, A3 and C4 when they are trans-  
posed to F. Use this setting for chan-  
nels that contain melody lines.  
When playing a  
C major chord.  
When playing an F  
major chord.  
ROOT FIXED  
The note is kept as close as possible to  
the previous note range. For example,  
the notes C3, E3 and G3 in the key of  
C become C3, F3 and A3 when they  
are transposed to F. Use this setting for  
channels that contain chord parts.  
When playing a C  
major chord.  
When playing an  
F major chord.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
128  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Style Creator  
NTT (Note Transposition Table)  
This sets the note transposition table for the source pattern.  
BYPASS  
When NTR is set to ROOT FIXED, the transposition table used does not  
do any note conversion. When NTR is set to ROOT TRANS, the table  
used only converts the root note.  
MELODY  
Suitable for melody line transposition. Use this for melody channels  
such as Phrase 1 and Phrase 2.  
CHORD  
Suitable for chord transposition. Use this for the Chord 1 and Chord 2  
channels, especially when they contain piano or guitar-like chordal parts.  
MELODIC MINOR  
When the played chord changes from a major to a minor chord, this  
table lowers the third interval in the scale by a semitone. When the  
chord changes from a minor to a major chord, the minor third interval is  
raised by a semitone. Other notes are not changed. Use this for melody  
channels of Sections which respond only to major/minor chords, such  
as Intros and Endings.  
MELODIC MINOR  
5th  
In addition to the Melodic Minor transposition above, augmented and  
diminished chords affect the 5th note of the Source Pattern.  
HARMONIC  
MINOR  
When the played chord changes from a major to a minor chord, this  
table lowers the third and sixth intervals in the scale by a semitone.  
When the chord changes from a minor to a major chord, the minor  
third and flatted sixth intervals are raised by a semitone. Other notes are  
not changed. Use this for chord channels of Sections which respond  
only to major/minor chords, such as Intros and Endings.  
HARMONIC  
MINOR 5th  
In addition to the Harmonic Minor transposition above, augmented and  
diminished chords affect the 5th note of the Source pattern.  
NATURAL MINOR  
When the played chord changes from a major to a minor chord, this table  
lowers the third, sixth and seventh intervals in the scale by a semitone.  
When the chord changes from a minor to a major chord, the minor third,  
flatted sixth and flatted seventh intervals are raised by a semitone. Other  
notes are not changed. Use this for chord channels of Sections which  
respond only to a Major/minor chord such as Intros and Endings.  
NATURAL MINOR  
5th  
In addition to the Natural Minor transposition above, augmented and  
diminished chords affect the 5th note of the Source pattern.  
DORIAN  
When the played chord changes from a major to a minor chord, this  
table lowers the third and seventh intervals in the scale by a semitone.  
When the chord changes from a minor to a major chord, the minor  
third and flatted seventh intervals are raised by a semitone. Other notes  
are not changed. Use this for chord channels of Sections which respond  
only to a Major/minor chord such as Intros and Endings.  
DORIAN 5th  
In addition to the Dorian transposition above, augmented and dimin-  
ished chords affect the 5th note of the Source pattern.  
NTT BASS ON/OFF  
The channels for which this is set to ON will be played back by the bass root note,  
when the on-bass chord is recognized by the instrument.  
HIGH KEY  
This sets the highest key (upper octave limit) of the note transposition for the chord  
root change. Any notes calculated to be higher than the highest key are transposed  
down to the next lowest octave. This setting is available only when the NTR param-  
Example—When the highest key is F.  
Root changes  
CM  
C#M  
FM  
F#M  
Notes played  
C3-E3-G3  
C#3-F3-G#3  
F3-A3-C4  
F#2-A#2-C#3  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Style Creator  
NOTE LIMIT  
This sets the note range (highest and lowest notes) for voices recorded to the style  
channels. By judicious setting of this range, you can ensure that the voices sound  
as realistic as possible—in other words, that no notes outside the natural range are  
sounded (e.g., high bass sounds or low piccolo sounds). The actual notes that  
sound are automatically shifted to the set range.  
Example—When the lowest note is C3 and the highest is D4.  
Root changes  
CM  
C#M  
F3-G#3-C#4  
FM  
Notes played  
E3-G3-C4  
F3-A3-C4  
High Limit  
Low Limit  
RTR (Retrigger Rule)  
These settings determine whether notes stop sounding or not and how they change  
pitch in response to chord changes.  
STOP  
The notes stop sounding.  
PITCH SHIFT  
The pitch of the note will bend without a new attack to match the type  
of the new chord.  
PITCH SHIFT TO  
ROOT  
The pitch of the note will bend without a new attack to match the root  
of the new chord.  
RETRIGGER  
The note is retriggered with a new attack at a new pitch corresponding  
to the next chord.  
RETRIGGER TO  
ROOT  
The note is retriggered with a new attack at the root note of the next  
chord. However, the octave of the new note remains the same.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
130  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Registering and Recalling Custom Panel Setups—Registration Memory  
The Registration Memory function allows you to save (or “register”) virtually all  
panel settings to a Registration Memory button, and then instantly recall your cus-  
tom panel settings by pressing a single button. The registered settings for eight Reg-  
istration Memory buttons should be saved as a single Bank (file).  
Registering and Saving Custom  
Panel Setups  
Registering Custom Panel Setups  
1
Set up the panel controls (such as Voice, Style, effects, and so on) as  
desired.  
Refer to the separate Data List for a list of parameters that can be registered  
with the Registration Memory function.  
2
Press the REGISTRATION MEMORY [MEMORY] button. The display  
for selecting the items to be registered appears.  
Only the items selected here will be registered.  
2
5
3
4
π†  
π†  
] buttons to select items.  
3
4
Press the [2  
]–[7  
When recalling registration set-  
ups, you can also select the  
items to be recalled or not, even  
if you selected all items when  
To cancel the operation, press the [I] (CANCEL) button.  
Enter or remove the checkmark in the box of the item to determine  
whether the item should be registered or not, by pressing the  
π†  
[8  
] button.  
5
Press one of the REGISTRATION MEMORY [1]–[8] buttons to register  
your settings.  
It is recommended that you select a button whose lamp is not lit in red or  
green. Buttons that are lit in red or green, already contain the panel setup  
data. Any panel setup previously registered to the selected REGISTRATION  
MEMORY button (lamp lights in green or red) will be erased and replaced  
by the new settings.  
About the lamp status:  
Off.............. no data registered  
On (green)...data registered, but  
not currently selected  
On (red)......data registered, and  
currently selected  
Deleting an unneeded panel  
setup  
6
Register various panel setups to other buttons by repeating steps #1–  
#5.  
Deleting all eight current  
panel setups  
To delete all the eight current  
panel setups, turn the [POWER]  
button ON while holding the B6  
key (right-most B key on the key-  
board).  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Recalling the Registered Panel Setups  
Saving the Registered Panel Setups  
You can save all the eight registered panel setups as a single Registration Memory  
Bank file.  
Bank 4  
Bank 3  
Bank 2  
Bank 1  
1
2
Press simultaneously REGISTRATION MEMORY [REGIST BANK] but-  
tons [+][–] to call up the REGISTRATION BANK Selection Display.  
Registration Memory data  
compatibility  
In general, Registration Memory  
data (Bank files) is compatible  
among the models CGP-1000/  
CVP-409/407/405/403/401.  
However, the data may not be  
perfectly compatible, depending  
on the specifications of each  
model.  
2
1
Recalling the Registered Panel Setups  
1
Press simultaneously REGISTRATION MEMORY [REGIST BANK] but-  
tons [+][–] to call up the REGISTRATION BANK Selection Display.  
About recalling setups from a  
USB storage device  
When recalling the setups includ-  
ing Song/Style file selection from  
a USB storage device, make sure  
that the appropriate USB storage  
device including the registered  
Song/Style is connected into the  
[USB TO DEVICE] Terminal.  
2
Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a bank.  
3
2
2
3
Press one of the green-lit numbered buttons ([1]–[8]) in the Registra-  
tion Memory section.  
Parameter Lock  
You can “lock” specific parameters (e.g., effect, split point, etc.) to make them  
selectable only via the panel controls—in other words, instead of via Registration  
Memory, One Touch Setting, Music Finder, Song or incoming MIDI data, etc.  
Call up the Parameter Lock display ([FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB [√  
]
CONFIG 1 [B] 3 PARAMETER LOCK). Select the desired parameter by  
using the [1π†]–[7π†] buttons, then lock it with the [8  
π] button.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
132  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Recalling the Registered Panel Setups  
Deleting an Unneeded Panel Setup/Naming a  
Panel Setup  
The panel setups can be deleted or named individually as desired.  
1
Press simultaneously REGISTRATION MEMORY [REGIST BANK] but-  
tons [+][–] to call up the REGISTRATION BANK Selection Display.  
2
3
Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a bank to be edited.  
Press the [8 ] (EDIT) button to call up the REGISTRATION EDIT Dis-  
play.  
4
Edit the panel setups.  
• Deleting a panel setup  
Press the [5  
• Renaming a panel setup  
The number above  
the file name corre-  
sponds to the  
REGISTRATION  
MEMORY [1]–[8]  
buttons.  
π
Press the [8 ] (UP) button to return to the REGISTRATION BANK  
Selection display.  
5
Disabling Recall of Specific Items (Freeze Func-  
tion)  
Registration Memory lets you recall all the panel setups you made with a single  
button press. However, there may be times that you want certain items to remain  
the same, even when switching Registration Memory setups. For example, you may  
want to switch Voices or effect settings while keeping the same accompaniment  
Style. This is where the Freeze function comes in handy. It lets you maintain the set-  
tings of certain items and leave them unchanged, even when selecting other Regis-  
tration Memory buttons.  
1
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [E] REGIST SEQUENCE/FREEZE/VOICE SET →  
TAB [][®] FREEZE  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Recalling the Registered Panel Setups  
π†  
Press the [2  
π†  
]–[7 ] buttons to select items.  
2
CAUTION  
3
Enter checkmarks for the items to be “Frozen” (i.e., to remain  
Settings in the REGISTRATION  
FREEZE display are automati-  
cally saved to the instrument  
when you exit from this dis-  
play. However, if you turn the  
power off without exiting  
π†  
unchanged), by pressing the [8  
] button.  
4
Press the [FREEZE] button on the panel to turn the Freeze function  
on.  
from this display, the settings  
will be lost.  
5
Press the [EXIT] button to exit from the operation display.  
Calling Up Registration Memory Numbers in  
Order—Registration Sequence  
As convenient as the Registration Memory buttons are, there may be times during a  
performance when you want to quickly switch between settings—without having  
to take your hands from the keyboard. The convenient Registration Sequence func-  
tion lets you call up the eight setups in any order you specify, by simply using the  
TAB [][®] buttons or the pedal as you play.  
1
Select the desired Registration Memory bank to program a sequence  
2
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [E] REGIST SEQUENCE/FREEZE/VOICE SET →  
TAB [][®] REGISTRATION SEQUENCE  
3
4
If you intend to use a pedal to switch Registration Memory settings,  
specify here how the pedal will be used—to advance or to reverse  
through the sequence.  
Use the [C] button to select the pedal for advancing through the sequence.  
Use the [D] button to select the pedal for reversing through the sequence.  
Use the [E] button to determine how Registration Sequence behaves  
when reaching the end of the sequence (SEQUENCE END).  
STOP .....................Pressing the TAB [®] button or the “advance” pedal has  
no effect. The sequence is “stopped.”  
TOP .......................The sequence starts again at the beginning.  
NEXT BANK...........The sequence automatically moves to the beginning of  
the next Registration Memory Bank in the same folder.  
5
Program the Sequence order.  
The numbers shown at the lower part of the display correspond to the REG-  
ISTRATION MEMORY [1]–[8] buttons on the panel.  
Program the Sequence order from left to right.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
134  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Recalling the Registered Panel Setups  
Press one of the REGISTRATION MEMORY [1]–[8] button on the  
π†  
panel, then press the [6  
] (INSERT) button to input the number.  
• Replacing the number  
Press the [5π†] (REPLACE) button to replace the number at the cursor  
position with the currently selected Registration Memory number.  
• Deleting the number  
Press the [7π†] (DELETE) button to delete the number at the cursor  
position.  
• Deleting all numbers  
Press the [8π†] (CLEAR) button to delete all numbers in the sequence.  
6
7
Press the [F] button to turn the Registration Sequence function on.  
CAUTION  
Press the [DIRECT ACCESS] button, then press the [EXIT] button to  
return to the Main display and confirm whether the Registration  
Memory numbers are called up according to the sequence pro-  
grammed above.  
Settings in the REGISTRATION  
SEQUENCE display are auto-  
matically saved to the instru-  
ment when you exit from this  
display. However, if you turn  
the power off without exiting  
from this display, the settings  
will be lost.  
• Use theTAB [  
order of the sequence, or use the TAB [  
reverse order. The TAB [ ] [ ] buttons can only be used for Registration  
®] button to call up the Registration Memory numbers in the  
] button to call them up in  
®
Sequence when the Main display is called up.  
Returning to the first  
• When pedal operation has been set in step 3, you can use a pedal to select  
the Registration Memory numbers in order. The pedal can be used for Reg-  
istration Sequence no matter which display is called up (except for the dis-  
play in step 3 above).  
Sequence in one action  
In the Main display, press the  
TAB [] and [®] buttons simul-  
taneously. This cancels the cur-  
rently selected Sequence  
number (the box indicator at the  
top right goes out). The first  
Sequence will be selected by  
pressing one of the TAB [][®]  
buttons or by pressing the pedal.  
The Registration Sequence is indicated at the top right of  
the Main display, letting you confirm the currently selected  
number.  
Saving the Registration Sequence Settings  
The settings for the Sequence order and how Registration Sequence behaves when  
reaching the end of the sequence (SEQUENCE END) are included as part of the  
Registration Memory Bank file. To store your newly programmed Registration  
Sequence, save the current Registration Memory Bank file.  
1
2
Press simultaneously REGISTRATION MEMORY [REGIST BANK] but-  
tons [+][–] to call up the REGISTRATION BANK Selection display.  
CAUTION  
Keep in mind that all Registra-  
tion Sequence data is lost  
when changing Registration  
Memory Banks, unless you’ve  
saved it with the Registration  
Memory Bank file.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Using, Creating and Editing Songs  
Reference to Quick Guide Pages  
Practicing with the Preset Songs .................................................. page 35  
Playing Back Songs Before Practicing ..................................... page 35  
Displaying Music Notation (Score) ......................................... page 38  
One-handed Practice with the Guide Lamps ........................... page 39  
Practicing with the Repeat Playback Function ......................... page 41  
Recording Your Performance.................................................... page 42  
Singing Along with Song playback (Karaoke) or Your Own  
Performance............................................................................page 54  
Connecting a Microphone...................................................... page 54  
Singing with the Lyrics Display................................................ page 55  
Displaying Text ....................................................................... page 55  
Convenient Functions for Karaoke........................................... page 56  
Convenient Functions for Singing Along with Your  
Own Performance ................................................................... page 58  
Recording Your Performance as Audio ..................................... page 60  
Compatible Song Types  
The instrument can play back the following Song types.  
Preset Songs  
Songs in the Song Selection PRESET display.  
Before using a USB storage  
dling the USB Storage Device  
Your Own Recorded Songs  
These are Songs which you’ve recorded (page 42, page 143) and saved to the  
USER/USB display. (USB is available when you connect an USB storage device  
such as USB flash memory/floppy disk to the instrument.)  
Before using a floppy disk and  
the disk slot, be sure to read  
“Handling the Floppy Disk Drive  
Commercially Available Song Data  
Song data downloaded from theYamaha Web site and commercially available Disk  
Songs are available when you connect the optional floppy disk drive to the instru-  
ment. The instrument is compatible with the Song disks (floppy disks) that bear the  
following marks:  
Commercially available music  
data is subject to protection by  
copyright laws. Copying com-  
mercially available data is strictly  
prohibited, except for your own  
personal use.  
the types of Song data that can  
be played on the instrument.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
136  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Operations for Song Playback  
Operations for Song Playback  
This section explains detailed operations and functions related to Song playback  
which are not covered in the “Quick Guide.”  
Starting/Stopping a Song  
Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start Song playback, and press the SONG  
[STOP] button to stop. In addition, there are several other convenient ways to start/  
stop a Song.  
Depending on the particular  
Song data, the Style will also  
play back at the same time.  
Starting Playback  
Synchro Start  
You can start playback as soon as you start playing the keyboard.  
When playback is stopped, simultaneously hold down the SONG [STOP] button  
and press the [PLAY/PAUSE] button.  
To cancel the Synchro Start function, simultaneously hold down the SONG [STOP]  
button and press the [PLAY/PAUSE] button once again.  
• Tap function  
This useful function lets you press the [TAP TEMPO] button to tap out the tempo  
and automatically start the Song at that tapped speed. Simply tap (press/release)  
the button (four times for a 4/4 time signature) while the instrument is in Synchro  
Start standby mode, and the Song playback starts automatically at the tempo you  
tapped.  
Fade In  
The Fade In function can be used to produce smooth fade-ins when starting the  
Song. To produce fade-ins, press the foot pedal which is assigned to Fade In/Out  
while playback is stopped and then press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start  
Stopping Playback  
Fade Out  
The Fade Out function can be used to produce smooth fade-outs when stopping  
the Song playback. Press the foot pedal which is assigned to Fade In/Out at the  
beginning of the phrase you want to fade out. For information on the settings, see  
Set the Fade In/Out time  
The times of the fade-in and fade-out can be set independently. For details,  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Operations for Song Playback  
Top/Pause/Rewind/Fast Forward  
Moving to the top position of the Song  
Press the SONG [STOP] button, regardless of whether the Song is stopped or play-  
ing back.  
Pausing the Song  
Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button during Song playback. Press the SONG  
[PLAY/PAUSE] button again and the Song will resume from the current position.  
Moving back and forth (rewind and fast forward)  
1 Press the SONG [REW] or SONG [FF] button to move back and forth  
(rewind and fast forward).  
It calls up a pop-up window showing the current measure number in the  
Main display.  
For Songs containing Phrase Marks, you can use the [FF] or [REW] buttons  
to navigate through the Phrase Marks in the Song. If you don’t want to set the  
Song position by the phrase marks, press the [E] button and select “BAR” in  
the window showing the Song position.  
Phrase Mark:  
Phrase Mark is a pre-pro-  
grammed marker in certain Song  
data, which specifies a certain  
location (set of measures) in the  
Song.  
For Songs not containing  
Phrase Marks  
For Songs containing  
Phrase Mark  
2 Press the [EXIT] button to close the pop-up window showing the cur-  
rent measure number (or Phrase Mark number).  
Repeat Playback/Chain Playback  
1
2
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [B] SONG SETTING  
The preset Songs in the “Follow  
Lights” folder contain the Guide  
settings. These Songs are inap-  
propriate for use with ALL or  
RANDOM repeat.  
Set the parameters related to the Repeat Playback by using the [H]/[I]  
buttons. The available parameters are shown below.  
REPEAT MODE  
OFF  
Plays through the selected Song, then stops.  
SINGLE  
Plays through the selected Song repeatedly.  
ALL  
Continues playback through all the Songs in the folder  
containing the current Song repeatedly.  
RANDOM  
Randomly and repeatedly plays back all Songs in the  
folder containing the current Song.  
PHRASE MARK REPEAT For Songs containing Phrase Marks, you can set Repeat  
Playback to “ON” or “OFF.” When this is on, the part corre-  
sponding to the specified Phrase Mark number is repeatedly  
played back. The steps for specifying the Phrase Mark num-  
ber are the same as in the steps 1–2 of the section “Moving  
back and forth (rewind and fast forward)” (see above).  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
138  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                     
Operations for Song Playback  
Queuing the Next Playback Song  
While a Song is playing back, you can queue up the next Song for playback. This is  
convenient for chaining it to the next Song smoothly during stage performance.  
Select the Song you want play next in the Song Selection display, while a Song is  
playing back.  
Parameter Lock  
You can “lock” specific parame-  
ters (e.g., effect, split point, etc.)  
to make them selectable only via  
The “NEXT” indication appears at the upper right of the corresponding Song name.  
To cancel this setting, press the [8] (Cancel) button.  
Using the Auto Accompaniment Features with the  
Song Playback  
When playing back a Song and a Style at the same time, channels 9–16 in the Song  
data are replaced with style channels—allowing you to play the accompaniment  
parts of the Song yourself. Try playing chords along with the Song playback as  
shown in the instructions below. When playing back a Song and a Style at the same  
time, we recommend that you use the Preset Songs in the “Sing-a-long” folder.  
1
2
3
Press the STYLE CONTROL [ACMP ON/OFF] button to turn on the  
Auto Accompaniment function.  
4
Press the STYLE CONTROL [SYNC START] button to enable standby—  
letting you simultaneously start the accompaniment as soon as you  
start playing.  
5
6
Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start playback.  
Play chords along with the Song.  
The chord name is indicated in the Main display. To return to the Main dis-  
play, press the [DIRECT ACCESS] button, then press the [EXIT] button.  
If the Song data does not contain  
this data, the current chord name  
will not be displayed in the Main  
display during Song playback.  
When the Song playback is stopped, the style playback is also stopped at the same  
time.  
• Tempo for playing back a Song and a style at the same time  
When playing back a Song and a Style at the same time, the tempo value set in  
the Song is automatically used.  
Playing Songs with the Quick Start function  
With the default settings, the Quick Start function is turned on. On some  
commercially available Song data, certain settings related to the Song  
(such as voice selection, volume, etc.) are recorded to the first measure,  
before the actual note data. When Quick Start is set to “ON,” the instru-  
ment reads all initial non-note data of the Song at the highest possible  
speed, then automatically slows down to the appropriate tempo at the first  
note. This allows you to start playback as quickly as possible, with a mini-  
mum pause for reading of data. When Quick Start is set to “ON,” a Song is  
played back directly from the first note (which may be in the middle of a  
measure). If you want to play from the beginning of the measure that has  
silence prior to the first note, turn Quick Start “OFF.”  
1 Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [B] SONG SETTING  
2 Press the [7 ] (QUICK START) button to turn the Quick Start  
“OFF.”  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Adjusting the Volume Balance and Voice Combination, etc. (MIXING CONSOLE)  
Reading Song data automatically when connecting a USB stor-  
age device  
You can have the instrument automatically call up the first Song (not con-  
tained in a folder) on a USB storage device, as soon as the device is con-  
nected in the [USB TO DEVICE] terminal.  
1 Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB [][®] MEDIA  
π
π
2 Press the [3 ]/[4 ] (SONG AUTO OPEN) button to select “ON”.  
Adjusting the Volume Balance and  
Voice Combination, etc. (MIXING  
CONSOLE)  
You can set the mixing-related parameters of a Song. Refer to the section “Adjust-  
able items (parameters) in the MIXING CONSOLE display” on page 90. Call up the  
“SONG CH 1–8” or “SONG CH 9–16” display in step 3 of the Basic Procedure in  
“Editing the Volume Balance and Voice Combination (MIXING CONSOLE)” on  
page 88. Below are two operation examples.  
About the [SONG CH 1–8]/  
[SONG CH 9–16] displays  
A Song consists of 16 separate  
channels. Separate settings can  
be made for each of the 16 chan-  
nels in the MIXING CONSOLE  
display. Adjust the parameters in  
the SONG CH 1–8 or SONG CH  
9–16 display respectively. Usu-  
ally, CH 1 is assigned to the  
[TRACK 1] button, CH 2 is  
assigned to the [TRACK 2] but-  
ton, and CH 3–16 are assigned  
to the [EXTRA TRACKS] button,  
respectively.  
Adjusting the Volume Balance of Each Channel  
1
2
Press the [MIXING CONSOLE] button to call up the MIXING CON-  
SOLE display.  
3
4
Select the [VOL VOICE] tab by pressing the TAB [][®] buttons.  
Press the [MIXING CONSOLE] button repeatedly to call up the display  
of “SONG CH 1–8” or “SONG CH 9–16.”  
Press the [C]/[H] (VOICE) but-  
tons in step 5 to select the Voice  
which you want to change.Then,  
press one of the [1 π†] to [8  
π†] buttons to call up the  
Voice selection display for the  
channel.  
5
6
Press the [J] button to select the “VOLUME.”  
π†  
Adjust the volume balance of each channel by using the [1  
]–  
π†  
[8  
] buttons.  
7
You can save the volume settings to the Song in the Setup operation  
Make sure to checkmark the “VOLUME” item in step 2 of the Setup proce-  
dure.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
140  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Using the Practice Function (Guide)  
Changing Voices  
1–4  
The operation steps are the same as in the “Adjusting the Volume  
5
6
Press the [H] button to select the “VOICE”.  
π†  
π†  
]–[8 ] buttons to call up the Voice selec-  
Press one of the [1  
tion display for the channel.  
7
8
Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a Voice.  
You can save the changed Voice selection to the Song in the Setup  
Make sure to checkmark the “VOICE” item in step 2 of the Setup procedure.  
Using the Practice Function (Guide)  
Saving the Guide settings in  
the SONG SETTING display  
You can save the Guide settings  
as a part of the Song data  
(page 162). For Songs to which  
Guide settings have been saved,  
the Guide function will be auto-  
matically turned on and the  
related settings will be recalled  
when the Song is selected.  
The keyboard guide lamps indicate the notes (location and timing) for you to play.  
Also, when you sing along with a Song playback using a connected microphone,  
the instrument automatically adjusts the timing of the Song playback to match your  
vocal performance.  
To use the practice function, press the [GUIDE] button.  
Selecting the Guide Function Type  
1
2
Call up the setting display:  
[FUNCTION] [B] SONG SETTING  
Turning the keyboard guide  
lamps off  
Press the [C] (GUIDE LAMP) but-  
ton in the SONG SETTING dis-  
play (in step 1 as described at  
left) to turn the keyboard guide  
lamps off.  
Use the [A]/[B] buttons to select the desired Guide function type. The  
following types are available.  
2
1
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Using the Practice Function (Guide)  
For Keyboard Performance  
Follow lights  
With this function, the keyboard guide lamps indicate which notes you should play  
(page 39). Song playback pauses and waits for you to play. When you play the cor-  
rect notes, Song playback continues.  
Any key  
With this function, you can play the melody of a Song just by pressing a single key  
(any key is OK) in time with the rhythm. Song playback pauses and waits for you to  
play any key. Simply play a key on the keyboard in time with music (any key is OK)  
and the Song playback continues.  
For Karaoke  
Karao-key  
This function lets you control the Song playback timing with just one finger, while  
you sing along. Song playback pauses, waiting for you to sing. Simply play a key  
on the keyboard (any key is OK) and the Song playback continues. (For this func-  
tion, the notes of the keyboard do not sound.)  
Vocal CueTIME  
This function lets you practice singing with the proper pitch.  
Song playback pauses, waiting for you to sing. When you sing with proper pitch,  
Song playback continues.  
Determining the timing by which the keyboard guide lamps  
light (GUIDE LAMP TIMING)  
Press the [D] button in the SONG SETTING display in step 1 (page 141) to  
select the timing by which the keyboard guide lamps light.  
JUST........................... The guide lamps light in time with the music, at the  
same timing you should play.  
NEXT......................... The guide lamps light slightly ahead of the music,  
indicating the notes you should play next. The  
guide lamps flash if you fail to play the keys with  
the correct timing.  
If the guide lamps do not light as intended  
The guide lamps light according to Song channels recorded to Track 1 and  
2 and the chord data in the Song (when such data is included).  
If the guide lamps do not light as intended, you may need to assign the  
appropriate right- and left-hand channels to Track 1 and 2 respectively, by  
using the [1π†]/[2π†] buttons in the SONG SETTING display as  
described in step 1 on the previous page.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
142  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Recording Your Performance  
Turning playback channels of the Song on and off  
A Song consists of 16 separate channels. You can independently turn each  
channel of the selected Song playback on or off. Usually, CH 1 is assigned to  
[TRACK 1] button, CH 2 is assigned to [TRACK 2] button, and CH 3–16 are  
assigned to the [EXTRA TRACKS] button.  
1 Press the [CHANNEL ON/OFF] button to call up the Song CHANNEL  
ON/OFF display.  
If the display shown below does not appear, press the [CHANNEL ON/  
OFF] button again.  
π†  
2 Use the [1  
π†  
]–[8 ] buttons to turn each channel on or off.  
If you want to play back only one particular channel (muting all other chan-  
π†  
π†  
]–[8 ] buttons corresponding  
nels), press and hold down one of the [1  
to the desired channel. To cancel solo playback, press the same button again.  
Recording Your Performance  
You can record your own performances and save them to the User tab display or a  
USB storage device. Several different recording methods are available:  
Quick Recording which lets you record performance conveniently and quickly,  
Multi track Recording which lets you record several different parts to multiple  
channels, and Step Recording which lets you enter notes one by one. You can also  
edit the Songs you’ve recorded.  
The microphone input signal can  
not be recorded.  
Internal memory (User tab  
displays) capacity  
The internal memory capacity of  
the instrument is about 3.2MB.  
This capacity applies to all file  
types, including Voice, Style,  
Song, and Registration data files.  
Recording Methods  
There are three methods as shown below.  
Quick Recording  
This convenient and simple recording method lets you quickly  
record your performance—useful, for example, in recording solo  
piano pieces. You can record to the [TRACK 1 (R)] or [TRACK 2  
(L)] button, and also to the [EXTRA TRACKS (STYLE)] track,  
which can be used for recording at the same time.  
Multi track Recording This lets you record a whole Song including several different  
instrument parts, to create the sound of a full band or orchestra.  
Record the performance of each instrument part one by one  
and create fully orchestrated compositions.You can also record  
over already-recorded parts of an existing Song (Preset Song or  
a Song on USB storage device) with your own performance.  
Step Recording  
This method lets you compose your performance by “writing”  
it down one event at a time. This is a non-realtime, manual  
recording method – similar to writing music notation onto  
paper. You can input notes, chords and other events one by  
one (realtime performance is not needed).  
You can also edit Songs after they’ve been recorded (page 158).  
For example, you can edit specific notes one by one, or you can use the Punch In/  
Out function to re-record a specific part.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
143  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Recording Your Performance  
Quick Recording  
This lets you conveniently and quickly record your performance.  
1
Press the SONG [REC] and SONG [STOP] buttons simultaneously.  
A blank Song (“New Song”) is called up for recording.  
2
Make the desired panel settings for your keyboard performance.  
Below are some example settings you may want to try.  
• Recording the RIGHT 1 part  
Select the voice for the RIGHT 1 part by calling up the Voice selection dis-  
The RIGHT and/or LEFT parts are  
recorded onto separate tracks.  
• Recording the Dual voice (RIGHT 1 and 2 parts)  
voice for each keyboard part (RIGHT 1, 2) by calling up the Voice selec-  
tion display (page 32).  
With Multi Track Recording, you  
can record RIGHT 2 part individ-  
ually.  
• Recording the LEFT part  
voice for the LEFT part by calling up the Voice selection display (page 32).  
• Recording Styles  
2 Set the tempo for recording by pressing the TEMPO [–] [+] buttons, as  
necessary.  
• Using Registration Memory panel setups  
Press one of the REGISTRATION MEMORY [1–8] buttons.  
3
While holding the SONG [REC] button, press the SONG TRACK but-  
tons to be recorded.  
+
• Recording your performance  
Press the SONG [TRACK 1 (R)] button for the right-hand part recording,  
and/or the SONG [TRACK 2 (L)] button for the left-hand part recording.  
• Recording Styles  
Press the SONG [EXTRA TRACKS (STYLE)] button.  
• Recording your performance and the Style playback simultaneously  
Press the SONG [TRACK 1 (R)]/[TRACK 2 (L)] buttons and the  
SONG[EXTRA TRACKS (STYLE)] button.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
144  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Recording Your Performance  
4
5
Start recording.  
There are several different ways you can start recording.  
• Starting by playing the keyboard  
If you’ve selected the SONG [TRACK 1(R)]/[TRACK 2 (L)] buttons in step 3  
selected the SONG [EXTRA TRACKS (STYLES)] button in step 3 above,  
ing begins automatically as soon as you play a note on the keyboard.  
Using the metronome  
You can record your perfor-  
mance while playing back the  
metronome sound is not  
recorded.  
• Starting by pressing the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button  
If you start recording in this way, “empty” data is recorded until you play a  
note on the keyboard. This is useful for starting a Song with a short one-or  
two-beat pick-up or lead-in.  
• Starting by pressing the STYLE CONTROL [START/STOP] button.  
In this case the rhythm parts (channels) of the Style begin playing back and  
recording starts simultaneously.  
Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop recording.  
Pausing and restarting your  
recording  
To pause recording, press the  
SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button  
during recording. To restart  
recording, follow the operations  
shown below.  
• For recording to [TRACK 1]/  
[TRACK 2] recording, press the  
SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button.  
• For recording to [EXTRA  
TRACKS (STYLES)] recording,  
press the STYLE CONTROL  
[SYNC START] button, then  
play in the chord section of the  
keyboard.  
When recording is finished, a message prompting you to save the recorded  
performance data appears. To close the message, press the [EXIT] button.  
See step 7 for instructions on saving your recording.  
6
7
Listen to your newly recorded performance. Press the SONG [PLAY/  
PAUSE] button to play back the performance you just recorded.  
CAUTION  
The recorded Song data will  
be lost if you select another  
Song or turn the power to the  
instrument off without exe-  
cuting the Save operation  
Press the [SONG SELECT] button to call up the Song Selection display  
for saving your data, then save the data in the Song Selection display  
Multi Track Recording  
A Song consists of 16 separate channels. With this method, you can record data to  
each channel independently, one by one. Both Keyboard and Style parts can be  
recorded.  
About Channels  
1
Press the SONG[REC] and  
Example  
Recording the keyboard RIGHT 2  
part to the channel 2  
SONG[STOP] buttons simultaneously.  
A blank Song (“New Song”) is called up  
for recording.  
Turn the PART ON/OFF [DUAL  
(RIGHT2)] button on. Then, call up  
Voice Selection display, and select a  
Select Voices for recording the keyboard  
parts (RIGHT 1, RIGHT 2, and/or LEFT)  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Recording Your Performance  
2
While holding the SONG [REC] button,  
While holding the SONG [REC] but-  
ton, press the [2 ] button to set the  
channel 2 to “REC”.  
Setting all of the 9–16 chan-  
nels to “REC” simultaneously  
While holding the SONG [REC]  
button, press the SONG [EXTRA  
TRACKS (STYLE)] button.  
π
π†  
press the [1  
π†  
]–[8 ] buttons to  
set the desired channels to “REC”.  
Normally, the keyboard parts should be  
recorded to channels 1–8, and the Styles  
should be recorded to channels 9–16. To  
cancel the channel selection, press the  
SONG [REC] button again.  
3
+
When selecting the MIDI part  
• Setting a single channel to  
MIDI  
2
All incoming data received via  
any of the MIDI channels 1–16  
is recorded. When using an  
external MIDI keyboard or  
controller to record, this lets  
you record without having to  
set the MIDI transmit channel  
on the external device.  
• Setting several channels to  
MIDI  
When using an external MIDI  
keyboard or controller to  
record, this records data only  
over the set MIDI channel—  
meaning the external device  
must also be set to the same  
channel.  
3
Use the [C]/[D] buttons to select the  
desired part for the channel to be  
recorded.  
This determines which part—keyboard or  
Style (Rhythm 1/2, Bass, etc.)—is recorded  
to each of the channels selected in step 2.  
Default channel/part assignments are  
shown in the section “About Song chan-  
Press the [D] button to select  
the “RIGHT2”.  
To close PART selection display, press the  
[EXIT] button.  
4
5
Start recording.  
The method for starting is the same as in step 4 of Quick Recording (page 145).  
Recording each channel with  
the same tempo  
Use the Metronome function  
with the same tempo. Keep in  
mind that the metronome sound  
is not recorded.  
Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop recording.  
When recording is finished, a message appears prompting you to save the  
recorded performance appears. To close the message, press the [EXIT] but-  
ton. For instructions on saving Song data, see step 8.  
Pausing and restarting your  
recording  
6
7
Listen to your newly recorded performance. Press the SONG [PLAY/  
PAUSE] button to playback the performance you just recorded.  
To record another channel, repeat steps 2 through 6.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
146  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording Your Performance  
8
Press the [SONG SELECT] button to call up the Song Selection display  
for saving your data, then save the data in the Song Selection display  
CAUTION  
The recorded Song data will  
be lost if you select another  
Song or turn the power to the  
instrument off without exe-  
cuting the Save operation  
About Song channels  
Default channel/part assignments are shown below.  
Channels  
Default Parts  
Channels  
Keyboard parts  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
RHYTHM1  
RHYTHM2  
BASS  
CHORD1  
CHORD2  
PAD  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
RIGHT1  
PHRASE1  
PHRASE2  
About keyboard parts  
There are three keyboard parts, RIGHT 1, RIGHT 2 and LEFT. As the  
default, the RIGHT 1 part is assigned to each of the channels 1–8. Nor-  
mally, the keyboard parts should be recorded to the channels 1–8.  
About Style parts  
As the default, each of the Style parts is assigned to the channels 9–16,  
respectively as shown below. Normally, the Style parts should be recorded  
to the channels 9–16.  
RHYTHM ......... This is the basic part of the Style, containing the drum and  
percussion rhythm patterns. Usually one of the drum kits  
is used.  
BASS ................ The bass part uses various appropriate instrument sounds  
to match the style.  
CHORD ........... This is the rhythmic chord backing, commonly used with  
piano or guitar Voices.  
PAD ................. This part is used for sustained instruments such as strings,  
organ, choir, etc.  
PHRASE ........... This part is used for punchy brass stabs, arpeggiated  
chords, and other extras that make the accompaniment  
more interesting.  
Step Recording  
This method lets you record regular music data such as melodies and chords.  
Basic Operations for Step Recording  
1
Press the SONG[REC] and SONG[STOP] buttons simultaneously.  
A blank Song (“New Song”) is called up for recording.  
2
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [F] DIGITAL REC MENU  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
147  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Recording Your Performance  
3
4
Press the [A] button to call up the Song Creator display for recording/  
editing a Song.  
3
Select the appropriate tab by using the TAB [  
For recording melodies ..............Select the [1–16] tab.  
For recording chords..................Select the [CHORD] tab.  
][®] buttons.  
4
5
6
5
If you select the “1–16” tab in step 4, press the [F] button to select the  
channel for recording.  
6
7
Press the [G] button to call up the STEP RECORD display.  
Start Step Recording.  
For recording melodies ..............See page 149.  
For recording chords..................See page 156.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
148  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Recording Your Performance  
Recording Melodies  
This section explains how to step-record notes, using three music score examples.  
Since the music score displayed  
on the instrument is generated  
from the recorded MIDI data, it  
may not appear exactly the same  
as shown below.  
Example 1  
The explanations here apply to step 7 of the section “Basic Operations for Step  
3–5  
6 7  
2
1
* The numbers shown in the notation correspond to the following opera-  
tion step numbers.  
Select the Voice for recording after calling up the Step Record display.  
Press the [G] button to select “.”  
1
1
2
3
4
2
3
4
5
Press the [H] button to select “Tenuto.”  
Press the [I] button to select “normal” note type.  
π†  
About the items which can be  
selected via the [G] [H] [I] but-  
tons  
Press the [6  
] button to select the quarter-note length.  
Play the keys C3, D3, E3, F3, G3, and A3 in order, according to the  
notation example.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
149  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Recording Your Performance  
π†  
] button to enter a quarter-note rest.  
6
Press the [6  
To enter the rest, use the [4  
π†  
π†  
]–[8 ] buttons. (Press the button once to  
select the rest value, and once again to actually enter it.) A rest having spec-  
ified note length will be entered.  
7
8
Play the C4 key.  
Press the SONG [STOP] button to move the cursor to the beginning  
of the Song.  
8
9
9
Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to hear the newly entered  
notes.  
10  
Press the [EXIT] button to exit from the Step Record display.  
If you want, you can also edit already recorded Songs in the same manner  
CAUTION  
11  
Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Song Selection display for  
saving your data, then save the data in the Song Selection display  
The recorded Song data will  
be lost if you select another  
Song or turn the power to the  
instrument off without exe-  
cuting the Save operation  
Deleting data  
Mistakenly entered notes can be deleted.  
Move the cursor to the begin-  
ning of the Song.  
Press the SONG [STOP] button  
during recording.  
select the data you want to delete.  
2 Press the [J] (DELETE) button to delete the selected data.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
150  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Recording Your Performance  
About items which can be selected via the [G] [H] [I] buttons  
in the Step Record display  
About velocity  
Velocity is determined by how  
strongly you play the keyboard.  
The more strongly you play the  
keyboard, the higher the velocity  
value and the louder the sound.  
The velocity value can be speci-  
fied within a range from 1 to  
127. The higher the velocity  
value, the louder the sound  
becomes.  
[G] button ........... Determines the velocity (loudness) of the note to  
be entered.  
Items  
Velocity to be recorded  
Actual velocity you play the keyboard with  
Kbd.Vel  
fff  
ff  
f
127  
111  
95  
mf  
mp  
p
79  
63  
47  
pp  
ppp  
31  
15  
[H] button ........... Determines the gate time (note length) of the note to  
be entered.  
Items  
Gate time to be recorded  
80%  
99%  
40%  
20%  
Normal  
Tenuto  
Staccato  
Staccatissimo  
Manual  
The gate time (note length) can be set to any  
desired percentage by using the [DATA  
ENTRY] dial.  
[I] button............. Determines the note type to be entered. Pressing the  
button alternately switches the note selectors (at the  
bottom of the display) among three basic note values:  
normal, dotted and triplet.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Recording Your Performance  
Example 2  
The explanations here apply to step 7 of the “Basic Operations for Step Recording”  
2–5  
6–8 10–13 14–16  
1
9
* The numbers shown in the sheet correspond to the following operation  
step numbers.  
In this example, keep in mind that one of the steps involves holding down a key on  
the keyboard while executing the operation.  
Select the Voice for recording after calling up the Step Record display.  
Press the [G] button to select “.”  
1
About the items which can be  
selected via the [G] [H] [I] but-  
tons  
1
2
3
4
2
3
4
5
Press the [H] button to select “Tenuto.”  
Press the [I] button to select “normal” note type.  
π†  
Press the [5  
] button to select the half-note length.  
π†  
While holding F3 on the keyboard, press the [7  
] button.  
π†  
Before you go on to step 6, release the F3 key and the [7  
] button.  
6
7
Press the [H] button to select the “Staccato”.  
π†  
Press the [7  
] button to select the eighth-note length.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
152  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording Your Performance  
8
Play the keys E3, F3, and A3 in order, according to the notation exam-  
ple.  
Press the [G] button to select “.”  
Press the [H] button to select “Tenuto.”  
Press the [I] button to select “dotted.”  
π†  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
Press the [5  
] button to select the dotted half-note length.  
Play the A3 key on the keyboard, as specified in the example.  
Press the [I] button to select “normal” note type.  
π†  
Press the [6  
] button to select the quarter-note length.  
Play the F3 key on the keyboard, as specified in the example.  
Press the SONG [STOP] button to move the cursor to the beginning  
of the Song.  
17  
18  
18  
19  
20  
Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to hear the newly entered  
notes.  
Press the [EXIT] button to exit from the Step Record display.  
You can also edit the Songs you’ve recorded as necessary (page 158).  
CAUTION  
The recorded Song data will  
be lost if you select another  
Song or turn the power to the  
instrument off without exe-  
cuting the Save operation  
Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Song Selection display for  
saving your data, then save the data in the Song Selection display  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording Your Performance  
Example 3  
The explanations here apply to step 7 of the “Basic Operations for Step Recording”  
5
1–4 6 7  
* The numbers shown in the sheet correspond to the following  
operation step numbers.  
In this example, keep in mind that one of the steps involves holding down a key on  
the keyboard while executing the entire operations.  
Select the Voice for recording after calling up the Step Record display.  
1
Press the [H] button to select “Normal.”  
About the items which can be  
selected via the [G] [H] [I] but-  
tons  
1
2
3
2
3
4
Press the [I] button to select “normal” note type.  
π†  
Press the [7  
] button to select the eighth note.  
π†  
While holding C3 key on the keyboard, press the [7  
Do not release the C3 key yet. Keep holding it while executing the following  
] button.  
steps.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
154  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording Your Performance  
π†  
]
5
6
7
While holding the C3 and E3 keys on the keyboard, press the [7  
button.  
Do not release the C3 and E3 keys yet. Keep holding them while executing  
the following steps.  
While holding the C3, E3 and G3 keys on the keyboard, press the  
π†  
[7  
] button.  
Do not release the C3, E3 and G3 keys yet. Keep holding them while exe-  
cuting the following steps.  
While holding the C3, E3, G3 and C4 keys on the keyboard, press the  
π†  
π†  
] button.  
] button, release the keys.  
[7  
After you press the [5  
] button, and successively press the [5  
π†  
8
Press the SONG [STOP] button to move the cursor to the beginning  
of the Song.  
9
Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to hear the newly entered  
notes.  
10  
Press the [EXIT] button to exit from the Step Record display.  
If you want, you can also edit already recorded Songs in the same manner  
CAUTION  
The recorded Song data will  
be lost if you select another  
Song or turn the power to the  
instrument off without exe-  
cuting the Save operation  
11  
Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Song Selection display for  
saving your data, then save the data in the Song Selection display  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording Your Performance  
Recording Chords  
You can record Chords and Sections (Intro, Main, Ending, and so on) one at a time  
with precise timing. These instructions show how to record chord changes using  
the Step Record function.  
The explanations here apply to step 7 of the “Basic Operations for Step Recording”  
1
4
7
MAIN A  
BREAK  
MAIN B  
C
F
G
F
G7  
C
2,3  
5,6 8,9  
* The numbers shown in the notation correspond to the following operation step  
numbers.  
1
Make sure the STYLE CONTROL [AUTO FILL IN] button is set to OFF,  
then press the STYLE CONTROL [MAIN VARIATION A] button.  
3
C
1
F
G
2
π†  
] button to select the half-note length.  
2
3
4
Press the [5  
Play the chords C, F and G in the chord section of the keyboard.  
Press the STYLE CONTROL [BREAK] button.  
F
6
G7  
4
5
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
156  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Recording Your Performance  
π†  
] button to select the quarter-note length.  
5
6
7
Press the [6  
Play the chords F, and G7 in the chord section of the keyboard.  
Press the STYLE CONTROL [MAIN VARIATION B] button.  
7
9
C
8
π†  
Press the [4 ] button to select the whole-note length.  
8
9
Play the chord C in the chord section of the keyboard.  
CAUTION  
10  
Press the SONG [STOP] button to move the cursor to the beginning  
of the Song.  
The recorded Song data will  
be lost if you select another  
Song or turn the power to the  
instrument off without exe-  
cuting the Save operation  
11  
12  
Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to hear the newly entered  
notes.  
Deleting data  
Mistakenly entered notes can be  
Press the [EXIT] button to exit from the Step Record display.  
If you want, you can also edit already recorded Songs in the same manner  
13  
14  
Press the [F] (EXPAND) button to convert the input chord change  
data into the Song data.  
Entering fill-ins  
Turn the STYLE CONTROL  
[AUTO FILL IN] button to ON,  
and simply press one of the  
STYLE CONTROL [MAIN VARI-  
ATION (A, B, C, D)] buttons.  
(The appropriate fill-in section  
plays and then automatically  
goes to the selected [MAIN  
VARIATION (A, B, C, D)] pattern  
playback.)  
Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Song Selection display for  
saving your data, then save the data in the Song Selection display  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
157  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording Your Performance  
Editing a Recorded Song  
You can edit the Songs you’ve recorded with any recording method—Quick  
Recording, Multi Track Recording, or Step Recording.  
Basic Editing Operation  
1
2
Select a Song for editing.  
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [F] DIGITAL REC MENU  
3
Press the [A] button to call up the SONG CREATOR display to record  
or edit Songs.  
3
4
Select the appropriate tab by using the TAB [][®] buttons and edit  
the Song.  
• Re-Recording a Specific Section  
—Punch In/Out (REC MODE)............................................... page 159  
This lets you re-record a specific section of a Song.  
• Editing Channel Events (CHANNEL) .................................... page 160  
This lets you edit the channel events. For example, you can delete data or  
transpose notes by channel.  
• Editing Note or Chord Events (CHORD, 1–16) .................... page 163  
This lets you change or delete the recorded notes or chords.  
• Editing System Event (SYS/EX.) ........................................... page 165  
This lets you change the tempo or the time signature.  
• Editing Lyrics (LYRICS).......................................................... page 166  
This lets you change the Song name or lyrics events.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
158  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                     
Recording Your Performance  
Re-Recording a Specific Section—Punch In/  
Out (REC MODE)  
When re-recording a specific section of an already-recorded Song, use the Punch  
IN/OUT function. In this method, only the data between the Punch In point and  
the Punch Out point is overwritten with the newly recorded data. Keep in mind  
that the notes before and after the Punch In/Out points are not recorded over,  
although you will hear them play back normally to guide you in the Punch In/Out  
timing. You can specify the Punch In and Punch Out points as measure numbers  
beforehand for automatic operation, or manually execute the Punch In/Out record-  
ing by using a Foot Pedal or simply by playing the keyboard.  
The explanations here apply to the REC MODE display in step 4 of the “Basic Edit-  
π†  
π†  
] buttons to determine the settings for re-  
1
2
Use the [1  
recording (see below).  
]–[6  
While holding the SONG [REC] button, press the desired track but-  
ton.  
+
3
4
Press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button to start playback. Play the key-  
board at the Punch In point and stop recording at the Punch Out  
point.  
CAUTION  
Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Song Selection display for  
saving your data, then save the data in the Song Selection display  
The recorded Song data will  
be lost if you select another  
Song or turn the power to the  
instrument off without exe-  
cuting the Save operation  
PUNCH IN settings  
NORMAL  
Overwrite recording starts when pressing the SONG [PLAY/  
PAUSE] button or when you play the keyboard in the Synchro  
Standby mode.  
FIRST KEY ON  
PUNCH IN AT  
The Song plays back normally, then starts overwrite recording as  
soon as you play the keyboard.  
The Song plays back normally up to the beginning of the indi-  
cated Punch In measure, then starts overwrite recording at that  
point. You can set the Punch In measure by pressing the [3π†  
]
button.  
PUNCH OUT settings  
REPLACE ALL  
This deletes all data after the point at which recording is stopped.  
PUNCH OUT  
The Song position at which recording is stopped is regarded as  
the Punch Out point. This setting maintains all data after the  
point at which recording is stopped.  
PUNCH OUT AT  
Actual overwrite recording continues until the beginning of the  
specified Punch Out measure (set with the corresponding display  
button), at which point recording stops and normal playback  
continues. This setting maintains all data after the point at which  
recording is stopped. You can set the Punch Out measure by  
pressing the [6π†] buttons.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
159  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Recording Your Performance  
Examples of re-recording with various Punch In/Out settings  
This instrument features several different ways you use the Punch In/Out function.  
The illustrations below indicate a variety of situations in which selected measures  
in an eight-measure phrase are re-recorded.  
Original data  
PUNCH IN setting  
PUNCH OUT setting  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Start overwrite recording *1  
Stop recording *2  
NORMAL  
REPLACE ALL  
1
2
3
3
3
4
4
4
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
Start overwrite recording *1  
Stop recording *2  
NORMAL  
PUNCH OUT  
1
2
6
7
8
Stop overwrite recording/Play original data  
Start overwrite recording *1  
NORMAL  
PUNCH OUT AT=006  
1
2
6
7
8
Play the keyboard to  
start overwrite recording  
Stop recording *2  
Play back (Original data)  
FIRST KEY ON  
REPLACE ALL  
1
2
3
4
Stop recording *2  
Play the keyboard to  
start overwrite recording  
Play back (Original data)  
FIRST KEY ON  
PUNCH OUT  
1
2
3
4
6
7
8
Stop overwrite recording/Play original data  
Play the keyboard to  
start overwrite recording  
Play back (Original data)  
FIRST KEY ON  
PUNCH OUT AT=006  
1
2
3
4
6
7
8
Play back (Original data)  
Stop recording *2  
PUNCH IN AT=003  
REPLACE ALL  
Start overwrite recording  
1
2
3
4
Play back (Original data)  
Stop recording *2  
PUNCH IN AT=003  
PUNCH OUT  
Start overwrite recording  
1
2
3
4
6
7
8
Stop overwrite recording/Play original data  
Play back (Original data)  
PUNCH IN AT=003  
PUNCH OUT AT=006  
Start overwrite recording  
1
2
3
4
6
7
8
Previously recorded data  
Newly recorded data  
Deleted data  
*1 To avoid overwriting measures 1-2, start recording from measure 3  
*2 To stop recording, press the [REC] button at the end of measure 5.  
Pedal Punch In/Out settings  
Pedal Punch In/Out operation  
may be reversed depending on  
the particular pedal you’ve con-  
nected to the instrument. If nec-  
essary, change the pedal polarity  
When this is set to ON, you can use the sostenuto pedal to control the punch-in  
and punch-out points. While a Song is playing back, pressing (and holding) the  
sostenuto pedal instantly enables Punch In recording, while releasing the pedal  
stops recording (Punch Out).You can press and release the sostenuto pedal as often  
as you want during playback, to punch in/out of overwrite recording. Note that the  
current function assignment of the sostenuto pedal is cancelled when the Pedal  
Punch In/Out function is set to ON.  
Editing Channel Events (CHANNEL)  
The explanations here apply to the CHANNEL tab display in the step 4 of the Basic  
1
2
π†  
Use the [1  
π†  
]–[8 ] buttons to edit the data.  
For information on the available parameters, see page 161.  
3
Press the [D] (EXECUTE) button to execute the operation for the cur-  
rent display.  
After the operation (with the exception of the SETUP menu display) is com-  
pleted, this button changes to “UNDO,” letting you restore the original data  
if you are not satisfied with the Operation results. The Undo function only  
has one level; only the immediate operation can be undone.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
160  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Recording Your Performance  
4
Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Song Selection display for  
saving your data, then save the data in the Song Selection display  
CAUTION  
The recorded Song data will  
be lost if you select another  
Song or turn the power to the  
instrument off without exe-  
cuting the Save operation  
QUANTIZE menu  
The Quantize function allows you to align  
the timing of all the notes in a channel. For  
example, if you record the musical phrase  
shown at right, you may not play it with  
absolute precision, and your performance  
may have been slightly ahead of or behind  
the precise timing. Quantize is a conve-  
nient way of correcting for this.  
About Quantize size (resolu-  
tion)  
The Quantize size or resolution  
is the number of clocks per quar-  
ter note.  
CHANNEL  
SIZE  
Determines the channel in the Song to be quantized.  
Selects the quantize size (resolution). For optimum results, you should set the  
Quantize size to the shortest note value in the channel. For example, if eighth  
notes are the shortest in the channel, you should use eighth note as the Quantize  
size.  
After eighth note quantization  
Settings  
quarter  
note  
eighth note  
sixteenth  
note  
thirty-second  
note  
sixteenth note  
+ eighth note  
triplet*  
quarter  
note triplet  
eighthnote  
triplet  
sixteenth  
note triplet  
eighth note  
+ eighth  
note triplet*  
sixteenth  
note + six-  
teenth triplet*  
The three Quantize settings marked with asterisks (*) are exceptionally conve-  
nient, since they allow you to quantize two different note values at the same  
time. For example, when the straight eighth notes and eighth notes triplet are  
contained in the same channel, if you quantize by the straight eighth notes, all  
notes in the channel are quantized to straight eighth notes—completely elimi-  
nating any triplet feel. However, if you use the eighth note + eighth note triplet  
setting, both the straight and triplet notes will be quantized correctly.  
STRENGTH Determines how strongly the notes will be quantized. A setting of 100% pro-  
duces exact timing. If a value less than 100% is selected, notes will be moved  
toward the specified quantization beats according to the specified percentage.  
Applying less than 100% quantization lets you preserve some of the “human”  
feel in the recording.  
Quarter-note length  
Original data  
Quantizing strength=100  
Quantizing strength=50  
Deleting the data of the specified channel (DELETE menu)  
You can delete the data of the specified channel in the Song. Select the channel  
whose data to be deleted by using the [1π†]–[8π†] buttons, then press the [D]  
(EXECUTE) button to execute the operation.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
161  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Recording Your Performance  
Mixing (merging) the data of the specified two channels (MIX menu)  
This function lets you mix the data of the two channels and place the results in a  
different channel. It also lets you copy the data from one channel to another.  
SOURCE 1  
Selects the channel (1–16) to be mixed. All MIDI events in the  
selected channel are copied to the destination channel.  
SOURCE 2  
Selects the channel (1–16) to be mixed. Only note events in the  
selected channel are copied to the destination channel. In addi-  
tion to the values 1–16, there is a “COPY” setting that allows you  
to copy the data from Source 1 to the destination channel. If  
“COPY” is selected here, the data from Source 1 is copied to the  
destination channel. (The original channel data is maintained.)  
DESTINATION  
Selects the channel into which the mix or copy results will be  
placed.  
CHANNEL TRANSPOSE menu  
This allows you to transpose the recorded data of individual channels up or down  
by a maximum of two octaves in semitone increments.  
To display the channels 9–16  
Press the [F] button to toggle between the two channel displays—Channels 1–8,  
and Channels 9–16.  
Transposing to the same value for all channels simultaneously  
While holding the [G] (ALL CH) button, press one of the [1π†]–[8π†] buttons.  
SETUP menu  
tings can be recorded to the top position of the Song as the Setup data. The Mixing  
Console and panel settings recorded here are automatically recalled when the  
Song starts.  
Setup recording procedure  
1 Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [F] DIGITAL REC MENU [A] SONG CREATOR TAB  
[][®] CHANNEL [B] SET UP  
π†  
π†  
] buttons to determine the settings to be  
2 Use the [1  
]–[7  
automatically called up when the Song starts.  
SONG  
Records the tempo setting and all settings made from the Mixing  
Console.  
KEYBOARD VOICE Records the panel settings including the Voice selection of the  
keyboard parts (RIGHT1, 2, and LEFT) and their on/off status.  
Panel settings recorded here are same as the ones memorized to  
the One Touch Setting. This can be recorded at any point in a  
Song (the other items in this chart can be recorded only to the  
top position of the Song).  
SCORE SETTING  
GUIDE SETTING  
Records the settings in the Score display.  
Records the settings of the Guide functions including the Guide  
ON/OFF setting.  
LYRICS SETTING  
MIC SETTING  
Records the settings in the Lyrics display.  
Records the microphone and the Vocal Harmony settings in the  
Mixing Console display (page 88).  
π
3 Checkmark the selected item by pressing the [8 ] button.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
162  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Recording Your Performance  
4 Press the [D] (EXECUTE) button to execute the SETUP recording oper-  
ation.  
5
Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Song Selection display for saving  
your data, then save the data in the Song Selection display (page 69).  
CAUTION  
The recorded Song data will  
be lost if you select another  
Song or turn the power to the  
instrument off without exe-  
cuting the Save operation  
Editing Note or Chord Events (CHORD, 1–16)  
The explanations here apply to the CHORD and 1–16 tab displays in step 4 of the  
Basic Editing Operation on page 158.  
1
2
When the 1–16 tab display is selected, press the [F] button to select  
the channel to be edited.  
Move the cursor to the desired data.  
To move the cursor up or down ..............................Use the [A]/[B] button.  
To move the cursor to the top data..........................Press the [C] button.  
To move the cursor by Measure/Beat/Clock units ....Use the [1π†]–  
[3π†] buttons.  
3
Edit the data.  
Selecting multiple lines of  
data  
While holding the [J] (MULTI  
SELECT) button, press the [A]/[B]  
buttons.  
Editing the data line by line  
Use the [6π†]–[8  
events.  
π] buttons to cut/copy/paste/insert/delete the  
Editing each parameter of the data  
1 Use the [D]/[E] buttons to select the parameter to be edited.  
2 Use the [4π†]/[5π†] buttons to edit the parameter value. The  
[DATA ENTRY] dial can also be used. To actually enter an edited  
value, simply move the cursor away from the parameter.  
Displaying specific types of  
event (FILTER)  
You can select the event types to  
be displayed in the [CHORD]  
and [1-16] tab displays. This is  
convenient, for example, when  
you wish to have only the note  
To restore the original value, press the [8] (CANCEL) button before move  
the cursor.  
4
5
When the CHORD tab display is selected, press the [F] (EXPAND) but-  
ton to convert the data into Song data.  
CAUTION  
The recorded Song data will  
be lost if you select another  
Song or turn the power to the  
instrument off without exe-  
cuting the Save operation  
Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Song Selection display for  
saving your data, then save the data in the Song Selection display  
The data recorded by Realtime  
Recording will not appear on the  
display and cannot be edited.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
163  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Recording Your Performance  
About the events shown in the display  
1
2
3
About Clock  
A unit of note resolution. The  
Quantize size is the number of  
clocks per quarter note. On the  
instrument, one clock is equal to  
1/1920th of a quarter note.  
Example  
001 : 1 : 1440  
Clock  
Beat  
Measure number (BAR)  
1 Indicates the location (position) of the corresponding event. Same as the indication  
at the lower left of the display.  
2 Indicates the event types (see below).  
3 Indicates the event values.  
Event types shown on the 1–16 tab display  
Note  
The individual note of a Song. Includes the note number  
which corresponds to the key which was played, plus a  
velocity value based on how hard the key is played, and the  
gate time value (the length of a note).  
Ctrl (Control Change) Settings to control the Voice, such as volume, pan, filter and  
effect depth (edited via the Mixing Console described on  
page 88), etc.  
Prog  
MIDI program change number for selecting a Voice.  
(Program Change)  
P.Bnd (Pitch Bend)  
A.T. (Aftertouch)  
Data for changing the pitch of a Voice continuously.  
This event is generated when pressure is applied to a key  
after the note is played.  
Event types shown on the CHORD tab display  
Style  
Style  
Tempo  
Chord  
Sect  
tempo  
chord root, chord type, on bass chord  
Accompaniment Style Section (Intro, Main, Fill In, Break,  
Ending)  
OnOff  
On/off status for each part (channel) of the Accompaniment  
Style  
CH.Vol  
S.Vol  
Volume for each part (channel) of the Accompaniment Style  
Overall volume of the Accompaniment Style  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
164  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Recording Your Performance  
Displaying Specific Types of Events (FILTER)  
In the edit displays various types of events are shown. It may sometimes be difficult  
to pinpoint the ones you want to edit. This is where the Filter function comes in  
handy. It lets you determine which event types will be shown in the edit displays.  
1
2
3
Press the [H] (FILTER) button in the edit displays.  
π†  
π†  
]–[5 ] buttons.  
Select the event type by using the [2  
Checkmark (show) or remove the checkmark for the selected item by  
π†  
using the [6  
π†  
]/[7 ] buttons.  
[H] (ALL ON)..............Checkmarks for all event types.  
[I] (NOTE/CHORD).....Selects only NOTE/CHORD data.  
[J] (INVERT) ................Reverses the checkmark settings for all boxes. In  
other words, this enters checkmarks to all boxes that  
were previously unchecked and vice versa.  
4
Press the [EXIT] button to execute the settings.  
Pressing the [C]–[E] buttons calls up the respective Filter displays as shown below.  
MAIN .........................Call up the Main Filter display.  
CTRL CHG .................Call up the Control Change Filter display.  
STYLE .........................Call up the Accompaniment Style Filter Display.  
Editing System Exclusive Events (SYS/EX.)  
The explanations here apply to the [SYS/EX] tab display in step 4 of the Basic Edit-  
From this display, you can edit recorded System Exclusive events, which do not  
belong to a specific channel, such as tempo and beat (time signature). The opera-  
tions here are basically the same as those in the section “Editing Note or Chord  
System Events  
ScBar (Score Start Bar)  
Tempo  
Determines the top measure of a Song.  
Determines the tempo value.  
Time (Time Signature)  
Key (Key Signature)  
Determines the time signature.  
Determines the key signature, as well as the major/minor set-  
ting, for the music score shown on the display.  
XGPrm (XG Parameters)  
SysEx (System exclusive)  
Allows you to make various detailed changes to the XG parame-  
ters. Refer to the “MIDI Data Format” in the separate Data List  
booklet for details.  
Displays the System Exclusive data in the Song. Keep in mind  
that you cannot create new data or change the contents of the  
data here; however, you can delete, cut, copy, and paste the  
data.  
Meta (Meta Event)  
Displays the SMF meta events in the Song. Keep in mind that  
you cannot create new data or change the contents of the data  
here; however, you can delete, cut, copy, and paste the data.  
CAUTION  
Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Song Selection display for saving your  
data, then save the data in the Song Selection display (page 69).  
The recorded Song data will  
be lost if you select another  
Song or turn the power to the  
instrument off without exe-  
cuting the Save operation  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
165  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Recording Your Performance  
Editing Lyrics (LYRICS)  
The explanations here apply to the LYRICS tab display in step 4 of the Basic Editing  
Operation on page 158. From this display, you can edit the recorded Lyrics events.  
The operations here are basically the same as in the section “Editing Note or Chord  
Lyrics Events  
Name  
Allows you to enter the Song name.  
Allows you to enter lyrics.  
Lyrics  
Control Codes  
CR  
Enters a line break in the lyrics text.  
LF  
Unavailable on the instrument. On some MIDI devices, this  
event may delete the currently displayed lyrics and display the  
next set of lyrics.  
Inputting and Editing Lyrics  
π†  
editing display.  
π†  
]/[5 ] (DATA ENTRY) buttons to call up the lyrics  
1 Use the [4  
Operations are the same as in the section “Entering Characters” (page 72).  
CAUTION  
The recorded Song data will  
be lost if you select another  
Song or turn the power to the  
instrument off without exe-  
cuting the Save operation  
2 Press the [I] (SAVE) button to call up the Song Selection display for  
saving your data, then save the data in the Song Selection display  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
166  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Using a Microphone  
Reference to Quick Guide pages  
Singing Along with Song Playback (Karaoke) or Your Own  
Performance.................................................................................. page 54  
Connecting a Microphone...........................................................page 54  
Singing with the Lyrics Display ...................................................page 55  
Convenient Functions for Karaoke ..............................................page 56  
Adjusting the tempo................................................................ page 31  
Transpose................................................................................ page 56  
Applying effects to Your Voice ................................................. page 56  
Adding Harmony Vocals to Your Voice..................................... page 57  
Practicing Singing with Proper Pitch (Vocal CueTIME)........... page 142  
Convenient Functions for Singing Along with Your Own  
Performance.................................................................................page 58  
Changing the Key (Transpose).................................................. page 58  
Displaying the Music Score on Instrument and Lyrics on TV.... page 59  
Making Announcements Between Songs ................................. page 59  
Controlling Playback Timing by Your Voice (Karao-Key) ......... page 142  
Editing Vocal Harmony Parameters  
This section explains briefly how to create your own Vocal Harmony (page 57)  
types, and lists the detailed parameters for editing. Up to ten Vocal Harmony types  
can be created and saved.  
1
2
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [G] MIC SETTING/VOCAL HARMONY  
Press the [H] (VOCAL HARMONY TYPE) button to call up the VOCAL  
HARMONY TYPE selection display.  
2
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
167  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Editing Vocal Harmony Parameters  
3
Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a Vocal Harmony type to be  
edited.  
3
3
4
Press the [8 ] (EDIT) button to call up the VOCAL HARMONY EDIT  
display.  
4
5
π†  
If you want to re-select the Vocal Harmony type, use the [1  
]/  
π†  
[2  
] buttons.  
Or you can re-select the Vocal Harmony type by pressing the [8π†  
]
(RETURN) button to return to the Vocal Harmony selection display.  
8
5
6
7
π†  
π†  
6
7
Use the [3  
you want to edit.  
]–[5  
Set the value of the parameter selected above.  
CAUTION  
8
Press the [I] (SAVE) button to save your edited Vocal Harmony type  
The settings here will be lost  
if you change to another  
Vocal Harmony type or you  
turn the power off without  
executing the save operation.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
168  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Editing Vocal Harmony Parameters  
Editable Parameters in the VOCAL HARMONY EDIT Display  
VOCODER TYPE  
Determines how the harmony notes are applied to the micro-  
phone sound when the Harmony mode (page 173) is set to  
“VOCODER.”  
CHORDAL TYPE  
Determines how the harmony notes are applied to the micro-  
phone sound when the Harmony mode (page 173) is set to  
“CHORDAL.”  
HARMONY GENDER TYPE Determines whether the gender of the harmony sound is  
changed or not.  
Off  
The gender of the harmony sound is not changed.  
Auto  
The gender of the harmony sound is changed automatically.  
LEAD GENDER TYPE  
Determines whether and how the gender of the lead vocal sound  
(i.e., the direct microphone sound) will be changed. Please note  
that the number of harmony notes differs depending on the  
selected type. When set to Off, three harmony notes are pro-  
duced. Other settings produce two harmony notes.  
Off  
No gender change occurs.  
Unison  
No gender change occurs. You can adjust the LEAD GENDER  
DEPTH below.  
Male  
The corresponding gender change is applied to the lead vocal.  
Female  
The corresponding gender change is applied to the lead vocal.  
LEAD GENDER DEPTH  
LEAD PITCH CORRECT  
Adjusts the degree of lead vocal gender change. This is available  
when the LEAD GENDER TYPE above is set to other than Off.  
The higher the value, the more “feminine” the harmony voice  
becomes. The lower the value, the more “masculine” the voice.  
This parameter is only effective when the LEAD GENDER TYPE  
above is set to other than Off.  
When Smooth or Hard is selected, the pitch of the lead vocal is  
shifted in precise semitone steps.  
UPPER GENDER THRESH-  
OLD  
Gender change will occur when the harmony pitch reaches or  
exceeds the specified number of semitones above the lead vocal  
pitch.  
LOWER GENDER THRESH- Gender change will occur when the harmony pitch reaches or  
OLD  
exceeds the specified number of semitones below the lead vocal  
pitch.  
UPPER GENDER DEPTH  
Adjusts the degree of gender change applied to harmony notes  
higher than the UPPER GENDER THRESHOLD. The higher the  
value, the more “feminine” the harmony voice becomes. The  
lower the value, the more “masculine” the voice.  
LOWER GENDER DEPTH  
Adjusts the degree of gender change applied to harmony notes  
lower than the LOWER GENDER THRESHOLD. The higher the  
value, the more “feminine” the harmony voice becomes. The  
lower the value, the more “masculine” the voice.  
VIBRATO DEPTH  
VIBRATO RATE  
VIBRATO DELAY  
Sets the depth of vibrato applied to the harmony sound. Also  
affects the lead vocal sound when the LEAD GENDER TYPE  
above is set to other than Off.  
Sets the speed of the vibrato effect. Also affects the lead vocal  
sound when the LEAD GENDER TYPE above is set to other than  
Off.  
Specifies the length of the delay before the vibrato effect begins  
when a note is produced. Higher values result in a longer delay.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
169  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Adjusting the Microphone and Harmony Sound  
HARMONY1/2/3 VOLUME Sets the volume of the first (lowest), second, and third (highest)  
harmony notes.  
HARMONY1/2/3 PAN  
Specifies the stereo (pan) position of the first (lowest), second,  
and third (highest) harmony notes.  
Random  
The stereo position of the sound will change randomly when-  
ever the keyboard is played. This is effective when the Har-  
mony mode (page 173) is set to “VOCODER” or “CHORDAL.”  
L63>R – C – L<R63  
A setting of L63>R pans the sound hard left, while C is at cen-  
ter, and L<R63 is at hard right.  
HARMONY1/2/3 DETUNE Detunes the first (lowest), second, and third (highest) harmony  
notes by the specified number of cents.  
PITCH TO NOTE  
When this is set to “ON,” you can “play” the voices of the instru-  
ment with your voice. (The instrument tracks the pitch of your  
voice and converts it to note data for the tone generator. Keep in  
mind, however, that dynamic changes in your voice do not affect  
the volume of the tone generator.)  
PITCH TO NOTE PART  
Determines which of the instrument parts will be controlled by  
the lead vocal when the Pitch to Note parameter is “ON.”  
Adjusting the Microphone and Har-  
mony Sound  
1
2
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [G] MIC SETTING/VOCAL HARMONY  
Press the [I] (MIC SETTING) button to call up the MICROPHONE SET-  
TING display.  
2
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
170  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Adjusting the Microphone and Harmony Sound  
3
Press the TAB [] button to select the OVERALL SETTING tab display.  
3
4
4
6
5
4
Use the [A]–[J] buttons to select the item (parameter) (see below) to  
be adjusted.  
π†  
π†  
] buttons to set the value.  
5
6
Use the [1  
]–[8  
Press the [EXIT] button to exit from the MICROPHONE SETTING dis-  
play.  
CAUTION  
Settings in the OVERALL SET-  
TING tab display are automat-  
ically saved to the instrument  
when you exit from the dis-  
play. However, if you turn the  
power off without exiting  
from this display, the settings  
will be lost.  
Adjustable Items (Parameters) in the OVERALL SETTING Tab  
Display  
3BAND EQ  
EQ (Equalizer) is a processor that divides the frequency spectrum into multiple  
bands, which can be boosted or cut as required to tailor the overall frequency  
response. The instrument features a high-grade three-band (LOW, MID and HIGH)  
digital equalizer function for the microphone sound.  
• Hz  
Adjusts the center frequency of the corresponding band.  
• dB  
Boosts or cuts the level of the corresponding band by up to 12 dB.  
NOISE GATE  
This effect mutes the input signal when the input from the microphone falls below  
a specified level. This effectively cuts off extraneous noise, allowing the desired sig-  
nal (vocal, etc.) to pass.  
• SW (Switch)  
This turns the Noise Gate on or off.  
• TH. (Threshold)  
This adjusts the input level at which the gate begins to open.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
171  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Adjusting the Microphone and Harmony Sound  
COMPRESSOR  
This effect holds down the output when the input signal from the microphone  
exceeds a specified level. This is especially useful for smoothing out vocals that  
have widely varying dynamics. It effectively “compresses” the signal, making soft  
parts louder and loud parts softer.  
• SW (Switch)  
This turns the Compressor on or off.  
• TH. (Threshold)  
This adjusts the input level at which compression begins to be applied.  
• RATIO  
This adjusts the compression ratio.  
• OUT  
This adjusts the final output level.  
VOCAL HARMONY CONTROL  
The following parameters determine how the harmony is controlled.  
• VOCODER CONTROL  
The Vocal Harmony effect in Vocoder mode (page 173) is controlled by note  
data—the notes you play on the keyboard and/or the notes of the song data. This  
parameter lets you determine which notes are used to control the harmony.  
SONG CHANNEL  
MUTE/PLAY  
When set to “MUTE,” the channel selected below (to control  
Harmony) is muted (turned off) during song playback.  
OFF/Channels 1–16  
When set to “OFF,” song data control over harmony is turned  
off. When set to one of the values 1–16, note data (played  
from a song on the instrument or an external MIDI sequencer)  
contained on the corresponding channel is used to control the  
harmony. This setting is linked to the HARMONY CH setting in  
the SONG SETTING display (page 141).  
KEYBOARD  
OFF  
Keyboard control over harmony is turned off.  
UPPER  
Notes played to the right of the split point control the har-  
mony.  
LOWER  
Notes played to the left of the split point control the harmony.  
• BAL.  
This lets you set the balance between the lead vocal (your own voice) andVocal  
Harmony. Raising this value increases the volume of the Vocal Harmony and  
decreases that of the lead vocal.  
When this is set to L<H63 (L: Lead Vocal, H: Vocal Harmony), only the Vocal  
Harmony is output; when it is set to L63>H, only the lead vocal is output.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
172  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Adjusting the Microphone and Harmony Sound  
• MODE  
All of the Vocal Harmony types fall into one of three modes, which produce har-  
mony in different ways. The harmony effect is dependent on the selected Vocal  
Harmony mode, and this parameter determines how the harmony is applied to  
your voice. The three modes are described below.  
AUTO  
When the [ACMP ON/OFF] or [LEFT] is set to ON and if chord  
data exists in the song, the mode is automatically set to  
CHORDAL. In all other cases, the mode is set to VOCODER.  
VOCODER  
The harmony notes are determined by the notes you play on the  
keyboard and/or song data. You can specify whether theVocoder  
effect is controlled by your keyboard performance or by the Song  
CHORDAL  
The harmony notes are determined by the following three types  
of chord: chords played in the chord section of the keyboard  
(with the [ACMP] turned on), chords played in the LEFT Voice  
section of the keyboard (with the [ACMP] turned off and the  
[LEFT] turned on), and chords contained in song data for control-  
ling the harmony. (Not available if the song does not contain any  
chord data.)  
• CHORD  
The following parameters determine which data in a recorded song is used for  
chord detection.  
OFF  
XF  
Chords are not detected from the song data.  
Chords of XF format are used for the Vocal Harmony.  
1–16  
Chords are detected from note data in the specified song chan-  
nel.  
• Vocal Range  
Set this to obtain the most natural vocal harmony, depending on your voice.  
Normal  
Low  
Normal setting  
Setting for lower voice. This setting is also appropriate for growl-  
ing and shouting.  
High  
Setting for higher voice. This setting is also appropriate for sing-  
ing close to the microphone.  
MIC  
The following parameters determine how the microphone sound is controlled.  
• MUTE  
When set to ON, the microphone sound is turned off.  
• VOLUME  
Adjusts the output volume of the microphone sound.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
173  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Talk Setting  
Talk Setting  
This function lets you have special settings for making announcements between  
songs, separate from the settings for your singing performance.  
1
2
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [G] MIC SETTING/VOCAL HARMONY  
Press the [I] (MIC SETTING) button to call up the MICROPHONE SET-  
TING display.  
3
Press the TAB [®] button to select the TALK SETTING tab display.  
3
4
6
5
4
be set.  
π†  
π†  
] buttons to set the value.  
5
6
Use the [1  
]–[7  
Press the [EXIT] button to exit from the MICROPHONE SETTING dis-  
play.  
CAUTION  
Settings in the TALK SETTING  
tab display are automatically  
saved to the instrument when  
you exit from the display.  
However, if you turn the  
power off without exiting  
from this display, the settings  
will be lost.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
174  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Talk Setting  
Adjustable Items (Parameters) in the TALK SETTING Tab Display  
VOLUME  
PAN  
This determines the output volume of the microphone sound.  
This sets the stereo pan position of the microphone sound.  
REVERB DEPTH  
This sets the depth of the reverb effects applied to the micro-  
phone sound.  
CHORUS DEPTH  
This sets the depth of the chorus effects applied to the micro-  
phone sound.  
TOTAL VOLUME ATTENUA- This determines the amount of attenuation to be applied to the  
TOR  
overall sound (excepting the microphone input)—allowing you  
to effectively adjust the balance between your voice and the  
overall instrument sound.  
DSP MIC ON/OFF  
DSP MIC TYPE  
This turns the DSP effect applied to the microphone sound ON  
or OFF.  
This selects the type of DSP effect to be applied to the micro-  
phone sound.  
DSP MIC DEPTH  
This sets the depth of the DSP effect applied to the microphone  
sound.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
175  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Connecting the Clavinova Directly to the Internet  
The special website can be  
opened when directly connect-  
ing the Clavinova to the Internet.  
You can purchase and download Song data and other types of data from the spe-  
cial Clavinova website by directly connecting the instrument to the Internet. This  
section contains terms related to computers and online communications. If there  
Connecting the Instrument to the  
Internet  
You can connect the instrument to a full-time online connection (ADSL, optical fiber,  
cable Internet, etc.) via a router or a modem equipped with a router. For specific  
instructions on connecting (as well as information on compatible LAN adaptors, rout-  
ers, etc.), refer to the Yamaha website:  
Depending on the Internet con-  
nection, you may not be able to  
connect to two or more devices  
(for example, a computer and  
the instrument), depending on  
the contract with the provider.  
This means you cannot connect  
with the Clavinova. If in doubt,  
check your contract or contact  
your provider.  
http://music.yamaha.com/homekeyboard  
Use a computer to connect to the Internet and get online before connect-  
ing the instrument, since no modem or router settings can be made from  
the instrument itself.  
To use the Internet connection, you will first need to subscribe to an Internet ser-  
vice or provider.  
Connection example 1:  
Connecting by cable (using a modem without router)  
LAN cable  
Modem*  
Router  
No router capability  
Cable type  
Connect the LAN cable to the  
LAN port.  
LAN cable  
Due to EU regulations, users  
within Europe should use an STP  
(shielded twisted pair) cable to  
prevent electromagnetic interfer-  
ence.  
LAN port  
* Here, “modem” refers to an ADSL modem, optical network unit (ONU) or cable modem.  
Some types of modems require  
an optional hub network for  
simultaneously connecting to  
several devices (such as com-  
puter, musical instrument, etc.).  
Connection example 2:  
Connecting by cable (using a modem with router)  
LAN cable  
ADSL modem  
Router capability  
Connect the LAN cable to the  
LAN port.  
LAN cable  
LAN port  
Connection example 3: Wireless connection  
Modem*  
Access point  
A USB wireless LAN adaptor  
also can be used.  
Wireless Game Adaptor  
* Here, “modem” refers to an ADSL modem, optical network unit (ONU) or cable modem.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
176  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Accessing the Special Website  
Accessing the Special Website  
From the special website, you can audition and purchase Song data, among other  
things. To access the site, press the [INTERNET] button, while the instrument is  
connected to the Internet.  
To close the website display and return to the operation display of the instrument,  
press the [EXIT] button.  
Operations in the Special Website  
Scrolling the Display  
When the size of the web page is too large to be shown at one time in the browser  
display of the instrument, a scroll bar appears at the right side of the display. Use  
the [DATA ENTRY] dial to scroll through the display and view those parts of the  
page that are not shown.  
Scroll bar  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
177  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Operations in the Special Website  
Following Links  
When there is a link in the page, it is shown as a button or in colored text, etc. To  
select the link, press the [6 ]/[7π†]/[8 ] buttons or use the [DATA ENTRY]  
dial. Press the [8 ] (ENTER) button to actually call up the link destination.  
π
You can also select and call up links by using the [A]–[J] buttons.  
Entering Characters  
This section explains how to enter characters within the website, for inputting a  
Return to the Previous Web Page  
To return to a previously selected web page, press the [1π†] (BACK) button. To  
return to the page selected before pressing the [1π†] (BACK) button, press the  
[2π†] (FORWARD) button.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
178  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Operations in the Special Website  
Refreshing a Web Page/Canceling Loading of  
a Web Page  
To refresh a web page (to make sure you have the latest version of the page, or to  
try reloading), press the [5π] (REFRESH) button.  
To cancel loading of a page (if the page is taking too long to open), press the [6  
π]  
(STOP) button.  
Monitoring the Internet Connection Status  
The messages and icons at the bottom right of the Internet display indicate  
the current Internet connection status.  
Message  
1
2
3
4
The following three messages are displayed according to the loading status of  
the web page.  
“Disconnected”  
This appears when the instrument is not connected with the Internet. When  
this message is displayed, the web page cannot be seen. Icon 1 is displayed.  
“Now opening web page... ”  
The web page is being loaded. Icon 2 flashes.  
“Web page has been displayed. ”  
Loading of the web page is completed, and the page is displayed completely.  
Icon 2 stops flashing. When the displayed web page uses SSL, icon 3 is dis-  
played, and information is encrypted for communication.  
SSL:  
SSL (Secure Sockets Layer) is an  
industry-standard method for  
protecting web communications  
by using data encryption and  
other tools.  
Strength of the reception is displayed in 4 when connecting to the Internet by  
wireless LAN. When reception is weak, move the instrument near the access  
point to improve reception.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
179  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Operations in the Special Website  
Purchasing and Downloading Data  
You can purchase and download Song data (for playback on this instrument) and  
other types of data from the special website. For details on purchasing and down-  
loading data, refer to the instructions on the site itself.  
Operation after purchase and download  
When downloading is completed, a message appears asking you whether or not to  
open the File Selection display. Select “YES” to call up the File Selection display,  
from which you can select the downloaded data. To return to the Internet display,  
CAUTION  
The purchased data will be  
lost if you turn the power to  
the instrument off during  
download.  
select “NO” When the File Selection display is open, press the [8π] (UP) button to  
call up the next highest level folder.  
Download Destination  
The download destination depends on the use of storage media, as  
described below.  
• When a USB storage device is connected to the instrument during pur-  
chase:  
The downloaded data is saved in the “MyDownloads” folder in the USB  
tab display of the File Selection display. To close the folder and call up  
the next highest level folder, press the [8π] (UP) button in the File  
Selection display.  
• When a USB storage device is not connected to the instrument during pur-  
chase:  
The downloaded data is saved in the “MyDownloads” folder in the User  
tab display of the File Selection display. To close the folder and call up  
the next highest level folder, press the [8π] (UP) button in the File  
Selection display.  
Registering Bookmarks of Your Favorite Pages  
You can “bookmark” the page you’re viewing, and set up a custom link so the page  
can be instantly called up in the future.  
π†  
] (BOOK-  
1
2
With the desired page currently selected, press the [4  
MARK) button. The Bookmark display appears, showing a list of the  
currently registered bookmarks.  
The title of the currently selected web page is shown below the list.  
π†  
Call up the display for registering bookmarks by pressing the [3  
]
(ADD) button.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
180  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Operations in the Special Website  
π† π  
/
3
Select the position of the new bookmark by pressing the [1  
] (  
) button.  
3
4
π†  
] (EXECUTE) button, or  
] (CANCEL) button to cancel.  
4
5
To register the bookmark, press the [7  
π†  
press the [8  
π†  
To return to the browser, press the [8  
] (CLOSE) button.  
Opening a Bookmarked Page  
π†  
] (BOOKMARK) button to call up the Bookmark dis-  
1
2
Press the [4  
play.  
π† π †  
Press the [1 ) button to select the desired bookmark.  
] (  
/
2 3  
π†  
Press the [2 ] (VIEW) button to open the page of the selected  
bookmark.  
3
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
181  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Operations in the Special Website  
Editing Bookmarks  
From the Bookmark display, you can change the names and rearrange the  
order of your bookmarks, as well as delete unnecessary bookmarks from  
the list.  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
π †  
/
1
Moves the selection position in the Bookmark list.  
2 View  
Opens the web page of the selected bookmark.  
3 Add  
4 Move  
Changes the order of the bookmarks.  
π†  
1 Select the bookmark you wish to move, then press the [4  
]
(MOVE) button.  
The lower part of the display changes, letting you select the new posi-  
tion for the bookmark.  
π† π †  
)
2 Select the intended position by pressing the [1  
] (  
/
button.  
3 Move the bookmark to the selected position by pressing the  
π†  
[7  
] (EXECUTE) button.  
5 Changing names  
Changes the name of the selected bookmark. Pressing the [5π†] (CHANGE) but-  
ton calls up the display for entering characters. For details on entering characters,  
6 Delete  
Deletes the selected bookmark from the Bookmark list.  
7 Close  
Closes the Bookmark display and returns to the browser display.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
182  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Operations in the Special Website  
About the Internet Settings Display  
From the Internet Settings display, you can make various settings related to the  
Internet connection, including preferences for the menus and displays. The Internet  
Settings display has four sub-displays: Browser, LAN, Wireless LAN, and Others.  
Basic Operation  
Press the [5 ] (SETTING) button to call up the Internet Setting dis-  
play.  
1
2
3
Press the TAB [  
][  
®
] buttons to select the desired display.  
π† π †  
/
Select the desired item by pressing the [1  
] (  
) button.  
3 4  
π†  
π†  
] (EDIT)  
4
5
To call up the relevant Edit display, press the [2  
button.  
]/[3  
For some items, the Edit display may not be shown, but the setting or change  
may be executed.  
π† π †  
) button to select the setting or change the  
Press the [2  
value.  
] (  
/
This can also be done by using the [DATA ENTRY] dial.  
Entering Characters  
When the character input dis-  
play is opened, you can enter  
5 6  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
183  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Operations in the Special Website  
π
To execute the setting, press the [3 ] (ENTER) button. To cancel,  
press the [3 ] (CANCEL) button.  
6
7
To actually apply all settings changed in the Internet Settings display,  
π†  
press the [7  
To cancel, press the [8π†] (CANCEL) button.  
] (SAVE) button.  
Browser  
1
2
3
4
5
6
1 Encode  
Selects the character code encoding for the browser.  
2 Home Page  
Shows and allows editing of the web page which is set as the home page.  
3 Set current page as Home  
4 Restore Default Home  
Restores the home page setting.  
5 Show images  
Image data and pictures in the web page are shown in the browser when this is set  
to on. Image data is not shown when this is set to off.  
6 Time zone  
This determines the time zone setting for the browser.  
LAN  
Both the wired LAN and wireless LAN need to be set in this display.  
Make a written note of the settings here, in  
case you have to enter them again.  
1
2
Use DHCP  
DNS server1  
3
DNS server2  
IP address  
Subnet mask  
Gateway  
1 Use DHCP  
Determines whether or not DHCP is used. If your router is compatible with DHCP,  
select “ON.”  
2 DNS server 1/DNS server 2  
These determine the addresses of the primary and secondary DNS servers. These  
settings must be made when “Use DHCP” above is set to “ON (set DNS manu-  
ally)” or “OFF.”  
3 IP address/Subnet mask/Gateway  
These settings are available only when DHCP is not used. The settings here are: IP  
address, subnet mask, and gateway server address. These settings must be made  
when “Use DHCP” above is set to “OFF.”  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
184  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Operations in the Special Website  
Wireless LAN  
These settings here are only necessary when using a USB wireless LAN adaptor.  
the Wireless LAN settings below.  
The settings at left are not neces-  
sary when using the Wireless  
Game Adaptor.  
Make a written note of the settings here, in  
case you have to enter them again.  
1
2
3
4
SSID  
Channel  
5
Encryption  
WEP key type  
WEP key length  
WEP key  
1 Wireless Networks  
Determines whether or not Wireless Networks are displayed.  
2 SSID  
Determines the SSID setting.  
3 Channel  
Determines the channel.  
4 Encryption  
Determines whether or not the data is encrypted.  
5 WEP key type/WEP key length/WEP key  
These settings are available only when Encryption above is enabled. These set the  
type and length of the encryption key.  
Others  
1
2
3
4
5
1 Proxy server/Proxy port/Non-proxy server  
Determines the proxy server name, port number and the host name for the non-  
proxy server. The settings here are only necessary when using a proxy server. When  
using a non-proxy server, enter a separator (comma) between each server name.  
2 Delete cookies  
Deletes the information of all saved cookies.  
3 Delete all bookmarks  
Deletes all saved bookmarks.  
4 Initialize setup  
Restores all settings in the Internet Settings displays to their defaults. See “Initializ-  
5 Connection information  
Shows detailed information on the current connection.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
185  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Operations in the Special Website  
Changing the Home Page  
In the default condition, the top page of the special website is automatically set to  
be the Home page for the browser. However, you can specify any desired page on  
the special website to be the Home page.  
1
2
Open the page you wish to set as your new Home page.  
Press the [5 ] (SETTING) button to call up the Internet Setting dis-  
play.  
3
Press the TAB [] button to select the BROWSER tab.  
3
4 5  
6
4
5
6
Press the [1 ] ( ) button to select the setting “Set current page as  
Home.”  
π†  
π†  
] (EDIT) buttons to actually set the selected  
Use the [2  
]/[3  
page as your new Home page.  
π†  
To return to the browser, press the [7  
To cancel, press the [8π†] (CANCEL) button.  
] (SAVE) button.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
186  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Operations in the Special Website  
Initializing Internet Settings  
The settings of the Internet function are not initialized when using the Initialize  
operation of the instrument; Internet settings must be initialized separately, as  
explained here. Initializing will reset to the default values not only the settings of  
the browser, but also all settings you have made in the Internet Settings displays  
(except for the cookies and bookmarks), including those related to Internet connec-  
tion.  
Press the [5 ] (SETTING) button to call up the Internet Settings dis-  
play.  
1
2
3
Press the TAB [®] button to select the OTHERS tab.  
π† π †  
Press the [1 ] (  
/
) button to select “Initialize.”  
3 4  
π†  
Use the [2  
tings.  
π†  
]/ [3  
4
] (EDIT) buttons to initialize the Internet set-  
Delete cookies/bookmarks  
Cookies and bookmarks are still remain after executing the initialize oper-  
ation above.  
Sometimes cookies contain per-  
sonal information.  
To delete the cookies or bookmarks, use the appropriate operations in the  
OTHERS tab display (page 185).  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Glossary of Internet Terms  
Glossary of Internet Terms  
Broadband  
Browser  
Cookie  
An Internet connection technology/service (such as ADSL and optical fiber) that allows for high-speed, high-  
volume data communication.  
The software used to search for, access, and view web pages. For this instrument, this refers to the display  
that shows the contents of the web pages.  
A system that records certain information that the user transfers when visiting a website and using the Inter-  
net. The function is similar to a preference file in a conventional computer program, in that it “remembers”  
certain information such as your user name and password, so you don’t have to re-enter the information  
each time you visit the site.  
DHCP  
This is a standard or protocol by which IP addresses and other low-level network configuration information  
can be dynamically and automatically assigned each time connection is made to the Internet.  
DNS  
A system that translates names of computers connected to a network to their corresponding IP addresses.  
Download  
Transferring data over a network, from a larger “host” system to a smaller “client” system’s hard drive or  
other local storage device—much like copying files from your hard disk drive to a floppy disk. For this  
instrument, this refers to the process of transferring Song and other data from a website to the instrument.  
Gateway  
Home page  
Internet  
IP address  
LAN  
A system which links different networks or systems, and makes possible data transfer and conversion  
despite differing communications standards.  
The first page shown when opening a browser and connecting to the Internet. This phrase is also used to  
mean the “front screen” or top page of a website.  
A huge network made up of networks, the Internet allows high-speed data transfer among computers,  
mobile phones and other devices.  
A string of numbers assigned to each computer connected to a network, and indicating the device’s location  
on the network.  
Short for Local Area Network, this is a data-transfer network that connects a group of computers at a single  
location (such as an office or home) by means of a special cable.  
Link  
Location information in other sentences and images, etc. that are under buttons and character strings on a  
web page. When the place with the link is clicked, the page selection jumps to the relevant link.  
Modem  
NTP  
A device which connects and allows data transfer between a conventional telephone line and a computer. It  
converts the digital signals from the computer to analog audio for sending over the phone line, and vice versa.  
Short for Network Time Protocol, a standard for setting the internal system clock of the computer over a network.  
For this instrument, the internal clock of the computer is used to specify the valid time/date for cookies and SSL.  
Provider  
Proxy  
A communications business that offers Internet connection services. In order to connect to the Internet, it is  
necessary to contract to a provider.  
A proxy server is a server that all computers on a local network have to go through before accessing informa-  
tion on the Internet. It intercepts all or designated requests to the real server to see if it can fulfill the requests  
itself. If not, it forwards the request to the real server. Proxy servers are used to improve performance and  
speed, and to filter requests, usually for security and to prevent unauthorized access to an internal network.  
Router  
A device for connecting multiple computer networks. For example, a router is necessary when connecting several  
computers in a house or office, and allow them to all access the Internet and share data. A router is usually con-  
nected between a modem and a computer, although some modems have a built-in router.  
Server  
Site  
A hardware system or computer used as a central point for a network, providing access to files and services.  
Short for “website,” this refers to the group of web pages that are opened together. For example, the collec-  
tion of web pages whose addresses begin with “http://www.yamaha.com/” is referred to as theYamaha site.  
SSID  
SSL  
This is an identification name for specifying a particular network over a wireless LAN connection. Commu-  
nication is possible only between terminals with matching SSID names.  
Short for Secure Sockets Layer, a standard for transmitting confidential data such as credit card numbers  
over the Internet.  
Subnet mask  
URL  
A setting used to divide a large-scale network into several smaller networks.  
Short for Uniform Resource Locator, a string of characters used to identify and link to specific websites and  
pages on the Internet. A complete URL usually starts with the characters “http://.”  
Web page  
Refers to each individual page that makes up a website.  
Wireless LAN  
A LAN connection that allows data transfer through a wireless, cable-free connection.  
Wireless Game  
Adaptor  
Device that allows easy wireless connection with digital consumer electronic devices, printers, and game  
machines, etc. equipped with LAN ports.  
(Wireless Ethernet  
Converter or Bridge)  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
188  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Using Your Instrument with Other Devices  
CAUTION  
Connecting Audio & Video  
Devices (345)  
Before connecting the instrument to other electronic  
components, turn off the power of all the components.  
Also, before turning any components on or off, make sure  
to set all volume levels to minimum (0). Otherwise, elec-  
trical shock or damage to the components may occur.  
n
Use audio cables and adaptor plugs having no (zero) resistance.  
Using External Audio Devices for play-  
back and Recording (3 [AUX OUT]  
Jacks, [AUX OUT (LEVEL FIXED)] Jacks)  
You can connect these jacks to a stereo system to  
amplify the instruments sound or to a cassette tape  
recorder or a digital audio device for recording your  
performance. The microphone or guitar sound con-  
nected to the instruments [MIC./LINE IN] jack) is output  
2
1
at the same time. Refer to the diagrams below and use  
audio cables for connection. These jacks are located on  
the underside jacks panel of the instrument.  
Using Headphones  
(1 [PHONES] jacks)  
CAUTION  
When the instrument’s sound is output to an external  
device, first turn on the power to the instrument, then to  
the external device. Reverse this order when you turn the  
power off.  
Connect a pair of headphones to one of the [PHONES]  
jacks (standard 1/4" phone jacks) located on the leftward  
underside of the instrument. For details, see page 17.  
Do not route the output from the [AUX OUT] [AUX OUT  
(LEVEL FIXED)] jacks to the [AUX IN] jacks. If you make  
this connection, the signal input at the [AUX IN] jacks is  
output from the [AUX OUT] [AUX OUT (LEVEL FIXED)]  
jacks. These connections could result in a feedback loop  
that will make normal performance impossible, and may  
even damage both pieces of equipment.  
Connecting a Microphone or  
Guitar (2 [MIC./LINE IN] jack)  
By connecting a microphone to the [MIC./LINE IN] jack  
(standard 1/4" phone jack) located on the left underside  
of the instrument, you can enjoy singing along with  
Song playback (KARAOKE) or with your own perfor-  
mance. The instrument outputs your vocals or guitar  
sounds through the built-in speakers. For instructions on  
connecting, see page 54. Please note that when con-  
necting devices of high output level, make sure to set  
the [MIC. LINE] switch to “LINE.”  
[AUX OUT] Jacks  
(Standard phone jacks of [L/L+R] and [R])  
When these are connected, you can use the instru-  
ments [MASTER VOLUME] control to adjust the vol-  
ume of the sound output to the external device.  
Connect the instruments AUX OUT [L/L+R]/[R] jacks  
and the input jacks of a pair of powered speakers using  
appropriate audio cables. Use only the [L/L+R] jack for  
connection with a monaural device.  
The front side of the instrument  
(the keyboard side)  
6
7
Instrument  
Powered speakers  
8
9
The left side  
of the instru-  
ment  
Input jack  
Phone plug (standard)  
Audio cable  
Phoneplug  
(standard)  
5
4
3
)
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
189  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Connecting Audio & Video Devices  
[AUX OUT (LEVEL FIXED)] Jacks  
Showing the Instrument’s Display Con-  
tents on an External Monitor  
(5 [VIDEO OUT] Terminal, [RGB OUT]  
Terminal)  
(RCA pin jacks of [L]and [R])  
When these are connected (with RCA pin plug; LEVEL  
FIXED), the sound is output to the external device at a  
fixed level, regardless of the [MASTER VOLUME] con-  
trol setting. Use these when controlling volume with an  
external audio system, or recording the instruments  
sound to an external audio system. Connect the instru-  
ments AUX OUT [L]/[R] (LEVEL FIXED) jacks and the  
AUX IN jacks of an external audio system using appro-  
priate audio cables.  
Connect the instrument to an external monitor, and you  
can have the current display contents, lyrics or text files  
(for group sing-alongs and the like) displayed on the TV,  
video, computer. For instructions on connecting, see  
Settings  
Instrument  
Stereo system  
1
2
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [J] (UTILITY) TAB [][®  
SCREEN OUT  
]
Select the video equipment standard  
“NTSC”, “PAL”, or “RGB” by using the  
Pin plug  
Pin plug  
Audio cable  
π†  
π†  
[1  
]/ [2  
] buttons. Select the con-  
tents of the Screen Out signal—the current  
display contents (LCD) or lyrics (LYRICS)/  
π†  
π†  
text (TEXT) —by using the [3  
buttons.  
]/[4  
]
Playing External Audio Devices with the  
Built-in Speakers (4 [AUX IN] Jacks)  
The stereo outputs from another instrument can be con-  
nected to these jacks, allowing the sound of an external  
instrument to be reproduced via the instruments speak-  
ers. Connect the output jacks (LINE OUT etc.) of an  
external synthesizer or the tone generator module and  
the instruments AUX IN [L/L+R]/[R] jacks using appro-  
priate audio cables.  
Instrument  
Synthesizer  
Tone generator  
Phone plug (standard)  
Pin plug  
Audio cable  
n
• Set the NTSC or PAL to correspond to the standard used by  
your video equipment.  
• Set the RGB to computer monitor.  
CAUTION  
• When LYRICS/TEXT is selected as the contents of the Screen  
Out signal, only the lyrics of the song or text files are output  
via VIDEO OUT/RGB OUT, regardless of the display that is  
called up on the instrument.  
• Avoid looking at the television, video, or computer monitor  
for prolonged periods of time since doing so could damage  
your eyesight. Take frequent breaks and focus your eyes on  
distant objects to avoid eyestrain.  
When the sound of an external device is output to the  
instrument, first turn on the power to the external device,  
then to the instrument. Reverse this order when you turn  
the power off.  
n
• Use only the [L/L+R] jack for connection with a monaural device.  
• The instrument’s [MASTER VOLUME] setting affects the input  
signal from the [AUX IN] jacks.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
190  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Using the Footswitch or Foot Controller ([AUX PEDAL] jack)  
2
3
4
Use the [A]/[B] buttons to select one of the  
three pedals or the AUX-connected pedal, to  
which the function is to be assigned.  
Using the Footswitch or Foot  
Controller  
(6 [AUX PEDAL] jack)  
π†  
Use the [1  
] button to select the functions to  
By connecting a Foot Controller or Footswitch to the  
[AUX PEDAL] jack, you can have convenient control  
over various user-assignable functions. For example,  
connecting the Foot controller FC7 and assigning it the  
volume control function allows you to add expression  
to your performance by controlling the volume level of  
the notes you play. Or by connecting the FC4 or FC5  
footswitch and assigning it to the Style playback start/  
stop function, you can start and stop the Style with your  
foot. (In this case, the pedal has the same function as  
the panel STYLE CONTROL [START/STOP] button.) The  
assignable functions are listed following the instructions  
below.  
be assigned to the pedal specified in step 2.  
Details on the pedal functions are listed below.  
π† π†  
Use the [2 ]–[8 ] buttons to set the  
details of the selected functions.  
The available parameters differ depending on the  
function selected in step 3. Details on the parameters  
are given below.  
5
Check that the desired function is controllable  
with the pedal by actually pressing the pedal.  
n When you use a pedal to switch Registration Memory  
Set the polarity of the pedal  
Pedal on/off operation may differ depending on the partic-  
ular pedal you’ve connected to the instrument. For exam-  
ple, pressing down on one pedal may turn the selected  
function on, while pressing a different make/brand of  
pedal may turn the function off. If necessary, use this set-  
ting to reverse the control. Press the [I] (AUX PEDAL  
POLARITY) button to switch the polarity.  
Foot Pedals  
Footswitch FC4  
(optional)  
Footswitch FC5  
(optional)  
Foot Controller FC7  
(optional)  
CAUTION  
Make sure to connect or disconnect the pedal only when  
the power is off.  
Assigning Specific Functions to Each  
Foot Pedal  
In addition to the footswitch or foot controller, the three  
piano pedals installed to the instrument (Right, Center  
and Left pedals) can also be assigned to various func-  
tions here. The following explanations cover the related  
operations and assignable functions (parameters).  
1
Call up the operation display.  
[FUNCTION] [D] CONTROLLER TAB [√  
PEDAL  
]
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
191  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Using the Footswitch or Foot Controller ([AUX PEDAL] jack)  
Details on the pedal functions are listed here. For functions indicated with “ “, use only the foot controller; proper  
*
operation cannot be done with a footswitch.  
Assignable Pedal Functions  
VOLUME*  
SUSTAIN  
Allows you to use a foot controller to control the volume. This function is available only  
for the pedal connected to the instrument’s AUX PEDAL jack.  
Allows you to use a pedal to control the sustain. When you press and hold the pedal,  
all notes played on the keyboard have a longer sustain. Releasing the pedal immedi-  
ately stops (damps) any sustained notes.  
SOSTENUTO  
SOFT  
Allows you to use the pedal as a sostenuto pedal. In other words, if you play a note or  
chord on the keyboard and press the pedal while holding the note(s), the notes will sus-  
tain as long as the pedal is held. However, all subsequent notes will not sustain. This  
makes it possible to sustain a chord, for example, while other notes are played staccato.  
Allows you to use a pedal to control the Soft effect. Pressing this pedal reduces the vol-  
ume and changes the timbre of the notes you play. This is effective only for certain  
appropriate Voices.  
GLIDE  
When the pedal is pressed, the pitch changes, and then returns to normal pitch when  
the pedal is released.  
PORTAMENTO  
The portamento effect (a smooth slide between notes) can be produced while the pedal  
is pressed. Portamento is produced when notes are played legato style (i.e., a note is  
played while the preceding note is still held). Portamento Time can also be adjusted  
from the Mixing Console (page 90). This function does not affect certain NaturalVoices,  
which would not sound appropriately with this function.  
PITCH BEND*  
MOD/S.ART1*  
Allows you to bend the pitch of notes up or down by using the pedal.  
Applies a vibrato effect to notes played on the keyboard. Moreover, various effects can  
be added to the S. Articulation Voice (page 78). The effect becomes deeper when press-  
ing down the foot controller.You can turn this function on/off for each keyboard part on  
this display.  
MOD/S.ART2 (ALT)  
S.ART SW  
As a variation on MOD/S.ART1, the effects (waveform) can be switched on/off by the  
pedal/footswitch. The effects (waveform) is alternately turned on and off each time the  
pedal/footswitch is pressed. You can turn this function on/off for each keyboard part on  
this display.  
When you use a S. Articulation voice that has an effect assigned to the pedal/foot-  
switch, you can enable the effect by pressing the pedal/footswitch. You can turn this  
function on/off for each keyboard part on this display.  
DSP VARIATION  
Switches Voice Effect DSP VARIATION on and off.  
VIBE ROTOR ON/OFF  
Switches the VIBRATE SW parameter on and off when the VIBE VIBRATE effect type is  
selected.  
HARMONY/ECHO  
VOCAL HARMONY  
TALK  
Switches the HARMONY/ECHO Voice Effect on and off.  
Switches the Vocal Harmony function on and off.  
Switches the MIC SETTING Talk function on and off.  
While the song is stopped, you can turn to the next score page.  
While the song is stopped, you can turn to the previous score page.  
While the song is stopped, you can turn to the next lyrics page.  
While the song is stopped, you can return to the last lyrics page.  
You can turn to the next text page.  
SCORE PAGE+  
SCORE PAGE–  
LYRICS PAGE+  
LYRICS PAGE–  
TEXT PAGE+  
TEXT PAGE–  
You can return to the last text page.  
SONG PLAY/PAUSE  
STYLE START/STOP  
TAP TEMPO  
Same as the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button.  
Same as the STYLE CONTROL [START/STOP] button.  
Same as the [TAP TEMPO] button.  
SYNCHRO START  
SYNCHRO STOP  
Same as the [SYNC START] button.  
Same as the [SYNC STOP] button.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
192  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Using the Footswitch or Foot Controller ([AUX PEDAL] jack)  
INTRO1–3  
MAIN A–D  
FILL DOWN  
Same as the [INTRO I–III] buttons.  
Same as the [MAIN VARIATION A–D] buttons.  
Plays a fill-in, which is automatically followed by the Main section of the button on the  
immediate left.  
FILL SELF  
FILL BREAK  
FILL UP  
Plays a fill-in.  
Plays a break.  
Plays a fill-in, which is automatically followed by the Main section of the button on the  
immediate right.  
ENDING1–3  
Same as the [ENDING/rit. I–III] buttons.  
FADE IN/OUT  
Switches Fade In /Fade Out function on and off.  
FINGERED/FING ON BASS  
BASS HOLD  
The pedal alternately switches between the Fingered and On Bass modes (page 107).  
While the pedal is pressed, the Accompaniment Style bass note will be held even if the  
chord is changed during Style playback. If the fingering is set to “AI FULL KEYBOARD,”  
the function does not work.  
PERCUSSION  
The pedal plays a percussion instrument selected by the [4π†]–[8π†] buttons. You  
can use the keyboard to select the desired percussion instrument.  
DUAL ON/OFF  
SPLIT ON/OFF  
OTS+  
Same as the PART ON/OFF [DUAL (RIGHT2)] button.  
Same as the PART ON/OFF [SPLIT (LEFT)] button.  
Calls up the next One Touch Setting.  
OTS–  
Calls up the previous One Touch Setting.  
n The Sostenuto and Portament functions will not affect the Organ Flute Voices, even they have been assigned to the Foot Pedals.  
Adjustable Parameters for Each Function  
The parameters below correspond to buttons [2π†]–[8π†], and their availability depends on the selected control  
type. For example, if SUSTAIN is selected as the type, the parameters “HALF PEDAL POINT,” “RIGHT 1,” “RIGHT 2”  
and “LEFT” automatically appear in the display.  
SONG, STYLE, MIC, LEFT, RIGHT1,  
RIGHT2  
These specify the part(s) that will be affected by the pedal.  
HALF PEDAL POINT*  
You can specify how far down you should press on the pedal until the damper or soft  
DEPTH  
Determines the depth of the pedal effect.  
UP/DOWN  
When GLIDE or PITCH BEND is selected, this determines whether the pitch change is  
raised or lowered.  
RANGE  
When GLIDE or PITCH BEND is selected, this determines the range of the pitch  
change, in semitones. Linked to the Mixing Console Pitch Bend Range (page 90) set-  
ting.  
ON SPEED  
OFF SPEED  
KIT  
When GLIDE is selected, this determines the speed of the pitch change, when the pedal  
is pressed.  
When GLIDE is selected, this determines the speed of the pitch change, when the pedal  
is released.  
When PERCUSSION is assigned to the pedal, all available drum kits are shown here,  
letting you select the particular drum kit used for the pedal.  
PERCUSSION  
When PERCUSSION is assigned to the pedal, all sounds of the selected drum kit (in KIT  
above) are shown here. This determines the particular instrument sound assigned to the  
pedal.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
193  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting external MIDI devices ([MIDI] terminals)/Connecting a Computer or USB Device  
n
Connecting External MIDI  
About the [USB TO HOST] and [USB TO DEVICE] terminals  
There are two different types of USB terminals on the instrument:  
[USB TO HOST] and [USB TO DEVICE]. Take care not to confuse  
the two terminals and the corresponding cable connectors.  
Be careful to connect the proper plug in the proper direction. Expla-  
nations on the [USBTO DEVICE] terminal follow in the next section.  
Devices (7 [MIDI] Terminals)  
Use the built-in [MIDI] terminals and standard MIDI  
cables to connect external MIDI devices.  
MIDI IN  
Receives MIDI messages from an external  
MIDI device.  
CAUTION  
Precautions when using the [USB TO HOST] terminal  
When connecting the computer to the [USB TO HOST] termi-  
nal, make sure to observe the following points. Failing to do so  
risks freezing the computer and corrupting or losing data. If the  
computer or the instrument freezes, turn the power to the  
instrument off and restart the computer.  
MIDI OUT  
Transmits MIDI messages generated by the  
instrument.  
MIDI THRU Simply relays the MIDI messages received at  
MIDI IN.  
• Before connecting the computer to the [USB TO HOST] ter-  
minal, exit from any power-saving mode of the computer  
(such as suspended, sleep, standby), and quit any open appli-  
cation software, also turns off the power to the instrument.  
• Execute the following before turning the power to the instru-  
ment off or unplugging the USB cable to/from the instrument/  
computer.  
- Quit any open application software on the computer.  
- Make sure that data is not being transmitted from the  
instrument. (Data is transmitted only by playing notes on  
the keyboard or playing back a song.)  
For a general overview of MIDI and how you can effec-  
tively use it, refer to the following sections:  
• What is MIDI?..............................................page 196  
• What You Can Do With MIDI.......................page 199  
• MIDI Settings...............................................page 200  
• While a USB device is connected to the instrument, you  
should wait for six seconds or more between these  
operations: When turning the power of the instrument  
off then on again, or when alternately connecting/dis-  
connecting the USB cable.  
Connecting a Computer, USB  
Device, or Internet (789))  
Connecting a Computer  
(7 [MIDI] and 8 [USB TO HOST] Terminals)  
n
• The instrument will begin transmission a short time after the  
USB connection is made.  
• When using a USB cable to connect the instrument to your  
computer, make the connection directly without passing  
through a USB hub.  
By connecting a computer to the [USB TO HOST] or  
[MIDI] terminals, you can transfer data between the  
instrument and the computer via MIDI, and take advan-  
tage of sophisticated computer music programs. Keep in  
mind that you also need to install an appropriate USB-  
MIDI driver.  
• For information on setting up your sequence software, refer to  
the owner’s manual of the relevant software.  
• Connection by [MIDI] terminals  
The instructions below explain how to connect and use  
the terminals.  
There are two ways to connect the instrument via MIDI  
to a computer. If you have a MIDI interface built into  
your computer, connect the MIDI OUT terminal of the  
computer interface to the [MIDI IN] terminal of the  
instrument, and connect the [MIDI OUT] terminal of  
the instrument to the MIDI IN terminal of the interface.  
n
If you are using a computer that has a USB interface, we recom-  
mend that you connect the computer and the instrument by USB,  
rather than by MIDI.  
n
MIDI cable  
Driver  
[MIDI IN]  
terminal  
[MIDI OUT]  
terminal  
A driver is software that provides a data-transfer interface between  
the computers operating system and a connected hardware  
device. You need to install a USB-MIDI driver to connect the com-  
puter and the instrument. Refer to the separate Installation Guide  
(page 4).  
Instrument  
[MIDI OUT]  
terminal  
[MIDI IN]  
terminal  
Computer with MIDI  
interface installed  
This explanation is divided into two parts, covering the  
two connections: connection to the [USB TO HOST]  
terminal and connection to the [MIDI] terminal.  
• Connecting to the [USB TO HOST] terminal  
When connecting the instrument to the computer via  
USB, use a standard USB cable (having the USB logo)  
to connect the [USB TO HOST] terminal on the  
instrument to the USB terminal of the computer.Then,  
install the USB-MIDI driver.  
Instrument  
USB cable  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
194  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Connecting a Computer or USB Device  
n
The second connection possibility involves a separate,  
external MIDI interface connected to the computer via a  
USB port or a serial port (modem or printer terminal).  
Using standard MIDI cables, connect the MIDI OUT ter-  
minal of the external interface to the [MIDI IN] terminal  
of the instrument, and connect the [MIDI OUT] terminal  
of the instrument to the MIDI IN terminal of the interface.  
Checking remaining memory on the USB storage device  
You can check this in the display called up by the following oper-  
ation:  
[FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB [][®] MEDIA  
Select the device by using the [A]/[B] buttons in this display and  
press [F] (PROPERTY).  
n
USB port or serial  
port (modem or  
Even with a computer connected to the [USB TO HOST] terminal  
and a USB storage device connected to the [USB TO DEVICE] ter-  
minal, you cannot access the USB storage device from the com-  
puter via the instrument.  
printer terminal)  
MIDI cable  
[MIDI IN] MIDI interface  
Instrument  
terminal  
[MIDI OUT]  
terminal  
Formatting USB storage media  
For details, see page 68.  
Computer  
n
Make sure to use the appropriate MIDI interface for your computer.  
CAUTION  
Formatting a USB storage media completely erases all  
data on the media. Make sure that the USB storage media  
you’re formatting does not contain important data!  
Connecting to a USB-type LAN Adaptor  
and USB Storage Device  
(9 via the [USB TO DEVICE] Terminal)  
Backing up your data to a computer  
Backing up the instrument data to a computer  
Once you’ve saved data to a USB storage device, you can  
copy the data to the hard disk of your computer, then  
archive and organize the files as desired. Simply recon-  
nect the device as shown below.  
There are two ways of using the [USB TO DEVICE] ter-  
minal.  
By connecting the USB-type LAN adaptor, you can  
directly access special Internet websites for down-  
loading music data (page 176).  
By connecting the instrument to a USB storage  
device with a standard USB cable, you can save data  
you’ve created to the connected device, as well as  
read data from the connected device.  
Saves internal data to a USB storage device.  
n
USB storage device  
USB TO DEVICE terminal  
About the [USB TO HOST] and [USB TO DEVICE] terminals  
There are two different types of USB terminals on the instrument:  
[USB TO HOST] and [USB TO DEVICE]. Take care not to confuse  
the two terminals and the corresponding cable connectors.  
Be careful to connect the proper plug in the proper direction.  
Explanations on the [USB TO HOST] terminal can be found in the  
previous section.  
Computer  
Instrument  
Using USB Storage Devices  
This type is used to connect the instrument to a USB  
storage device, and allows you to save data you’ve cre-  
ated to the connected device, as well as read data from  
the connected device. The following description gener-  
ally explains about how to connect and use them.  
Before using a USB storage device, be sure to read  
Disconnect the USB storage device from the instrument and  
connect it to the computer  
Backing up data to a computer and organizing files/folders  
USB storage device  
Computer  
Instrument  
1
2
Connect the USB storage device to the [USB TO  
DEVICE] terminal with a standard USB cable.  
After that, exit once from the selection display  
then return to the display (or press the Tab  
switch buttons [] and [®] simultaneously from  
the selection display). The USB tabs (USB 1, USB  
2, etc.) are automatically called up, allowing you  
to save files and play back music data from the  
devices.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
195  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Connecting a Computer or USB Device  
What is MIDI?  
Copying files from a computer hard disk to a  
USB storage device  
Files contained on the hard disk of a computer can be  
transferred to the instrument by first copying them to the  
storage media, then connecting/inserting the media to the  
instrument.  
Not only files created on the instrument itself but also  
Standard MIDI files and Style File-formatted Style files cre-  
ated on other devices can be copied to a USB storage  
device from the hard disk of the computer. Once you’ve  
copied the data, connect the device to the [USB TO  
DEVICE] terminal of the instrument, and play back the  
data on the instrument.  
Put simply, MIDI is a data transfer standard that allows  
easy and comprehensive control among electronic/digi-  
tal music instruments and other devices. To get a better  
idea of what MIDI does, lets rst consider acoustic  
instruments, such as a grand piano and a classical gui-  
tar. With the piano, you strike a key, and a hammer  
inside hits some strings and plays a note. With the gui-  
tar, you directly pluck a string and the note sounds.  
But how does a digital instrument go about playing a  
note?  
Acoustic guitar note  
Digital instrument note pro-  
production  
duction  
Copying the files of the hard disk of the computer to the USB  
storage device  
Internal amp  
Internal amp  
Tone generator  
(Electric circuit)  
L
R
USB storage device  
Computer  
Playing the key board  
Instrument  
Based on playing information  
from the keyboard, a sampling  
note stored in the tone generator  
is played through the speakers.  
Pluck a string and the  
body resonates the  
sound.  
Disconnect the USB storage  
device from the computer and  
connect it to the instrument  
As shown in the illustration above, in an electronic  
instrument the sampling note (previously recorded  
note) stored in the tone generator section (electronic  
circuit) is played based on information received from  
the keyboard.  
Reading files on the USB storage device from the instrument  
Now, let’s examine what happens when we playback a  
recording. When you play back a music CD (for exam-  
ple, a solo piano recording), you’re hearing the actual  
sound (vibration in air) of the acoustic instrument. This  
USB storage device  
[USB TO DEVICE] terminal  
Instrument  
Computer  
Recording and playing back the performance of an  
acoustic instrument (audio data)  
Recording  
Playback  
Connect to the Internet () [LAN] Port)  
There are three ways to use the [LAN] port (located on  
the bottom left of the instrument) to access special Inter-  
net websites, and download song data, etc.  
In the above example, the actual acoustic sounds of the  
pianists performance are captured in the recording as  
audio data, and this is recorded to CD. When you play  
back that CD on your audio system, you can hear the  
actual piano performance. The piano itself is not neces-  
sary, since the recording contains the actual sounds of  
the piano, and your speakers reproduce them.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
196  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Connecting a Computer or USB Device/What is MIDI  
Finally, we’ll take a look at the actual data that gets  
recorded and that serves as the basis for playing the  
sounds. For example, lets say you play a “C” quarter  
note using the grand piano sound on the instruments  
keyboard. Unlike an acoustic instrument that puts out a  
resonated note, the electronic instrument puts out infor-  
mation from the keyboard such as “with what voice,”  
“with which key,” “about how strong,” “when was it  
pressed” and “when was it released.” Then each piece  
of information is changed into a number value and sent  
to the tone generator. Using these numbers as a basis  
for sound generation, the tone generator plays the  
stored sampled note.  
Recording and play back the performance of a digital  
instrument (MIDI data)  
Recording  
Playback  
Tone Generator  
Sequencer  
Controller (keyboard, etc.)  
USB storage  
device  
USB storage  
device  
Example Keyboard Data  
n
In the case of digital instruments, the audio signals are sent  
through output jacks (such as [AUX OUT]) on the instrument.  
Voice number (with what voice)  
Note number (with which key)  
01 (grand piano)  
60 (C3)  
Note on (when was it pressed)  
and  
note off (when was it released)  
Timing expressed  
numerically  
(quarter note)  
The “controller” and “tone generator” in the illustration  
above are equivalent to the piano in our acoustic exam-  
ple. Here, the player’s performance on the keyboard is  
captured as MIDI song data (see illustration below). In  
order to record the audio performance on an acoustic  
piano, special recording equipment is needed. How-  
ever, since the instrument features a built-in sequencer  
that lets you record performance data, this recording  
equipment is unnecessary. Instead, your digital instru-  
ment—the Clavinova—allows you to both record and  
play back the data.  
Velocity  
120 (strong)  
(strength at which it was played)  
Panel operations on the instrument, such as playing the  
keyboard and selecting voices, are processed and  
stored as MIDI data. The auto accompaniment Styles  
and Songs also consist of MIDI data.  
MIDI is an acronym that stands for Musical Instrument  
Digital Interface, which allows electronic musical  
instruments to communicate with each other, by send-  
ing and receiving compatible Note, Control Change,  
Program Change and various other types of MIDI data,  
or messages.  
Tone generator  
Sequencer  
The instrument can control a MIDI device by transmit-  
ting note related data and various types of controller  
data. The instrument can be controlled by incoming  
MIDI messages which automatically determine the tone  
generator mode, select MIDI channels, voices and  
effects, change parameter values and of course play the  
voices specified for the various parts.  
Keyboard performance (MIDI data)  
However, we also need a sound source to produce the  
audio, which eventually comes from your speakers. The  
tone generator of the instrument fills this function. The  
recorded performance is reproduced by the sequencer,  
playing back the song data, using a tone generator  
capable of accurately producing various instrument  
sounds—including that of a piano. Looked at in another  
way, the relation of the sequencer and the tone genera-  
tor is similar to that of the pianist and the piano—one  
plays the other. Since digital instruments handle play-  
back data and the actual sounds independently, we can  
hear our piano performance played by another instru-  
ment, such as guitar or violin.  
n
MIDI data has the following advantages over audio data:  
• The amount of data is much less.  
• The data can be effectively and easily edited, even to the point  
of changing voices and transforming the data.  
MIDI messages can be divided into two groups: Chan-  
nel messages and System messages.  
n
Channel Messages  
Even though it is a single musical instrument, the instrument can  
be thought of as containing several electronic components: a con-  
troller, a tone generator, and a sequencer.  
The instrument is an electronic instrument that can han-  
dle 16 MIDI channels (or reception of 32 channels for  
MIDI data reception when using the [USB] terminal).  
This is usually expressed as “it can play 16 instruments  
at the same time.” Channel messages transmit informa-  
tion such as Note ON/OFF, Program Change, for each  
of the 16 channels.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
197  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
What is MIDI?  
Example: Recording a performance with the auto accompa-  
niment (Style playback) sound of the instrument to an exter-  
nal sequencer  
Message Name  
Note ON/OFF  
Operation/Panel Setting  
Messages which are generated when  
the keyboard is played. Each mes-  
sage includes a specific note num-  
ber which corresponds to the key  
which is pressed, plus a velocity  
value based on how hard the key is  
played.  
MIDI cable  
Clavinova track (channnel)  
RIGHT 1  
RIGHT 2  
External sequencer  
Track 1  
Channel 1  
Channel 2  
Track 2  
Program Change  
Control Change  
n
For selecting Voices (with control  
change bank select MSB/LSB set-  
tings)  
LEFT  
Channel 3  
Channel 4  
Channel 5  
Channel 6  
Track 3  
Track 4  
Track 5  
Track 6  
STYLE instrument  
STYLE instrument  
STYLE instrument  
Volume, panpot (Mixing Console),  
etc.  
Channel 7  
Channel 8  
Channel 9  
Channel 10  
Channel 11  
Track 7  
Track 8  
Track 9  
Track 10  
STYLE instrument  
STYLE instrument  
STYLE instrument  
STYLE instrument  
STYLE instrument  
Track 11  
The performance data of all Songs and Styles is handled as MIDI  
data.  
As you can see, it is essential to determine which data is  
to be sent over which MIDI channel when transmitting  
MIDI data (page 202).  
The instrument also allows you to determine how the  
received data is played back (page 203).  
MIDI Channels  
MIDI performance data is assigned to one of sixteen  
MIDI channels. Using these channels, 1–16, the perfor-  
mance data for sixteen different instrument parts can be  
simultaneously sent over one MIDI cable.  
System Messages  
Think of the MIDI channels as TV channels. Each TV  
station transmits its broadcasts over a specific channel.  
Your home TV set receives many different programs  
simultaneously from several TV stations and you select  
the appropriate channel to watch the desired program.  
This is data that is used in common by the entire MIDI  
system. These include System Exclusive messages for  
transferring data unique to each instrument manufac-  
turer and Realtime messages for controlling the MIDI  
device.  
Weather report  
Message Name  
Operation/Panel Setting  
System Exclusive  
Message  
Effect type settings (Mixing Console),  
etc.  
NEWS  
2
1
NEWS  
2
Realtime Messages Clock setting,  
Start/stop operation  
MIDI operates on the same basic principle. The trans-  
mitting instrument sends MIDI data on a specific MIDI  
channel (MIDI Transmit Channel) via a single MIDI  
cable to the receiving instrument. If the receiving instru-  
ments MIDI channel (MIDI Receive Channel) matches  
the Transmit Channel, the receiving instrument will  
sound according to the data sent by the transmitting  
instrument.  
The messages transmitted/received by the instrument  
are shown in the MIDI Data Format and MIDI Imple-  
mentation Chart in the separate Data List.  
MIDI  
cable  
MIDI Transmit channel 2  
MIDI Receive channel 2  
n
The instrument’s keyboard and internal tone generator are also  
connected by MIDI. LOCAL CONTROL (page 202)  
For example, several parts or channels can be transmit-  
ted simultaneously, including the Style data (as shown  
below).  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
198  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
What You Can Do With MIDI  
XF  
What You Can Do With MIDI  
The Yamaha XF format enhances the SMF (Standard  
MIDI File) standard with greater functionality and open-  
ended expandability for the future. The instrument is  
capable of displaying lyrics when an XF file containing  
lyric data is played. (SMF is the most common format  
used for MIDI sequence files. The instrument is compat-  
ible with SMF Formats 0 and 1, and records “song” data  
using SMF Format 0.)  
Record your performance data (1–16 channels) using  
the instruments auto accompaniment features on an  
external sequencer (or computer with sequencer  
software). After recording, edit the data with the  
sequencer, then play it back on the instrument.  
MIDI receive  
MIDI IN  
MIDI OUT  
Instrument  
MIDI OUT  
MIDI IN  
Style File  
MIDI transmit  
Computer or  
Sequencer  
The Style File Format combines all of Yamahas auto  
accompaniment know-how into a single unified format.  
When you want to use the instrument as an XG-com-  
patible multi-timbral tone generator, set the receive part  
for MIDI channels 1–16 to “SONG” in MIDI/USB 1 in  
MIDI Receive (page 203).  
Voice Allocation Format  
With MIDI, Voices are assigned to specific numbers,  
called “program numbers.” The numbering standard  
(order of voice allocation) is referred to as the “voice  
allocation format.”  
Controlling from an external MIDI keyboard  
MIDI receive  
Instrument  
MIDI IN  
MIDI OUT  
Voices may not play back as expected unless the voice  
allocation format of the song data matches that of the  
compatible MIDI device used for playback. The instru-  
ment is compatible with the following formats.  
n
MIDI Data Compatibility  
Even if the devices and data used satisfy all the conditions above,  
the data may still not be completely compatible, depending on the  
specifications of the devices and particular data recording meth-  
ods.  
This section covers basic information on data compati-  
bility: whether or not other MIDI devices can playback  
the data recorded by CGP-1000, and whether or not the  
CGP-1000 can playback commercially available song  
data or song data created for other instruments or on a  
computer. Depending on the MIDI device or data char-  
acteristics, you may be able to play back the data with-  
out any problem, or you may have to perform some  
special operations before the data can be played back.  
If you run into problems playing back data, please refer  
to the information below.  
GM System Level 1  
This is one of the most common voice allocation for-  
mats.  
Many MIDI devices are compatible with GM System  
Level 1, as is most commercially available software.  
GM System Level 2  
“GM System Level 2” is a standard specification that  
enhances the original “GM System Level 1” and  
improves Song data compatibility. It provides for  
increased polyphony, greater voice selection, expanded  
voice parameters, and integrated effect processing.  
Sequence Formats  
Song data is recorded and stored in a variety of different  
systems, referred to as “sequence formats.”  
XG  
Playback is only possible when the sequence format of  
the Song data matches that of the MIDI device. The  
CGP-1000 is compatible with the following formats.  
XG is a major enhancement of the GM System Level 1  
format, and was developed by Yamaha specifically to  
provide more Voices and variations, as well as greater  
expressive control over Voices and effects, and to  
ensure compatibility of data well into the future.  
Song data recorded on the CGP-1000 using Voices in  
the XG category is XG-compatible.  
SMF (Standard MIDI file)  
This is the most common sequence format. Standard  
MIDI Files are generally available as one of two types:  
Format 0 or Format 1. Many MIDI devices are compati-  
ble with Format 0, and most commercially available  
software is recorded as Format 0.  
• The CGP-1000 is compatible with both Format 0 and  
Format 1.  
• Song data recorded on the CGP-1000 is automati-  
cally saved as SMF Format 0.  
DOC (Disk Orchestra Collection)  
This voice allocation format is compatible with many of  
Yamahas MIDI devices, including the Clavinova series  
instruments.  
GS  
GS was developed by the Roland Corporation.  
In the same way as Yamaha XG, GS is a major enhance-  
ment of the GM specifically to provide moreVoices and  
Drum kits and their variations, as well as greater expres-  
sive control over Voices and effects.  
ESEQ  
This sequence format is compatible with many of  
Yamahas MIDI devices, including the Clavinova series  
instruments. This is a common format used with various  
Yamaha software.  
• The CGP-1000 is compatible with ESEQ.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
199  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                       
MIDI Settings  
4
Use the TAB [  
vant setting display.  
]/[®] buttons to call up the rele-  
MIDI Settings  
In this section, you can make MIDI-related settings for  
the instrument. The instrument gives you a set of ten  
pre-programmed templates that let you instantly and  
easily reconfigure the instrument to match your particu-  
lar MIDI application or external device. Also, you can  
edit the pre-programmed templates and save up to ten  
of your original templates to the USER display. You can  
then save all these original templates as a single file to  
USB storage devices, in the MIDI SETUP selection dis-  
play (called up by pressing [FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY  
TAB [®] SYSTEM RESET).  
SYSTEM display  
MIDI System Settings (page 202)  
TRANSMIT display MIDI Transmission Settings  
RECEIVE display  
BASS display  
MIDI Reception Settings (page 203)  
Settings for the bass note of chord  
for Style playback via MIDI recep-  
tion data (page 203)  
CHORD DETECT  
display  
Settings for the chord type for Style  
playback via MIDI reception data  
Basic Operation  
5
6
When you’ve finished editing, press the [EXIT]  
button to return to the MIDI template selection  
display (PRESET or USER).  
1
Call up the operation (MIDI template selection)  
display.  
Function [I] MIDI  
Select the USER tab display to save the data by  
using the TAB [][®] buttons (page 69).  
2
3
To use the pre-programmed templates or to edit  
them  
Press the TAB [] button to select the PRESET dis-  
play. Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a MIDI  
template.  
To use the templates already saved to the USER  
display or to edit them  
Press the TAB [®] button to select the USER display.  
Press one of the [A]–[J] buttons to select a MIDI tem-  
plate.  
To edit a template, press the [8 ] (EDIT) but-  
ton to call up the MIDI display for editing.  
The individual parameters settings are shown for the  
selected template. Here you can edit each parame-  
ter.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
200  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
MIDI Settings  
Pre-Programmed MIDI Templates  
Template name  
All Parts  
Description  
Transmits all parts including the keyboard parts (RIGHT1, 2,and LEFT), with the excep-  
tion of Song parts.  
KBD & STYLE  
Master KBD  
Song  
Basically the same as “All Parts” with the exception of how keyboard parts are man-  
aged. The right-hand parts are handled as “UPPER” instead of RIGHT 1 and 2 and the  
left-hand part is handled as “LOWER.”  
In this setting, the instrument functions as a “master” keyboard, playing and controlling  
one or more connected tone generators or other devices (such as a computer/  
sequencer).  
All transmit channels are set to correspond to Song channels 1–16. This is used to play  
Song data with an external tone generator and to record Song data to an external  
sequencer.  
Clock Ext  
Playback (Song or Style) synchronizes with an external MIDI clock instead of the instru-  
ment’s internal clock. This template should be used when you wish to set the tempo on  
the MIDI device connected to the instrument.  
MIDI Accord 1  
MIDI accordions allow you to transmit MIDI data and play connected tone generators  
from the keyboard and bass/chord buttons of the accordion. This template lets you play  
melodies from the keyboard and control Style playback on the instrument with the left-  
hand buttons.  
MIDI Accord 2  
MIDI Pedal 1  
Basically the same as “MIDI Accord1” above, with the exception that the chord/bass  
notes you play with your left hand on the MIDI Accordion are recognized also as MIDI  
note events.  
MIDI pedal units allow you play connected tone generators with your feet (especially  
convenient for playing single note bass parts). This template lets you play/control the  
chord root in Style playback with a MIDI pedal unit.  
MIDI Pedal 2  
MIDI OFF  
This template lets you play the bass part for Style playback by using a MIDI pedal unit.  
No MIDI signals are sent or received.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
201  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
MIDI Settings  
START/STOP  
SYSTEM display  
Determines whether incoming FA (start) and FC (stop)  
messages affect Song or Style playback.  
MIDI System Settings  
MESSAGE SW  
SYS/EX.  
The “Tx” setting turns MIDI transmission of MIDI Sys-  
tem Exclusive messages on or off. The “Rx” setting turns  
MIDI reception and recognition of MIDI System Exclu-  
sive messages generated by external equipment on or  
off.  
The explanations here apply to the SYSTEM display to  
be called up in step 4 of the “Basic Operation” on  
CHORD SYS/EX.  
The “Tx” setting turns MIDI transmission of MIDI chord  
exclusive data (chord detect. root and type) on or off.  
The “Rx” setting turns MIDI reception and recognition  
of MIDI chord exclusive data generated by external  
equipment on or off.  
TRANSMIT display  
LOCAL CONTROL  
MIDI Transmit Settings  
Turns the Local Control for each part on or off. When  
Local Control is set to “ON,” the keyboard of the instru-  
ment controls its own (local) internal tone generator,  
allowing the internal voices to be played directly from the  
keyboard. If you set Local to “OFF,” the keyboard and  
controllers are internally disconnected from the instru-  
ments tone generator section so that no sound is output  
when you play the keyboard or use the controllers. For  
example, this allows you to use an external MIDI  
The explanations here apply to the TRANSMIT display  
to be called up in step 4 of the “Basic Operation” on  
page 200. This determines which parts will be sent as  
MIDI data and over which MIDI channel the data will  
be sent.  
sequencer to play the instruments internal voices, and  
use the instrument keyboard to record notes to the exter-  
nal sequencer and/or play an external tone generator.  
Clock setting, etc.  
CLOCK  
Determines whether the instrument is controlled by its  
own internal clock or a MIDI clock signal received from  
an external device. INTERNAL is the normal Clock setting  
when the instrument is being used alone or as a master  
keyboard to control external devices. If you are using the  
instrument with an external sequencer, MIDI computer,  
or other MIDI device, and you want to synchronize it to  
that device, set this parameter to the appropriate setting:  
MIDI, USB 1, or USB 2. In this case, make sure that the  
external device is connected properly (e.g., to the instru-  
ments MIDI IN terminal), and that it is properly transmit-  
ting a MIDI clock signal. When this is set for control by  
an external device (MIDI, USB 1 or USB 2), the Tempo is  
indicated as “Ext.” in the Main display.  
Operation  
Select the part to be transmitted and the channel via  
which the selected part will be transmitted.You can also  
determine the types of data to be sent.  
With the exception of the two parts below, the  
configuration of the parts is the same as those  
already explained elsewhere in this manual.  
• UPPER  
The keyboard part played on the right side of the key-  
board from the Split Point for the Voices (RIGHT1 and/  
or 2).  
TRANSMIT CLOCK  
Turns MIDI clock (F8) transmission on or off. When set  
to OFF, no MIDI clock or Start/Stop data is transmitted  
even if a Song or Style is played back.  
• LOWER  
The keyboard part played on the left side of the keyboard  
from the Split Point for the Voices. This is not affected by  
the on/off status of the [ACMP ON/OFF] button.  
RECEIVE TRANSPOSE  
Determines whether or not the instrument's transpose  
by the instrument via MIDI.  
Tx MONITOR  
The dots corresponding to each channel (1–16) flash  
briefly whenever any data is transmitted on the chan-  
nel(s).  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
202  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
MIDI Settings  
n
Rx MONITOR  
The dots corresponding to each channel (1–16) flash  
briefly whenever any data is received on the channel(s).  
When different parts are assigned to the same transmit channel  
If the same transmit channel is assigned to several different parts,  
the transmitted MIDI messages are merged to a single channel—  
resulting in unexpected sounds and possible glitches in the con-  
nected MIDI device.  
n Parameter Lock  
You can “lock” specific parameters (e.g., effect, split  
point, etc.) to make them selectable only via the panel  
n
About the protected Songs  
Write-protected Songs cannot be transmitted even if the proper  
Song channels 1–16 are set to be transmitted.  
MIDI transmission/reception via the USB ter-  
minal and MIDI terminals  
The relationship between the [MIDI] terminals and the  
[USB] terminal which can be used for transmitting/  
receiving 32 channels (16 channels x 2 ports) of the  
MIDI messages is as follows:  
MIDI messages which can be transmitted or  
received (recognized)  
The following MIDI messages can be set on the TRANS-  
MIT/RECEIVE display.  
• Note (Note events).......................................page 164  
• CC (CONTROL CHANGE) ..........................page 164  
• PC (PROGRAM CHANGE)...........................page 164  
• PB (Pitch Bend)............................................page 164  
• AT (Aftertouch).............................................page 164  
MIDI reception  
[USB TO  
MIDI transmission  
[USB TO  
HOST] jack  
[MIDI OUT] jack  
HOST] jack  
[MIDI IN] jack  
Port  
handling  
RECEIVE display  
USB1  
USB2  
MIDI Receive Settings  
Merge  
Merge  
MIDI/USB1  
01–16  
USB2  
01–16  
MIDI/USB 01–16  
BASS display  
Setting the Bass Note for Style Playback  
via MIDI Receive  
The explanations here apply to the BASS display to be  
called up in step 4 of the “Basic Operation” on  
The explanations here apply to the RECEIVE display to be  
called up in step 4 of the “Basic Operation” on page 200.  
This determines which parts will receive MIDI data and  
over which MIDI channels the data will be received.  
These settings let you determine the bass note for Style  
playback, based on the note messages received via  
MIDI. The note on/off messages received at the chan-  
nel(s) set to “ON” are recognized as the bass note of the  
chord of Style playback. The bass note will be detected  
regardless of the [ACMP ON/OFF] or split point set-  
tings. When several channels are simultaneously set to  
“ON,” the bass note is detected from merged MIDI data  
received over the channels.  
Operation  
Select the channel to be received and the part via which  
the selected channel will be received. You can also  
determine the types of data to be received.  
The instrument can receive MIDI messages over  
32 channels (16 channels x 2 ports) by USB con-  
nection.  
With the exception of the two parts below, the  
configuration of the parts is the same as those  
already explained elsewhere in this manual.  
• KEYBOARD  
The received note messages control the instruments  
keyboard performance.  
• EXTRA PART 1–5  
There are five parts specially reserved for receiving  
and playing MIDI data. Normally, these parts are not  
used by the instrument itself. The instrument can be  
used as a 32-channel multi-timbral tone generator by  
using these five parts in addition to the general parts  
(except for the microphone sound).  
Operation  
Select the channel and set the “ON/OFF” for that chan-  
nel. Use the All OFF item to set all channels to OFF.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
203  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
MIDI Settings  
CHORD DETECT display  
Setting the Chord Type for Style Play-  
back via MIDI Receive  
The explanations here apply to the CHORD DETECT  
display to be called up in step 4 of the “Basic Opera-  
These settings let you determine the chord type for Style  
playback, based on the note messages received via  
MIDI. The note on/off messages received at the chan-  
nel(s) set to “ON” are recognized as the notes for  
detecting chords in Style playback. The chords to be  
detected depend on the fingering type. The chord type  
will be detected regardless of the [ACMP ON/OFF] or  
split point settings. When several channels are simulta-  
neously set to “ON,” the chord type is detected from  
merged MIDI data received over the channels.  
The operation procedure is basically the same as that of  
the BASS display above.  
Displaying the Voice Program Change Number  
Determines whether or not the Voice bank and number  
are shown in the Voice selection display. This is useful  
when you want to check which bank select MSB/LSB val-  
ues and program change number you need to specify  
when selecting the Voice from an external MIDI device.  
You can set this in the display called up by the following  
operations: [FUNCTION] [J] UTILITY TAB [][®  
]
CONFIG 2. Switch the DISPLAY VOICE NUMBER menu  
ON and OFF.  
n
• The numbers displayed here start from “1.” Accordingly the  
actual MIDI program change numbers are one lower, since  
that number system starts from “0.”  
• For the GS Voices, this feature is not available (the program  
change numbers are not shown).  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
204  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Troubleshooting  
- There is a slight difference in sound quality among  
different notes played on the keyboard.  
Overall  
- Some Voices have a looping sound.  
The instrument does not turn on.  
- Some noise or vibrato is noticeable at higher  
pitches, depending upon the voice.  
• Securely insert the female plug into the socket on the  
instrument, and the male plug into a proper AC outlet.  
• This is normal and is a result of the instrument’s sam-  
pling system.  
A click or pop is heard when the power is turned on  
or off.  
Some Voices will jump an octave in pitch when played  
in the upper or lower registers.  
• Electrical current is being applied to the instrument. This  
is normal.  
• This is normal. Some voices have a pitch limit which,  
when reached, causes this type of pitch shift.  
Noise is heard from the instrument’s speakers.  
• Noise may be heard if a mobile phone is used near the  
instrument or if the phone is ringing. Turn off the mobile  
phone, or use it further away from the instrument.  
The Main display does not appear even when turning  
the power on.  
• This may occur if a USB storage device has been  
installed to the instrument. Installation of some USB stor-  
age device may result a long interval between turning  
the power on and appearance of the Main display. To  
avoid this, turn the power on after disconnecting the  
device.  
The letters in the display cannot be read, because the  
display is too bright (or dark).  
• Use the [LCD CONTRAST] knob to adjust for optimum  
visibility.  
• Adjust the brightness of the display (page 19).  
The overall volume is too low, or, no sound is heard.  
The main background image from the CD-ROM is not  
displayed.  
• This is because the Main display is loaded prior to load-  
ing of the image from the CD-ROM. To remedy this,  
copy the image data from the CD-ROM to the User dis-  
play, then set it as the main background image (page 19).  
• The master volume may be set too low. Set it to an  
appropriate level with the [MASTER VOLUME] dial.  
• The volume of the individual parts may be set too low.  
Raise the volume in the BALANCE display (page 40).  
• Make sure the desired channel is set to ON (page 109).  
• Headphones are connected, disabling the speaker out-  
put. (This happens when the speaker setting is set to  
• The Fade-In and Fade-Out function is on, muting the  
sound. To turn it off, press the pedal to which you  
assigned the Fade In/Out function.  
Pedals  
The damper, sostenuto and soft functions do not  
work for the relevant pedals.  
• Each pedal has been assigned to a different function.  
Make sure that each pedal is properly assigned to SUS-  
TAIN, SOSTENUTO, and SOFT (page 191).  
• Make sure the Registration Sequence function is set to  
• Make sure the Local Control function is set to ON  
Not all simultaneously played notes sound.  
You are probably exceeding the maximum polyphony  
polyphony is exceeded, the earliest played notes will  
stop sounding, letting the latest played notes sound.  
Files/Folders  
The keyboard volume is lower than the Song/Style  
playback volume.  
• The volume of the keyboard parts may be set too low.  
Raise the volume in the BALANCE display (page 40).  
Some characters of the file/folder name are garbled.  
• The language settings have been changed. Set the appro-  
An existing file is not shown.  
Keys do not sound at the proper pitch.  
• Make sure the Performance Assistant function is off on  
the operation display (page 43).  
• The file extension (.MID, etc.) may have been changed  
or deleted. Manually rename the file, adding the appro-  
priate extension, on a computer.  
Certain notes sound at the wrong pitch.  
The data contained in the USB storage device is not  
shown on the instrument itself.  
• Data files with names of more than 50 characters cannot  
be handled by the instrument. Rename the file, reducing  
the number of characters to 50 or less.  
The Scale parameter has probably been set to some-  
thing other than “Equal,” changing the tuning system of  
the keyboard. Make sure “Equal” is selected as the  
Scale in the Scale Tune display (page 84).  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
205  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
• Adjust the sound using the [8π†] (TOTAL GAIN ADJ.)  
buttons from the display shown in step 6 of “Editing and  
Master EQ.  
• Some filter resonance settings in the VOICE SET display  
settings if necessary.  
Demo  
How can I stop the demo?  
• Press the [EXIT] button.  
Voice  
• Noise may occur depending on the settings made in the  
Filter display of the Mixing Console. Adjust the Har-  
monic Content or Brightness controls in the Filter display  
The Voice selected from the Voice Selection display  
does not sound.  
• Check whether or not the selected part is turned on  
The sound does not change when replacing Voices  
with the Song Auto Revoice feature.  
• Depending on the particular Song data, there are some  
instances where Song Auto Revoice has no effect, even  
when replacing Voices.  
To select the Voice for the right-hand key range, make  
sure the PART ON/OFF [DUAL (RIGHT2)]/[SPLIT (LEFT)]  
buttons are off. For the Voice to be layered in the right-  
hand range, press the PART ON/OFF [DUAL (RIGHT2)]  
button. To select the Voice for the left-hand key range,  
press the PART ON/OFF [SPLIT (LEFT)] button.  
The sound of the Voice doesn’t change, even when  
editing the Voice.  
• Keep in mind that adjustments made to the parameters  
may not make much change in the actual sound depend-  
ing on the original settings of the Voice.  
A strange “flanging” or “doubling” sound occurs. The  
sound is slightly different each time the keys are played.  
• The RIGHT 1 and RIGHT 2 parts are set to “ON,” and  
both parts are set to play the same Voice. Turn off the  
RIGHT 2 part or change the Voice of one of the parts.  
Voices other than those in the Preset display cannot  
be selected for Step recording.  
• This is normal.  
The sound seems strange or different than expected  
when changing a rhythm Voice (drum kit, etc.) of the  
Style or Song from the Mixer.  
• When changing the rhythm/percussion Voices (drum  
kits, etc.) of the Style and Song from the VOICE parame-  
ter, the detailed settings related to the drum voice are  
reset, and in some cases you may be unable to restore  
the original sound. In the case of Song playback, you  
can restore the original sound by returning to the begin-  
ning of the Song and playing back from that point. In the  
case of Style play, you can restore the original sound by  
selecting the same Style again.  
Style  
Style playback does not start.  
• Make sure to press the STYLE CONTROL [START/STOP]  
button.  
• MIDI Clock may be set to “EXTERNAL.” Make sure this is  
set to “INTERNAL” (page 202).  
Only the rhythm channel plays.  
• Make sure the Auto Accompaniment function is turned  
on; press the [ACMP ON/OFF] button.  
You may be playing keys in the right hand range of the  
keyboard. Make sure to play keys in the chord range of  
the keyboard.  
Tremolo/Trill cannot be applied to the Organ Flute  
Voice.  
• This is normal; Tremolo and Trill settings in the Harmony/  
Echo display are not effective for Organ Flute Voices.  
The Harmony function does not operate.  
Styles cannot be selected.  
• Harmony cannot be used with the AI Fingered or AI Full  
Keyboard fingering modes. Select an appropriate finger-  
• If the size of the Style data is large (about 120 KB or  
greater), the Style cannot be selected because the data is  
too large to be ready by the instrument.  
When a Voice is changed, the previously selected  
effect is changed.  
• EachVoice has its own suitable preset settings, which are  
automatically recalled when the corresponding Voice  
The desired chord is not recognized or output by the  
auto accompaniment.  
You may not be playing the correct keys for indicating  
the chord. Refer to “Chord Types Recognized in the Fin-  
gered Mode” of the separate Data List.  
The Voice produces excessive noise.  
You may be playing the keys according to a different fin-  
gering mode, and not the one currently selected. Check  
the accompaniment mode, and play the keys according  
• Certain Voices may produce noise, depending on the  
Harmonic Content and/or Brightness settings in the FIL-  
TER page of the Mixing Console display (page 90).  
Synchro Stop cannot be turned on.  
The sound is distorted or noisy.  
• Synchro Stop cannot be turned on when the fingering  
mode is set to “Full Keyboard” or “AI Full Keyboard,” or  
when Style On/Off is set to off. Make sure the fingering  
mode is set to something besides “Full Keyboard” or “Al  
Full Keyboard” and set Style On/Off to on.  
• The volume may be turned up too high. Make sure all  
relevant volume settings are appropriate.  
• This may be caused by certain effects. Try canceling all  
unnecessary effects, especially distortion-type effects  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
206  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Auto accompaniment chords are recognized regard-  
less of the split point or where chords are played on  
the keyboard.  
• This is normal if the fingering mode is set to “Full Key-  
board” or “AI Full Keyboard.” If either of these is  
selected, chords are recognized over the entire range of  
the keyboard, irrespective of the split point setting. If  
When using the Freeze function of the Registration  
Memory, the On/Off setting of the Left Part does not  
change even when changing the Registration Mem-  
ory setting.  
• The Left Part On/Off setting is included in the Style  
group. Remove the checkmark from “STYLE” in the  
Freeze setting display (page 133).  
Even though a Registration Memory setting contain-  
ing a User/USB voice is selected, the File Selection dis-  
play shows a Preset Voice.  
When playing back one Style and selecting another,  
the newly selected Style doesn’t play at the proper  
Tempo.  
You can select whether the appropriate tempo will be  
called up automatically or not by using the TEMPO  
parameter in the STYLE CHANGE BEHAVIOR function.  
• This is normal; even with the Preset Voice shown, the  
actual sounding Voice is the selected User/USB Voice.  
When a User/USB Voice is saved to the User/USB drive,  
the actual data is divided into two separate types: 1) the  
source Preset Voice itself, and 2) the parameter settings  
as set in the Voice Set. When you recall a Registration  
Memory setting containing a User/USB Voice, the instru-  
ment selects the Preset voice (on which the User/USB  
Voice is based), then applies the relevant parameter set-  
tings to it—so that your original User/USB Voice is  
sounded.  
Starting a Song while playing back a Style stops Style  
playback.  
This is because Song playback has priority. The two ways  
shown below let you play back a Style and Song simulta-  
neously.  
• Set the Song to Synchro Start standby, then start the  
Style.  
• Start the Style playback after playing back a Song.  
Song  
The level balance of the various Parts becomes wrong  
or unexpected sounds are output when selecting a  
Style or a Voice after selecting a Song.  
Songs cannot be selected.  
• This may be because the language settings have been  
changed. Set the appropriate language for the Song file  
name.  
• If the size of the Song data is large (about 300 KB or  
greater), the Song cannot be selected because the data is  
too large to be read by the instrument.  
• The level balance of the Parts can change and unex-  
pected sounds can be produced because of the effects  
applied to each Part.  
The “Off” setting is not shown for the Play Type  
parameter in the Assembly (Style Creator) feature.  
• The selected section is set to record enable. Release the  
Song playback does not start.  
recording assignment by pressing the appropriate [1  
[8 ] button in the recording channel display (TAB [  
button BASIC tab [F] REC CH).  
]–  
• “New Song” (a blank Song) has been selected. Make  
sure to select an appropriate Song in the Song Selection  
]  
The channels BASS-PHR2 cannot be edited in Channel  
Edit.  
• This is normal; BASS-PHR2 channels of the Preset Styles  
cannot be edited.  
• Make sure to press the SONG [PLAY/PAUSE] button.  
• The Song has been stopped at the end of the Song data.  
Return to the beginning of the Song by pressing the  
SONG [STOP] button.  
• In the case a Song to which write-protect has been  
applied (“Prot. 2 Edit” is shown at the upper left of the  
Song name), the original file may not be in the same  
folder. It cannot be played back unless the original file  
(showing “Prot.2 Orig” at the upper left of the Song  
name) is in the same folder.  
• In case of a Song to which write-protect has been  
applied (“Prot. 2 Edit” is shown at the upper left of the  
Song name), the original file name may have been  
changed. Rename the file with the original file name (so  
that “Prot.2 Orig” is shown at the upper left of the Song  
name).  
Registration memory  
The Song/Style registered to the Registration Mem-  
ory cannot be called up.  
• If the registered Song/Style is contained on USB storage  
device and the USB storage device is not inserted or  
connected to the instrument, the Song/Style cannot be  
called up. Insert or connect the appropriate USB storage  
device containing the Song/Style data.  
• In case of a Song to which write-protect has been  
applied (“Prot. 2 Edit” is shown at the upper left of the  
Song name), the file icon may have been changed. Songs  
to which write-protect has been applied cannot be  
played back when the file icon of the original has been  
changed.  
The order for calling up Registration Memory settings  
is not shown on the Registration Sequence setting  
display.  
• The bank containing the Registration has not been  
• MIDI Clock may be set to “EXTERNAL.” Make sure this is  
set to “INTERNAL” (page 202).  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
207  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Song playback stops before the Song is finished.  
The lamps in the chord section of the keyboard light.  
• The Guide function is turned on. (In this case, playback  
is “waiting” for the correct key to be played.) Press the  
[GUIDE] button to turn off the guide function.  
• The Guide function for chords (page 50) has been  
enabled. Turn the Style off by pressing the [ACMP ON/  
OFF] button.  
The Song last selected before turning off the power is  
no longer available.  
• If the Song last selected before turning off the power is  
contained in USB storage device, you’ll need to reinsert/  
reconnect the same USB storage device to call up the  
Song again.  
The Guide lamps do not indicate how to play chords.  
• Make sure that the Guide Mode is set to “FollowLights”  
You cannot check how to play chords with the Guide  
lamps if the chord fingering method is set to “Single Fin-  
ger,” “Full Keyboard” or “AI Full Keyboard.” Select  
The measure number is different from that of the  
score in the Song Position display, shown by pressing  
the [REW]/[FF] buttons.  
Score  
• This happens when playing back music data for which a  
specific, fixed tempo is set.  
When displaying the music score, long notes that  
have been entered, such as whole notes and ties, are  
not displayed correctly.  
• Long notes, such as whole notes and ties, may not be  
shown in the music score display exactly as they were  
entered. Selecting “Tenuto” by pressing the [H] button  
before inputting each note in the Step Record display  
(page 149) may solve the problem.  
In the AB Repeat function, the B point cannot be set.  
• The A point has not been set. Set the B point only after  
setting the A point.  
When playing back a Song, some channels do not  
play.  
• Playback of these channels may be set to “OFF.” Turn  
playback on for those channels that are set to “OFF”  
The tempo, beat, measure and music notation is not  
displayed correctly.  
A Song to which write-protect has been applied  
(“Prot. 2 Edit” is shown at the upper left of the Song  
name) cannot be moved to external media such as a  
SmartMedia card or floppy disk.  
• Some Song data for the instrument has been recorded  
with special “free tempo” settings. For such Song data,  
the tempo, beat, measure and music notation will not be  
displayed correctly.  
• A Song to which write-protect has been applied cannot  
be moved to an external media such as SmartMedia/  
floppy disk, etc. Use the [USB TO DEVICE] terminal to  
move the song to a USB flash memory device connected  
to this instrument.  
The note name partially obscures the note in the dis-  
play.  
• When several notes occur close to each other, the note  
name may obscure the note at left.  
The Tuning Curve of the piano Voice does not quite  
match that of other instruments’ Voices.  
The music score of the right-hand/left-hand part is  
not displayed.  
• The Tuning Curve designed especially for piano Voices  
may not sound with the appropriate pitches when used  
with other instrument Voices. Set the Tuning Curve to  
• The appropriate channels have not been assigned to the  
right-hand and left-hand parts. Set RIGHT and LEFT to  
the appropriate channels (page 39).  
The notation in the display is cut off, with the middle  
of a measure starting on the next line.  
• When all the notes of a measure cannot fit on one line,  
the remaining notes in the measure are carried over to  
the next line.  
Guide  
The melody still plays back, even when specifying Track  
1 as the part to be muted for one-handed practice.  
Dotted notes are indicated as rests.  
• A part other than the melody part has been assigned to  
Track 1. Reassign the channel containing the melody to  
• This is normal; sometimes dotted notes are indicated as  
rests.  
Chords are not displayed.  
The Guide lamps do not light during Song playback,  
even after pressing the [GUIDE] button.  
• If the selected Song does not contain chord data, chords  
are not displayed.  
• Any notes outside of the 88-key range cannot be indi-  
cated by the Guide lamps.  
The Guide lamps light an octave or two lower/higher  
than the actual pitch.  
• The Guide lamps sometimes light an octave or two  
lower/higher than the actual pitch depending on the  
selected Voice.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
208  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lyrics (Karaoke)  
Microphone/Vocal harmony  
Lyrics are not displayed.  
The microphone input signal cannot be recorded.  
• If the selected Song does not contain lyric data, lyrics are  
not displayed.  
• The microphone input signal cannot be recorded by  
Song/Style recording. Use the USB Audio Recorder func-  
tion (page 60). Furthermore, you can connect a recorder  
to the output terminals [AUX OUT, AUX OUT (LEVEL  
FIXED) and record the microphone signal.  
Some of the lyrics overlap each other.  
• This happens for Songs containing many lyrics.  
The Lyrics Background setting cannot be changed.  
• When the background color is specified in the song  
data, the Lyrics Background setting cannot be changed.  
Harmony can be heard in addition to the microphone  
sound.  
• Vocal Harmony is set to “ON.” Turn Vocal Harmony off  
The Vocal Harmony effect sounds distorted or out-of-  
tune.  
Performance assistant technology  
Your vocal microphone may be picking up extraneous  
sounds, such as the Style sound from the instrument. In  
particular, bass sounds can cause mistracking of the Vocal  
Harmony. To remedy this:  
Performance assistant technology does not work  
appropriately.  
• Press the SONG [STOP] button to stop Song playback,  
then set the [ACMP ON/OFF] and PART ON/OFF [LEFT]  
to off. Finally, restart the Song.  
• Sing as closely to the microphone as possible.  
• Use a directional microphone.  
Turn down the Master volume, Style volume, or Song  
Video out/RGB out  
• Separate the microphone from the external speakers as  
much as possible.  
The instrument display contents cannot be sent via  
video out/RGB out and do not show on an external  
monitor.  
• Make sure that the NTSC/PAL/RGB setting corresponds  
• Cut the Low band via the 3 Band EQ function in the  
MICROPHONE SETTING display (page 171).  
• Raise the microphone input level (TH) via the Com-  
pressor function in the MICROPHONE SETTING dis-  
Some flashing parallel lines appear in the TV, video,  
or computer monitor.  
Appropriate harmony notes are not produced by the  
Vocal Harmony feature.  
• Make sure you are using the appropriate method to  
specify the harmony notes for the current Vocal Har-  
• Occasionally some flashing parallel lines may appear in  
the television, video, or computer. This does not neces-  
sarily indicate that the monitor is malfunctioning. For  
optimum results, try adjusting the color settings on the  
monitor itself.  
The monitor you are using may not show the instru-  
ment's display contents as expected.  
USB Audio Recorder  
• Keep in mind that even after adjusting all settings as rec-  
ommended, the monitor you are using may not show the  
instrument's display contents as expected (e.g., the dis-  
play contents may not fit on the screen, the characters  
may not be completely clear, or the colors may be incor-  
rect).  
The message “This drive is busy now.” appeared, and  
then the recording was aborted.  
• Make sure to use a compatible USB flash memory  
• Make sure that the USB flash memory has enough mem-  
• If you are using a USB flash memory to which data has  
already been recorded, check first that no important data  
recording again.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
209  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Removing the CGP-1000 from its Case and Assembling the Unit  
CAUTION  
• Be careful not to confuse parts, and be sure to install all parts in the correct orientation. Please assemble in accordance with  
the sequence given below.  
• Assembly should be carried out by at least four persons.  
• Be sure to use the correct screw size, as indicated below. Use of incorrect screws can damage the instrument.  
• Be sure to tighten all screws upon completing the assembly of each unit.  
• To disassemble, reverse the assembly sequence given below.  
Have a Phillips (+) screwdriver and a hexagonal wrench ready.  
1
Remove the parts shown below from the box.  
2
3
Remove the brackets  
2
1
3
4
Unscrew the brackets.  
Attach the right front and rear legs.  
5
1 Cut the bands.  
2 Remove the top cover.  
3 Remove the front screws.  
6
4 Remove the side screws.  
5 Pull off the cover.  
6 Remove the parts.  
Pedal  
1 Attach and securely tighten the right front leg with  
the 70mm hexagon bolts.  
Leg × 3  
70mm hexagon bolt × 4  
92mm hexagon bolt × 2  
Pedal brace rod × 2  
AC power cord  
4.0 × 20mm screw × 4  
2 Attach and securely tighten the rear leg with the  
92mm hexagon bolts.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
210  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4
5
Remove the four base screws (and ONLY those  
screws) on the skid.  
8
9
Attach and securely tighten the left front leg  
with the 70mm hexagon bolts.  
Remove the rear skid (with the wooden board).  
Set a blanket at the left corner and slide the  
piano forward.  
CAUTION  
While removing the screws, make sure to have at least two  
other people securely hold this board and keep it from drop-  
ping.  
6
7
Set the piano upright.  
10  
Attach the pedal.  
Attach and securely tighten the screws.  
Remove the front metal skid.  
Securely hold the piano while doing this.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
211  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11  
Attach the pedal brace rods.  
After completing the assembly, please check  
the following.  
• Are there any parts left over?  
Review the assembly procedure and correct any  
errors.  
• Is the Clavinova clear of doors and other movable  
fixtures?  
Move the Clavinova to an appropriate location.  
• Does the Clavinova make a rattling noise when you  
shake it?  
Tighten all screws.  
• Is the power cord inserted securely into the sockets?  
Check the connection.  
• If the main unit creaks or is otherwise unsteady  
when you play on the keyboard, refer to the assem-  
bly diagrams and retighten all screws.  
Insert the pedal brace rods into the pedal box  
recesses and make sure they fit securely, then tighten  
the screws (4.0 X 20mm) to attach the rods.  
12  
Connect the AC power cord.  
When moving the instrument after assembly, always  
hold the bottom of the main unit.  
CAUTION  
Do not hold the key cover or top portion. Improper han-  
dling can result in damage to the instrument or personal  
injury.  
Top portion  
Key cover  
Do not hold here.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
212  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the Floppy Disk Drive (Optional)  
The floppy disk drive can be installed to the bottom of  
the instrument by using the included floppy disk drive  
case and screws. For a list of optional floppy disk drives  
available for this instrument, see “Optional Accesso-  
Have a Phillips-head (+) screwdriver ready.  
1
Remove the three backing papers from the  
adhesive tape in the case, and fit the floppy disk  
drive into the case.  
3
Attach the drive and case assembly to the left  
underside of the instrument, using the included  
four screws (4 mm x 10 mm).  
Insert the drive to the case, with the side  
having the rubber stoppers facing the case.  
4
Connect the USB cable to the [USB TO DEVICE]  
terminal.  
Dual-sided adhesive tape  
2
Fold the USB cable inside the case as shown.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
213  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Specifications  
CGP-1000  
Sound Source  
Keyboard  
AWM Dynamic Stereo Sampling  
NW (Natural Wood) with Synthetic ivory keytops  
(Wood is used for the white keys)  
Number of keys  
Display  
88  
640 480 dots VGA color 7.8 inch LCD  
Music Score, Lyrics, and Text  
YES  
YES  
Wallpaper Customize  
Polyphony (max)  
128 + 128  
590 voices + 480 XG Voices 19 Drum/SFX Kits +  
GM2 + GS (GS Voices for GS Song playback)  
Voice Selection  
Natural! Voice  
S. Articulation! Voice  
MegaVoice  
38  
38  
18  
Voice  
Live! Voice  
56  
Cool! Voice  
39  
Sweet! Voice  
Organ Flutes!  
Regular Voice  
23  
10  
368  
YES  
Voice Editing (Voice Set)  
Reverb/Chorus/DSP/Master  
Compressor  
9
1
Effect Blocks  
Microphone  
Reverb: 34 Preset + 3 User  
Chorus: 30 Preset + 3 User  
DSP 1: 191 Preset + 3 User  
DSP 2–6: 191 Preset + 10 User  
Reverb/Chorus/DSP  
Effects  
Effect Types  
Master EQ  
5 Preset + 2 User  
Master Compressor  
Part EQ  
5 Preset + 5 User  
27 Parts  
Vocal Harmony  
60 Preset + 10 User  
Accompaniment Styles  
408  
334  
38  
Pro Styles  
Session Styles  
Pianist Styles  
36  
MegaVoice Styles  
Fingering  
YES  
Single Finger, Fingered, Fingered On Bass,  
Multi Finger, AI Fingered, Full Keyboard,  
AI Full Keyboard  
Accompaniment Style  
Style Creator  
YES  
4 for Each Style  
YES  
OTS (One Touch Setting)  
OTS Link  
Preset  
Edit  
YES  
Music Finder  
YES  
Preset Songs  
Guide  
120  
Follow Lights, Any Key, Karao-Key, Vocal Cue-  
TIME  
Guide Lamp  
YES  
YES  
Song  
Performance assistant technology  
Quick Recording, Multi Recording, Step Record-  
ing, Song Editing  
Recording  
Record Channels  
16  
USB Audio Recorder  
YES  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
214  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
CGP-1000  
LAN Port, Wireless Game Adaptor (LAN Port),  
External Adaptor (via USB to DEVICE)  
Internet Direct Connection  
USB Flash Memory  
Floppy Disk (2HD, 2DD)  
Hard Disk  
YES  
External Adaptor (via USB to DEVICE)  
Memory  
Device  
External Adaptor (via USB to DEVICE)  
Flash Memory (Internal)  
Memory Card (SmartMedia, etc.)  
Tempo Range  
about 3.2 MB  
External Adaptor (via USB to DEVICE)  
5–500, Tap Tempo  
Tempo  
Metronome  
YES  
Sound  
Bell on/off, Human Voices (5 Languages)  
Buttons  
8
Registration Memory  
Regist. Sequence/Freeze  
Demo  
YES  
YES  
6 Languages (English, Japanese, German,  
French, Spanish, Italian)  
Language for Display  
Direct Access  
YES  
Others  
Piano Reset Button  
(incl. Piano Lock)  
YES  
Transpose  
Scale Type  
Keyboard/Song/Master  
9
USB to HOST  
(Computer)  
YES  
USB  
Connection  
USB TO DEVICE  
(left side of front panel)  
YES  
YES  
USB TO DEVICE (bottom left panel of the instrument)  
PHONES x 2, MIDI (THRU, OUT, IN), AUX  
PEDAL, AUX IN (L/L+R, R), AUX OUT  
(L/L+R, R), AUX OUT (LEVEL FIXED) (L, R),  
MIC (INPUT VOLUME, MIC./LINE IN),  
VIDEO OUT, RGB OUT, LAN  
Other Connectors  
Pedals  
VOLUME, SUSTAIN, SOSTENUTO, SOFT,  
GLIDE, S. Articulation, SONG PLAY/PAUSE,  
STYLE START/STOP, etc.  
Functions  
iAFC  
YES  
Amplifiers  
60 W 2 + 60 W 2  
Amplifiers/ Speakers  
(16 cm + 13 cm + 2.5 cm + 2.5 cm) 2  
+ Transducer 2  
Speakers  
1465 mm 1511 mm 998 mm  
[57-7/8" 59-1/2" 39-3/8"]  
Dimensions [W D H]  
(Lid up)  
(1476 mm 1511 mm 1703 mm)  
[58-1/8" 59-1/2" 67-1/16"]  
Weight  
187 Kg (412 lbs., 4 oz)  
HPE-160  
Headphones  
Footswitch  
FC 4/FC 5  
FC 7  
Optional Accessories  
Foot Controller  
USB-FDD Unit  
UD-FD01  
* Specifications and descriptions in this owner’s manual are for information purposes only. Yamaha Corp. reserves the right to  
change or modify products or specifications at any time without prior notice. Since specifications, equipment or options  
may not be the same in every locale, please check with your Yamaha dealer.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
215  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Index  
Symbols  
E
®
Entering Characters (Internet Direct Connection) ........178  
Numerics  
A
B
F
File Selection Display Basic Operation .........................67  
File Selection Display Configuration .............................66  
C
D
DOC (Disk Orchestra Collection) ...............................199  
- For information on the panel controls, see “Panel  
Controls” on page 12.  
- For information on the jacks and connectors  
located on the bottom of the instrument, see “Using  
- For Internet-related terms, see “Glossary of Internet  
- For information on the parameters in the tab dis-  
plays, refer to the tab names in this index.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
216  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
G
H
N
O
I
Initializing Internet Settings ........................................187  
K
P
performance assistant technology .................................43  
L
M
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
217  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q
R
T
U
V
S
Voice Program Change Number .................................204  
Search (Music Finder Records) ....................................112  
Set the polarity of the pedal ........................................191  
W
X
- For information on the panel controls, see “Panel  
Controls” on page 12.  
- For information on the jacks and connectors  
located on the bottom of the instrument, see “Using  
- For Internet-related terms, see “Glossary of Internet  
- For information on the parameters in the tab dis-  
plays, refer to the tab names in this index.  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
218  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Panel Button Chart  
The position of the button on the panel can be confirmed by the Panel Control (page 12).  
Symbol  
M
[–] [+] (TEMPO)............................................................. 8  
[–] [+] (TRANSPOSE) ..................................................... 6  
MAIN VARIATION [A]/[B]/[C]/[D].....................................C  
[MASTER VOLUME].............................................................3  
[MEMORY]............................................................................j  
Mic signal/over lamps.................................................... u  
[MIXING CONSOLE] ...........................................................M  
[MUSIC FINDER]..................................................................I  
Number  
[1]–[4] (ONE TOUCH SETTING) ................................... n  
[1]–[8] (REGISTRATION MEMORY)............................... k  
[1π†]–[8π†] ................................................................... O  
O
A
[ON/OFF] (METRONOME)............................................ 5  
[OTS LINK]............................................................................o  
[ACMP ON/OFF]........................................................... 0  
[AUTO FILL IN]............................................................. A  
[A]–[J]............................................................................ K  
P
[PIANO RESET].....................................................................h  
[PLAY/PAUSE].......................................................................]  
[POWER] ...............................................................................1  
B
[BREAK]................................................................................. D  
C
R
[CHANNEL ON/OFF].......................................................... N  
[REC]......................................................................................[  
REGIST BANK [+] [–] ...........................................................i  
[REPEAT]................................................................................g  
[REW]/[FF] buttons ...............................................................^  
D
Damper pedal....................................................................... s  
[DATA ENTRY]..................................................................... R  
[DEMO]......................................................................... 4  
[DIRECT ACCESS]................................................................ L  
Drum Kit icons ..................................................................... p  
[DUAL (RIGHT2)] ................................................................ V  
S
[SCORE].................................................................................d  
[SONG SELECT]....................................................................Z  
Sostenuto pedal.....................................................................r  
[SPLIT (LEFT)]........................................................................W  
[START/STOP] ............................................................... H  
[STOP] ...................................................................................\  
STYLE category selection buttons................................... 9  
[SYNC START] ......................................................................G  
[SYNC STOP]........................................................................F  
E
ENDING/rit. [I]/[II]/[III]........................................................ E  
[ENTER]................................................................................. S  
[EXIT]..................................................................................... Q  
[EXTRA TRACKS] ................................................................. a  
T
F
TAB [][®] ...........................................................................P  
[TAP TEMPO] (TEMPO)................................................. 7  
[TRACK 1 (R)]........................................................................c  
[TRACK 2 (L)]........................................................................b  
[FUNCTION]........................................................................ X  
G
[GUIDE] ................................................................................ f  
U
I
[USB]......................................................................................T  
[USB TO DEVICE] ......................................................... 2  
[USER]........................................................................... U  
[INTERNET] .......................................................................... Y  
INTRO [I]/[II]/[III]................................................................. B  
V
K
VOICE category selection buttons.................................. l  
[VOICE EFFECT] ...................................................................m  
Keyboard guide lamps......................................................... t  
L
[LCD CONTRAST]............................................................... J  
Left pedal .............................................................................. q  
[LYRICS/TEXT] button.......................................................... e  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
219  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
The followings are the titles, credits and copyright notices for fifty  
seven (57) of the songs pre-installed in this instrument:  
Chim Chim Cher-ee  
from Walt Disneys MARY POPPINS  
Words and Music by Richard M. Sherman and Robert B. Sherman  
© 1963 Wonderland Music Company, Inc.  
Copyright Renewed  
Alfie  
Theme from the Paramount Picture ALFIE  
Words by Hal David  
Music by Burt Bacharach  
All Rights Reserved Used by Permission  
Copyright © 1966 (Renewed 1994) by Famous Music Corporation  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
Do-Re-Mi  
from THE SOUND OF MUSIC  
Lyrics by Oscar Hammerstein II  
Music by Richard Rodgers  
Copyright © 1959 by Richard Rodgers and Oscar Hammerstein II  
Copyright Renewed  
WILLIAMSON MUSIC owner of publication and allied rights through-  
out the world  
All Shook Up  
Words and Music by Otis Blackwell and Elvis Presley  
Copyright © 1957 by Shalimar Music Corporation  
Copyright Renewed and Assigned to Elvis Presley Music  
All Rights Administered by Cherry River Music Co. and Chrysalis  
Songs  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
Don’t Be Cruel (To A Heart That’s True)  
Words and Music by Otis Blackwell and Elvis Presley  
Copyright © 1956 by Unart Music Corporation and Elvis Presley  
Music, Inc.  
Copyright Renewed and Assigned to Elvis Presley Music  
All Rights Administered by Cherry River Music Co. and Chrysalis  
Songs  
Beauty And The Beast  
from Walt Disneys BEAUTY AND THE BEAST  
Lyrics by Howard Ashman  
Music by Alan Menken  
© 1991 Walt Disney Music Company and Wonderland Music Com-  
pany, Inc.  
All Rights Reserved Used by Permission  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
Bésame Mucho (Kiss Me Much)  
Music and Spanish Words by Consuelo Velazquez  
English Words by Sunny Skylar  
Copyright © 1941, 1943 by Promotora Hispano Americana de Musica,  
S.A.  
Copyrights Renewed  
Edelweiss  
from THE SOUND OF MUSIC  
Lyrics by Oscar Hammerstein II  
Music by Richard Rodgers  
Copyright © 1959 by Richard Rodgers and Oscar Hammerstein II  
Copyright Renewed  
WILLIAMSON MUSIC owner of publication and allied rights through-  
out the world  
All Rights Administered by Peer International Corporation  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
Blue Hawaii  
from the Paramount Picture WAIKIKI WEDDING  
Words and Music by Leo Robin and Ralph Rainger  
Copyright © 1936, 1937 (Renewed 1963, 1964) by Famous Music  
Corporation  
Fly Me To The Moon (In Other Words)  
featured in the Motion Picture ONCE AROUND  
Words and Music by Bart Howard  
TRO - © Copyright 1954 (Renewed) Hampshire House Publishing  
Corp., New York, NY  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
International Copyright Secured  
Blue Moon  
All Rights Reserved Including Public Performance For Profit  
Used by Permission  
Words by Lorenz Hart  
Music by Richard Rodgers  
© 1934 (Renewed 1962) METRO-GOLDWYN-MAYER INC.  
All Rights Controlled by EMI ROBBINS CATALOG INC. (Publishing)  
and WARNER BROS. PUBLICATIONS U.S. INC. (Print)  
All Rights Reserved Used by Permission  
Hey Jude  
Words and Music by John Lennon and Paul McCartney  
Copyright © 1968 Sony/ATV Songs LLC  
Copyright Renewed  
All Rights Administered by Sony/ATV Music Publishing, 8 Music  
Square West, Nashville, TN 37203  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
Brazil  
Words and Music by Ray Barroso  
English lyrics by S. K. Russell  
Copyright © 1941 by Peer International Corporation  
Copyright Renewed  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
Hound Dog  
Words and Music by Jerry Leiber and Mike Stoller  
Copyright © 1956 by Elvis Presley Music, Inc. and Lion Publishing  
Co., Inc.  
California Girls  
Copyright Renewed, Assigned to Gladys Music and Universal - MCA  
Music Publishing, A Division of Universal Studios, Inc.  
All Rights Administered by Cherry Lane Music Publishing Company,  
Inc. and Chrysalis Music  
Words and Music by Brian Wilson and Mike Love  
Copyright © 1965 IRVING MUSIC, INC.  
Copyright Renewed  
All Rights Reserved Used by Permission  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
Can You Feel The Love Tonight  
from Walt Disney Pictures’ THE LION KING  
Music by Elton John  
Lyrics by Tim Rice  
© 1994 Wonderland Music Company, Inc.  
All Rights Reserved Used by Permission  
I Just Called To Say I Love You  
Words and Music by Stevie Wonder  
© 1984 JOBETE MUSIC CO., INC. and BLACK BULL MUSIC  
c/o EMI APRIL MUSIC INC.  
All Rights Reserved International Copyright Secured Used by Per-  
mission  
Can’t Help Falling In Love  
I Left My Heart In San Francisco  
Words by Douglass Cross  
Music by George Cory  
from the Paramount Picture BLUE HAWAII  
Words and Music by George David Weiss, Hugo Peretti and Luigi Cre-  
atore  
© 1954 (Renewed 1982) COLGEMS-EMI MUSIC INC.  
All Rights Reserved International Copyright Secured Used by Per-  
mission  
Copyright © 1961 by Gladys Music, Inc.  
Copyright Renewed and Assigned to Gladys Music  
All Rights Administered by Cherry Lane Music Publishing Company,  
Inc. and Chrysalis Music  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
220  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In The Mood  
Moon River  
By Joe Garland  
from the Paramount Picture BREAKFAST AT TIFFANY’S  
Words by Johnny Mercer  
Music by Henry Mancini  
Copyright © 1939, 1960 Shapiro, Bernstein & Co., Inc., New York  
Copyright Renewed  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
Used by Permission  
Copyright © 1961 (Renewed 1989) by Famous Music Corporation  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
Isn’t She Lovely  
Moonlight Serenade  
Words and Music by Stevie Wonder  
© 1976 JOBETE MUSIC CO., INC. and BLACK BULL MUSIC  
c/o EMI APRIL MUSIC INC.  
Words by Mitchell Parish  
Music by Glen Miller  
Copyright © 1939 (Renewed 1967) by ROBBINS MUSIC CORPORA-  
All Rights Reserved International Copyright Secured Used by Per-  
mission  
TION  
All Rights Controlled and Administered by EMI ROBBINS CATALOG  
INC.  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
Let It Be  
Words and Music by John Lennon and Paul McCartney  
Copyright © 1970 Sony/ATV Songs LLC  
Copyright Renewed  
My Favorite Things  
from THE SOUND OF MUSIC  
All Rights Administered by Sony/ATV Music Publishing, 8 Music  
Square West, Nashville, TN 37203  
Lyrics by Oscar Hammerstein II  
Music by Richard Rodgers  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
Copyright © 1959 by Richard Rodgers and Oscar Hammerstein II  
Copyright Renewed  
WILLIAMSON MUSIC owner of publication and allied rights through-  
out the world  
Let’s Twist Again  
Words by Kal Mann  
Music by Dave Appell and Kal Mann  
Copyright © 1961 Kalmann Music, Inc.  
Copyright Renewed  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
My Way  
All Rights Controlled and Administered by Spirit Two Music, Inc.  
(ASCAP)  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
By Paul Anka, Jacques Revaux, Claude Francois and Giles Thibault  
© 1997 by Chrysalis Standards, Inc.  
Used by Permission. All Rights Reserved.  
Linus And Lucy  
The Nearness Of You  
By Vince Guaraldi  
Copyright © 1965 LEE MENDELSON FILM PRODUCTIONS, INC.  
Copyright Renewed  
from the Paramount Picture ROMANCE IN THE DARK  
Words by Ned Washington  
Music by Hoagy Carmichael  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
Copyright © 1937, 1940 (Renewed 1964, 1967) by Famous Music  
Corporation  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
Love Story  
Theme from the Paramount Picture LOVE STORY  
Music by Francis Lai  
Copyright © 1970, 1971 (Renewed 1998, 1999) by Famous Music  
Corporation  
Theme From “New York, New York”  
Music by John Kander  
Words by Fred Ebb  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
© 1977 UNITED ARTISTS CORPORATION  
All Rights Controlled by EMI UNART CATALOG INC. (Publishing) and  
WARNER BROS. PUBLICATIONS U.S. INC. (Print)  
All Rights Reserved Used by Permission  
Lullaby Of Birdland  
Words by George David Weiss  
Music by George Shearing  
© 1952, 1954 (Renewed 1980, 1982) EMI LONGITUDE MUSIC  
All Rights Reserved International Copyright Secured Used by Per-  
mission  
Ob-La-Di, Ob-La-Da  
Words and Music by John Lennon and Paul McCartney  
Copyright © 1968 Sony/ATV Songs LLC  
Copyright Renewed  
All Rights Administered by Sony/ATV Music Publishing, 8 Music  
Square West, Nashville, TN 37203  
Michelle  
Words and Music by John Lennon and Paul McCartney  
Copyright © 1965 Sony/ATV Songs LLC  
Copyright Renewed  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
All Rights Administered by Sony/ATV Music Publishing, 8 Music  
Square West, Nashville, TN 37203  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
Proud Mary  
Words and Music by J.C. Fogerty  
© 1968 (Renewed) JONDORA MUSIC  
All Rights Reserved Used by Permission  
Mickey Mouse March  
from Walt Disneys THE MICKEY MOUSE CLUB  
Words and Music by Jimmie Dodd  
© 1955 Walt Disney Music Company  
Copyright Renewed  
Return To Sender  
Words and Music by Otis Blackwell and Winfield Scott  
Copyright © 1962 by Elvis Presley Music, Inc.  
Copyright Renewed and Assigned to Elvis Presley Music  
All Rights Administered by Cherry River Music Co. and Chrysalis  
Songs  
All Rights Reserved Used by Permission  
Mission: Impossible Theme  
from the Paramount Television Series MISSION: IMPOSSIBLE  
By Lalo Schifrin  
Copyright © 1966, 1967 (Renewed 1994, 1995) by Bruin Music Com-  
pany  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
The Shoop Shoop Song (It’s In His Kiss)  
Words and Music by Rudy Clark  
Copyright © 1963, 1964 by Trio Music Company, Inc. and Top Of The  
Charts  
Copyright Renewed  
All Rights for the United States Controlled and Administered by Trio  
Music Company, Inc.  
All Rights for the World excluding the United States Controlled and  
Administered by Trio Music Company, Inc. and Alley Music Corp.  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
Used by Permission  
Mona Lisa  
from the Paramount Picture CAPTAIN CAREY, U.S.A.  
Words and Music by Jay Livingston and Ray Evans  
Copyright © 1949 (Renewed 1976) by Famous Music Corporation  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
221  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(Sittin’ On) The Dock Of The Bay  
Words and Music by Steve Cropper and Otis Redding  
Copyright © 1968, 1975 IRVING MUSIC, INC.  
Copyright Renewed  
That’s Amore (That’s Love)  
from the Paramount Picture THE CADDY  
Words by Jack Brooks  
Music by Harry Warren  
All Rights Reserved Used by Permission  
Copyright © 1953 (Renewed 1981) by Paramount Music Corporation  
and Four Jays Music  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
Smoke Gets In Your Eyes  
from ROBERTA  
Words by Otto Harbach  
Up Where We Belong  
Music by Jerome Kern  
© 1933 UNIVERSAL - POLYGRAM INTERNATIONAL PUBLISHING,  
INC.  
Copyright Renewed  
All Rights Reserved  
from the Paramount Picture AN OFFICER AND A GENTLEMAN  
Words by Will Jennings  
Music by Buffy Sainte-Marie and Jack Nitzsche  
Copyright © 1982 by Famous Music Corporation and Ensign Music  
Corporation  
International Rights Secured. Not for broadcast transmission.  
DO NOT DUPLICATE. NOT FOR RENTAL.  
WARNING: It is a violation of Federal Copyright Law to synchronize  
this Multimedia Disc with video tape or film, or to print the Composi-  
tion(s) embodied on this Multimedia Disc in the form of standard  
music notation, without the express written permission of the copy-  
right owner.  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
Waltz For Debby  
Lyric by Gene Lees  
Music by Bill Evans  
TRO - © Copyright 1964 (Renewed), 1965 (Renewed), 1966  
(Renewed) Folkways Music Publishers, Inc., New York, NY  
International Copyright Secured  
Somewhere, My Love  
Lara’s Theme from DOCTOR ZHIVAGO  
Lyric by Paul Francis Webster  
Music by Maurice Jarre  
Copyright © 1965, 1966 (Renewed 1993, 1994) Webster Music Co.  
and EMI Robbins Catalog Inc.  
All Rights Reserved Including Public Performance For Profit  
Used by Permission  
White Christmas  
from the Motion Picture Irving Berlins HOLIDAY INN  
Words and Music by Irving Berlin  
© Copyright 1940, 1942 by Irving Berlin  
Copyright Renewed  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
Spanish Eyes  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
Words by Charles Singleton and Eddie Snyder  
Music by Bert Kaempfert  
© 1965, 1966 (Renewed 1993, 1994) EDITION DOMA BERT  
KAEMPFERT  
All Rights for the world, excluding Germany, Austria and Switzerland,  
Controlled and Administered by SCREEN GEMS-EMI MUSIC INC.  
All Rights Reserved International Copyright Secured Used by Per-  
mission  
A Whole New World  
from Walt Disneys ALADDIN  
Music by Alan Menken  
Lyrics by Tim Rice  
© 1992 Wonderland Music Company, Inc. and Walt Disney Music  
Company  
All Rights Reserved Used by Permission  
Yesterday  
Speak Softly, Love (Love Theme)  
Words and Music by John Lennon and Paul McCartney  
Copyright © 1965 Sony/ATV Songs LLC  
Copyright Renewed  
All Rights Administered by Sony/ATV Music Publishing, 8 Music  
Square West, Nashville, TN 37203  
from the Paramount Picture THE GODFATHER  
Words by Larry Kusik  
Music by Nino Rota  
Copyright © 1972 (Renewed 2000) by Famous Music Corporation  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
Stella By Starlight  
from the Paramount Picture THE UNINVITED  
Words by Ned Washington  
Music by Victor Young  
Copyright © 1946 (Renewed 1973, 1974) by Famous Music Corpora-  
tion  
You Are The Sunshine Of My Life  
Words and Music by Stevie Wonder  
© 1972 (Renewed 2000) JOBETE MUSIC CO., INC. and BLACK BULL  
MUSIC  
c/o EMI APRIL MUSIC INC.  
All Rights Reserved International Copyright Secured Used by Per-  
mission  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
Take The “A” Train  
Words and Music by Billy Strayhorn  
You Sexy Thing  
Words and Music by E. Brown  
Copyright © 1941; Renewed 1969 DreamWorks Songs (ASCAP) and  
Billy Strayhorn Songs, Inc. (ASCAP) for the U.S.A.  
Rights for DreamWorks Songs and Billy Strayhorn Songs, Inc. Adminis-  
tered by Cherry Lane Music Publishing Company, Inc.  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
Copyright © 1975 by Finchley Music Corp.  
Administered in the USA and Canada by Music & Media International,  
Inc.  
Administered for the World excluding the USA and Canada by RAK  
Music Publishing Ltd.  
Tears In Heaven  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
Words and Music by Eric Clapton and Will Jennings  
Copyright © 1992 by E.C. Music Ltd. and Blue Sky Rider Songs  
All Rights for E.C. Music Ltd. Administered by Unichappell Music Inc.  
All Rights for Blue Sky Rider Songs Administered by Irving Music, Inc.  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
That Old Black Magic  
from the Paramount Picture STAR SPANGLED RHYTHM  
Words by Johnny Mercer  
Music by Harold Arlen  
Copyright © 1942 (Renewed 1969) by Famous Music Corporation  
International Copyright Secured All Rights Reserved  
CGP-1000 Owners Manual  
222  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS  
INFORMATION RELATING TO PERSONAL INJURY, ELECTRICAL SHOCK,  
AND FIRE HAZARD POSSIBILITIES HAS BEEN INCLUDED IN THIS LIST.  
WARNING- When using any electrical or electronic product,  
basic precautions should always be followed. These precautions  
include, but are not limited to, the following:  
8. This product was NOT designed for use in wet/damp loca-  
tions and should not be used near water or exposed to rain.  
Examples of wet/damp locations are; near a swimming pool,  
spa, tub, sink, or wet basement.  
1. Read all Safety Instructions, Installation Instructions, Spe-  
cial Message Section items, and any Assembly Instructions  
found in this manual BEFORE making any connections, includ-  
ing connection to the main supply.  
9. This product should be used only with the components  
supplied or; a cart, rack, or stand that is recommended by the  
manufacturer. If a cart, rack, or stand is used, please observe all  
safety markings and instructions that accompany the accessory  
product.  
2. Main Power Supply Verification: Yamaha products are  
manufactured specifically for the supply voltage in the area  
where they are to be sold. If you should move, or if any doubt  
exists about the supply voltage in your area, please contact your  
dealer for supply voltage verification and (if applicable) instruc-  
tions. The required supply voltage is printed on the name plate.  
For name plate location, please refer to the graphic found in the  
Special Message Section of this manual.  
10. The power supply cord (plug) should be disconnected  
from the outlet when electronic products are to be left unused for  
extended periods of time. Cords should also be disconnected  
when there is a high probability of lightning and/or electrical  
storm activity.  
11. Care should be taken that objects do not fall and liquids  
are not spilled into the enclosure through any openings that may  
exist.  
3. This product may be equipped with a polarized plug (one  
blade wider than the other). If you are unable to insert the plug  
into the outlet, turn the plug over and try again. If the problem  
persists, contact an electrician to have the obsolete outlet  
replaced. Do NOT defeat the safety purpose of the plug.  
12. Electrical/electronic products should be serviced by a  
qualified service person when:  
a. The power supply cord has been damaged; or  
b. Objects have fallen, been inserted, or liquids have been  
spilled into the enclosure through openings; or  
c. The product has been exposed to rain: or  
d. The product dose not operate, exhibits a marked change  
in performance; or  
4. Some electronic products utilize external power supplies  
or adapters. Do NOT connect this type of product to any power  
supply or adapter other than one described in the owners manual,  
on the name plate, or specifically recommended by Yamaha.  
e. The product has been dropped, or the enclosure of the  
product has been damaged.  
5. WARNING: Do not place this product or any other  
objects on the power cord or place it in a position where anyone  
could walk on, trip over, or roll anything over power or connect-  
ing cords of any kind. The use of an extension cord is not recom-  
mended! If you must use an extension cord, the minimum wire  
size for a 25’ cord (or less) is 18 AWG. NOTE: The smaller the  
AWG number, the larger the current handling capacity. For  
longer extension cords, consult a local electrician.  
13. Do not attempt to service this product beyond that  
described in the user-maintenance instructions. All other servic-  
ing should be referred to qualified service personnel.  
14. This product, either alone or in combination with an  
amplifier and headphones or speaker/s, may be capable of pro-  
ducing sound levels that could cause permanent hearing loss.  
DO NOT operate for a long period of time at a high volume level  
or at a level that is uncomfortable. If you experience any hearing  
loss or ringing in the ears, you should consult an audiologist.  
IMPORTANT: The louder the sound, the shorter the time period  
before damage occurs.  
6. Ventilation: Electronic products, unless specifically  
designed for enclosed installations, should be placed in locations  
that do not interfere with proper ventilation. If instructions for  
enclosed installations are not provided, it must be assumed that  
unobstructed ventilation is required.  
7. Temperature considerations: Electronic products should  
be installed in locations that do not significantly contribute to  
their operating temperature. Placement of this product close to  
heat sources such as; radiators, heat registers and other devices  
that produce heat should be avoided.  
15. Some Yamaha products may have benches and/or acces-  
sory mounting fixtures that are either supplied as a part of the  
product or as optional accessories. Some of these items are  
designed to be dealer assembled or installed. Please make sure  
that benches are stable and any optional fixtures (where applica-  
ble) are well secured BEFORE using. Benches supplied by  
Yamaha are designed for seating only. No other uses are recom-  
mended.  
PLEASE KEEP THIS MANUAL  
92-469-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FCC INFORMATION (U.S.A.)  
1. IMPORTANT NOTICE: DO NOT MODIFY THIS UNIT!  
other electronic devices. Compliance with FCC regula-  
tions does not guarantee that interference will not occur  
in all installations. If this product is found to be the  
source of interference, which can be determined by  
turning the unit “OFF” and “ON”, please try to eliminate  
the problem by using one of the following measures:  
This product, when installed as indicated in the instruc-  
tions contained in this manual, meets FCC require-  
ments. Modifications not expressly approved by  
Yamaha may void your authority, granted by the FCC, to  
use the product.  
Relocate either this product or the device that is being  
affected by the interference.  
2. IMPORTANT: When connecting this product to acces-  
sories and/or another product use only high quality  
shielded cables. Cable/s supplied with this product  
MUST be used. Follow all installation instructions. Fail-  
ure to follow instructions could void your FCC authori-  
zation to use this product in the USA.  
Utilize power outlets that are on different branch (circuit  
breaker or fuse) circuits or install AC line filter/s.  
In the case of radio or TV interference, relocate/reorient  
the antenna. If the antenna lead-in is 300 ohm ribbon  
lead, change the lead-in to co-axial type cable.  
3. NOTE: This product has been tested and found to com-  
ply with the requirements listed in FCC Regulations,  
Part 15 for Class “B” digital devices. Compliance with  
these requirements provides a reasonable level of  
assurance that your use of this product in a residential  
environment will not result in harmful interference with  
other electronic devices. This equipment generates/  
uses radio frequencies and, if not installed and used  
according to the instructions found in the users manual,  
may cause interference harmful to the operation of  
If these corrective measures do not produce satisfac-  
tory results, please contact the local retailer authorized  
to distribute this type of product. If you can not locate  
the appropriate retailer, please contact Yamaha Corpo-  
ration of America, Electronic Service Division, 6600  
Orangethorpe Ave, Buena Park, CA90620  
The above statements apply ONLY to those products  
distributed by Yamaha Corporation of America or its  
subsidiaries.  
* This applies only to products distributed by YAMAHA CORPORATION OF AMERICA.  
(class B)  
IMPORTANT NOTICE FOR THE UNITED KINGDOM  
Connecting the Plug and Cord  
COMPLIANCE INFORMATION STATEMENT  
(DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY PROCEDURE)  
IMPORTANT. The wires in this mains lead are coloured in  
accordance with the following code:  
Responsible Party : Yamaha Corporation of America  
Address : 6600 Orangethorpe Ave., Buena Park, Calif.  
90620  
Telephone : 714-522-9011  
Type of Equipment : Electronic Piano  
Model Name : CGP-1000  
BLUE  
: NEUTRAL  
BROWN : LIVE  
As the colours of the wires in the mains lead of this appa-  
ratus may not correspond with the coloured makings iden-  
tifying the terminals in your plug proceed as follows:  
The wire which is coloured BLUE must be connected to  
the terminal which is marked with the letter N or coloured  
BLACK.  
The wire which is coloured BROWN must be connected to  
the terminal which is marked with the letter L or coloured  
RED.  
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules.  
Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
1) this device may not cause harmful interference, and  
2) this device must accept any interference received including  
interference that may cause undesired operation.  
See user manual instructions if interference to radio reception is  
suspected.  
Making sure that neither core is connected to the earth ter-  
minal of the three pin plug.  
* This applies only to products distributed by  
YAMAHA CORPORATION OF AMERICA.  
(FCC DoC)  
(2 wires)  
• This applies only to products distributed by Yamaha-Kemble Music  
(U.K.) Ltd.  
CAUTION: TO PREVENT ELECTRIC SHOCK, MATCH  
This product contains a high intensity lamp that con-  
tains a small amount of mercury. Disposal of this  
material may be regulated due to environmental  
considerations.  
For disposal information in the United States, refer  
to the Electronic Industries Alliance web site:  
www.eiae.org  
WIDE BLADE OF PLUG TO WIDE SLOT, FULLY INSERT.  
ATTENTION: POUR ÉVITER LES CHOCS ÉLEC-  
TRIQUES, INTRODUIRE LA LAME LA PLUS LARGE DE  
LA FICHE DANS LA BORNE CORRESPONDANTE DE  
LA PRISE ET POUSSER JUSQU’AU FOND.  
(polarity)  
• This applies only to products distributed by Yamaha Canada Music  
Ltd.  
• Ceci ne s’applique qu’aux produits distribués par Yamaha Canada  
Musique Ltée.  
* This applies only to products distributed by  
YAMAHA CORPORATION OF AMERICA.  
(mercury)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For details of products, please contact your nearest Yamaha  
representative or the authorized distributor listed below.  
Die Einzelheiten zu Produkten sind bei Ihrer unten aufgeführten  
Niederlassung und bei Yamaha Vertragshändlern in den jeweiligen  
Bestimmungsländern erhältlich.  
Pour plus de détails sur les produits, veuillez-vous adresser à Yamaha ou  
au distributeur le plus proche de vous figurant dans la liste suivante.  
Para detalles sobre productos, contacte su tiendaYamaha más cercana  
o el distribuidor autorizado que se lista debajo.  
THE NETHERLANDS/  
NORTH AMERICA  
ASIA  
BELGIUM/LUXEMBOURG  
CANADA  
THE PEOPLE’S REPUBLIC OF CHINA  
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH,  
Branch Benelux  
Clarissenhof 5-b, 4133 AB Vianen, The Netherlands  
Tel: 0347-358 040  
Yamaha Canada Music Ltd.  
135 Milner Avenue, Scarborough, Ontario,  
M1S 3R1, Canada  
Yamaha Music & Electronics (China) Co.,Ltd.  
25/F., United Plaza, 1468 Nanjing Road (West),  
Jingan, Shanghai, China  
Tel: 416-298-1311  
Tel: 021-6247-2211  
FRANCE  
U.S.A.  
HONG KONG  
Yamaha Musique France  
Yamaha Corporation of America  
6600 Orangethorpe Ave., Buena Park, Calif. 90620,  
U.S.A.  
Tom Lee Music Co., Ltd.  
BP 70-77312 Marne-la-Vallée Cedex 2, France  
Tel: 01-64-61-4000  
11/F., Silvercord Tower 1, 30 Canton Road,  
Tsimshatsui, Kowloon, Hong Kong  
Tel: 2737-7688  
Tel: 714-522-9011  
ITALY  
Yamaha Musica Italia S.P.A.  
Viale Italia 88, 20020 Lainate (Milano), Italy  
Tel: 02-935-771  
INDONESIA  
CENTRAL & SOUTH AMERICA  
PT. Yamaha Music Indonesia (Distributor)  
PT. Nusantik  
MEXICO  
Gedung Yamaha Music Center, Jalan Jend. Gatot  
Subroto Kav. 4, Jakarta 12930, Indonesia  
Tel: 21-520-2577  
Yamaha de México S.A. de C.V.  
Calz. Javier Rojo Gómez #1149,  
Col. Guadalupe del Moral  
C.P. 09300, México, D.F., México  
Tel: 55-5804-0600  
SPAIN/PORTUGAL  
Yamaha Música Ibérica, S.A.  
Ctra. de la Coruna km. 17, 200, 28230  
Las Rozas (Madrid), Spain  
Tel: 91-639-8888  
KOREA  
Yamaha Music Korea Ltd.  
8F, 9F, Dongsung Bldg. 158-9 Samsung-Dong,  
Kangnam-Gu, Seoul, Korea  
Tel: 080-004-0022  
BRAZIL  
GREECE  
Philippos Nakas S.A. The Music House  
147 Skiathou Street, 112-55 Athens, Greece  
Tel: 01-228 2160  
Yamaha Musical do Brasil Ltda.  
Rua Joaquim Floriano, 913 - 4' andar, Itaim Bibi,  
CEP 04534-013 Sao Paulo, SP. BRAZIL  
Tel: 011-3704-1377  
MALAYSIA  
Yamaha Music Malaysia, Sdn., Bhd.  
Lot 8, Jalan Perbandaran, 47301 Kelana Jaya,  
Petaling Jaya, Selangor, Malaysia  
Tel: 3-78030900  
SWEDEN  
ARGENTINA  
Yamaha Music Latin America, S.A.  
Sucursal de Argentina  
Olga Cossettini 1553, Piso 4 Norte  
Madero Este-C1107CEK  
Buenos Aires, Argentina  
Yamaha Scandinavia AB  
J. A. Wettergrens Gata 1, Box 30053  
S-400 43 Göteborg, Sweden  
Tel: 031 89 34 00  
PHILIPPINES  
Yupangco Music Corporation  
339 Gil J. Puyat Avenue, P.O. Box 885 MCPO,  
Makati, Metro Manila, Philippines  
Tel: 819-7551  
DENMARK  
YS Copenhagen Liaison Office  
Generatorvej 6A, DK-2730 Herlev, Denmark  
Tel: 44 92 49 00  
Tel: 011-4119-7000  
PANAMA AND OTHER LATIN  
AMERICAN COUNTRIES/  
CARIBBEAN COUNTRIES  
Yamaha Music Latin America, S.A.  
Torre Banco General, Piso 7, Urbanización Marbella,  
Calle 47 y Aquilino de la Guardia,  
Ciudad de Panamá, Panamá  
SINGAPORE  
FINLAND  
F-Musiikki Oy  
Kluuvikatu 6, P.O. Box 260,  
SF-00101 Helsinki, Finland  
Tel: 09 618511  
Yamaha Music Asia Pte., Ltd.  
#03-11 A-Z Building  
140 Paya Lebor Road, Singapore 409015  
Tel: 747-4374  
TAIWAN  
Yamaha KHS Music Co., Ltd.  
3F, #6, Sec.2, Nan Jing E. Rd. Taipei.  
Taiwan 104, R.O.C.  
Tel: +507-269-5311  
NORWAY  
Norsk filial av Yamaha Scandinavia AB  
Grini Næringspark 1, N-1345 Østerås, Norway  
Tel: 67 16 77 70  
EUROPE  
THE UNITED KINGDOM  
Yamaha Music U.K. Ltd.  
Sherbourne Drive, Tilbrook, Milton Keynes,  
MK7 8BL, England  
Tel: 02-2511-8688  
ICELAND  
Skifan HF  
Skeifan 17 P.O. Box 8120, IS-128 Reykjavik, Ice-  
land  
Tel: 525 5000  
THAILAND  
Siam Music Yamaha Co., Ltd.  
4, 6, 15 and 16th floor, Siam Motors Building,  
891/1 Rama 1 Road, Wangmai,  
Pathumwan, Bangkok 10330, Thailand  
Tel: 02-215-2626  
Tel: 01908-366700  
IRELAND  
Danfay Ltd.  
61D, Sallynoggin Road, Dun Laoghaire, Co. Dublin  
Tel: 01-2859177  
RUSSIA  
Yamaha Music (Russia)  
Office 4015, entrance 2, 21/5 Kuznetskii  
Most street, Moscow, 107996, Russia  
Tel: 495 626 0660  
OTHER ASIAN COUNTRIES  
Yamaha Corporation,  
Asia-Pacific Music Marketing Group  
Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Naka-ku, Hamamatsu,  
Japan 430-8650  
GERMANY  
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH  
Siemensstraße 22-34, 25462 Rellingen, Germany  
Tel: 04101-3030  
OTHER EUROPEAN COUNTRIES  
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH  
Siemensstraße 22-34, 25462 Rellingen, Germany  
Tel: +49-4101-3030  
Tel: +81-53-460-2317  
SWITZERLAND/LIECHTENSTEIN  
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH,  
Branch Switzerland  
OCEANIA  
AUSTRALIA  
Yamaha Music Australia Pty. Ltd.  
Level 1, 99 Queensbridge Street, Southbank,  
Victoria 3006, Australia  
Seefeldstrasse 94, 8008 Zürich, Switzerland  
Tel: 01-383 3990  
AFRICA  
Yamaha Corporation,  
Asia-Pacific Music Marketing Group  
Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Naka-ku, Hamamatsu,  
Japan 430-8650  
AUSTRIA  
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH,  
Branch Austria  
Tel: 3-9693-5111  
NEW ZEALAND  
Music Works LTD  
P.O.BOX 6246 Wellesley, Auckland 4680,  
New Zealand  
Tel: +81-53-460-2312  
Schleiergasse 20, A-1100 Wien, Austria  
Tel: 01-60203900  
CZECH REPUBLIC/SLOVAKIA/  
HUNGARY/SLOVENIA  
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH,  
Branch Austria, CEE Department  
Schleiergasse 20, A-1100 Wien, Austria  
Tel: 01-602039025  
MIDDLE EAST  
TURKEY/CYPRUS  
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH  
Siemensstraße 22-34, 25462 Rellingen, Germany  
Tel: 04101-3030  
Tel: 9-634-0099  
COUNTRIES AND TRUST  
TERRITORIES IN PACIFIC OCEAN  
Yamaha Corporation,  
Asia-Pacific Music Marketing Group  
Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Naka-ku, Hamamatsu,  
Japan 430-8650  
OTHER COUNTRIES  
POLAND  
Yamaha Music Gulf FZE  
LOB 16-513, P.O.Box 17328, Jubel Ali,  
Dubai, United Arab Emirates  
Tel: +971-4-881-5868  
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH  
Sp.z. o.o. Oddzial w Polsce  
Tel: +81-53-460-2312  
ul. 17 Stycznia 56, PL-02-146 Warszawa, Poland  
Tel: 022-868-07-57  
HEAD OFFICE Yamaha Corporation, Pro Audio & Digital Musical Instrument Division  
Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Naka-ku, Hamamatsu, Japan 430-8650  
Tel: +81-53-460-3273  
EKB45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clavinova Web site  
http://music.yamaha.com/homekeyboard  
Yamaha Manual Library  
http://www.yamaha.co.jp/manual/  
U.R.G., Pro Audio & Digital Musical Instrument Division, Yamaha Corporation  
© 2007 Yamaha Corporation  
WH72810 806APAP3.2-02B0  
Printed in China  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Weider Home Gym 831159821 User Manual
Whirlpool Clothes Dryer CSP2761TQ User Manual
Winegard TV Converter Box RCDT09A User Manual
Xantech Door WPK1 User Manual
Xantrex Technology Welding System 808 9002 01 User Manual
Xerox Printer Phaser 6280 User Manual
Xpelair Ventilation Hood DX100H User Manual
Yamaha Motorcycle Breeze User Manual
Yamaha Music Mixer AM802 User Manual
Zanussi Freezer ZA18 User Manual